7
|
1 /* vi:set ts=8 sts=4 sw=4:
|
|
2 *
|
|
3 * VIM - Vi IMproved by Bram Moolenaar
|
|
4 *
|
|
5 * Do ":help uganda" in Vim to read copying and usage conditions.
|
|
6 * Do ":help credits" in Vim to see a list of people who contributed.
|
|
7 * See README.txt for an overview of the Vim source code.
|
|
8 */
|
|
9
|
|
10 /*
|
|
11 * syntax.c: code for syntax highlighting
|
|
12 */
|
|
13
|
|
14 #include "vim.h"
|
|
15
|
|
16 /*
|
|
17 * Structure that stores information about a highlight group.
|
|
18 * The ID of a highlight group is also called group ID. It is the index in
|
|
19 * the highlight_ga array PLUS ONE.
|
|
20 */
|
|
21 struct hl_group
|
|
22 {
|
|
23 char_u *sg_name; /* highlight group name */
|
|
24 char_u *sg_name_u; /* uppercase of sg_name */
|
|
25 /* for normal terminals */
|
|
26 int sg_term; /* "term=" highlighting attributes */
|
|
27 char_u *sg_start; /* terminal string for start highl */
|
|
28 char_u *sg_stop; /* terminal string for stop highl */
|
|
29 int sg_term_attr; /* Screen attr for term mode */
|
|
30 /* for color terminals */
|
|
31 int sg_cterm; /* "cterm=" highlighting attr */
|
|
32 int sg_cterm_bold; /* bold attr was set for light color */
|
|
33 int sg_cterm_fg; /* terminal fg color number + 1 */
|
|
34 int sg_cterm_bg; /* terminal bg color number + 1 */
|
|
35 int sg_cterm_attr; /* Screen attr for color term mode */
|
|
36 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
|
37 /* for when using the GUI */
|
|
38 int sg_gui; /* "gui=" highlighting attributes */
|
|
39 guicolor_T sg_gui_fg; /* GUI foreground color handle */
|
|
40 char_u *sg_gui_fg_name;/* GUI foreground color name */
|
|
41 guicolor_T sg_gui_bg; /* GUI background color handle */
|
|
42 char_u *sg_gui_bg_name;/* GUI background color name */
|
205
|
43 guicolor_T sg_gui_sp; /* GUI special color handle */
|
|
44 char_u *sg_gui_sp_name;/* GUI special color name */
|
7
|
45 GuiFont sg_font; /* GUI font handle */
|
|
46 #ifdef FEAT_XFONTSET
|
|
47 GuiFontset sg_fontset; /* GUI fontset handle */
|
|
48 #endif
|
|
49 char_u *sg_font_name; /* GUI font or fontset name */
|
|
50 int sg_gui_attr; /* Screen attr for GUI mode */
|
|
51 #endif
|
|
52 int sg_link; /* link to this highlight group ID */
|
|
53 int sg_set; /* combination of SG_* flags */
|
448
|
54 #ifdef FEAT_EVAL
|
|
55 scid_T sg_scriptID; /* script in which the group was last set */
|
|
56 #endif
|
7
|
57 };
|
|
58
|
|
59 #define SG_TERM 1 /* term has been set */
|
|
60 #define SG_CTERM 2 /* cterm has been set */
|
|
61 #define SG_GUI 4 /* gui has been set */
|
|
62 #define SG_LINK 8 /* link has been set */
|
|
63
|
|
64 static garray_T highlight_ga; /* highlight groups for 'highlight' option */
|
|
65
|
|
66 #define HL_TABLE() ((struct hl_group *)((highlight_ga.ga_data)))
|
|
67
|
|
68 #ifdef FEAT_CMDL_COMPL
|
|
69 static int include_default = FALSE; /* include "default" for expansion */
|
|
70 static int include_link = FALSE; /* include "link" for expansion */
|
|
71 #endif
|
|
72
|
|
73 /*
|
|
74 * The "term", "cterm" and "gui" arguments can be any combination of the
|
|
75 * following names, separated by commas (but no spaces!).
|
|
76 */
|
|
77 static char *(hl_name_table[]) =
|
205
|
78 {"bold", "standout", "underline", "undercurl",
|
|
79 "italic", "reverse", "inverse", "NONE"};
|
7
|
80 static int hl_attr_table[] =
|
205
|
81 {HL_BOLD, HL_STANDOUT, HL_UNDERLINE, HL_UNDERCURL, HL_ITALIC, HL_INVERSE, HL_INVERSE, 0};
|
7
|
82
|
|
83 static int get_attr_entry __ARGS((garray_T *table, attrentry_T *aep));
|
|
84 static void syn_unadd_group __ARGS((void));
|
|
85 static void set_hl_attr __ARGS((int idx));
|
|
86 static void highlight_list_one __ARGS((int id));
|
|
87 static int highlight_list_arg __ARGS((int id, int didh, int type, int iarg, char_u *sarg, char *name));
|
|
88 static int syn_add_group __ARGS((char_u *name));
|
|
89 static int syn_list_header __ARGS((int did_header, int outlen, int id));
|
|
90 static int hl_has_settings __ARGS((int idx, int check_link));
|
|
91 static void highlight_clear __ARGS((int idx));
|
|
92
|
|
93 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
|
94 static void gui_do_one_color __ARGS((int idx, int do_menu, int do_tooltip));
|
|
95 static int set_group_colors __ARGS((char_u *name, guicolor_T *fgp, guicolor_T *bgp, int do_menu, int use_norm, int do_tooltip));
|
|
96 static guicolor_T color_name2handle __ARGS((char_u *name));
|
|
97 static GuiFont font_name2handle __ARGS((char_u *name));
|
|
98 # ifdef FEAT_XFONTSET
|
|
99 static GuiFontset fontset_name2handle __ARGS((char_u *name, int fixed_width));
|
|
100 # endif
|
|
101 static void hl_do_font __ARGS((int idx, char_u *arg, int do_normal, int do_menu, int do_tooltip));
|
|
102 #endif
|
|
103
|
|
104 /*
|
|
105 * An attribute number is the index in attr_table plus ATTR_OFF.
|
|
106 */
|
|
107 #define ATTR_OFF (HL_ALL + 1)
|
|
108
|
|
109 #if defined(FEAT_SYN_HL) || defined(PROTO)
|
|
110
|
|
111 #define SYN_NAMELEN 50 /* maximum length of a syntax name */
|
|
112
|
|
113 /* different types of offsets that are possible */
|
|
114 #define SPO_MS_OFF 0 /* match start offset */
|
|
115 #define SPO_ME_OFF 1 /* match end offset */
|
|
116 #define SPO_HS_OFF 2 /* highl. start offset */
|
|
117 #define SPO_HE_OFF 3 /* highl. end offset */
|
|
118 #define SPO_RS_OFF 4 /* region start offset */
|
|
119 #define SPO_RE_OFF 5 /* region end offset */
|
|
120 #define SPO_LC_OFF 6 /* leading context offset */
|
|
121 #define SPO_COUNT 7
|
|
122
|
|
123 static char *(spo_name_tab[SPO_COUNT]) =
|
|
124 {"ms=", "me=", "hs=", "he=", "rs=", "re=", "lc="};
|
|
125
|
|
126 /*
|
|
127 * The patterns that are being searched for are stored in a syn_pattern.
|
|
128 * A match item consists of one pattern.
|
|
129 * A start/end item consists of n start patterns and m end patterns.
|
|
130 * A start/skip/end item consists of n start patterns, one skip pattern and m
|
|
131 * end patterns.
|
|
132 * For the latter two, the patterns are always consecutive: start-skip-end.
|
|
133 *
|
|
134 * A character offset can be given for the matched text (_m_start and _m_end)
|
|
135 * and for the actually highlighted text (_h_start and _h_end).
|
|
136 */
|
|
137 typedef struct syn_pattern
|
|
138 {
|
|
139 char sp_type; /* see SPTYPE_ defines below */
|
|
140 char sp_syncing; /* this item used for syncing */
|
|
141 short sp_flags; /* see HL_ defines below */
|
|
142 struct sp_syn sp_syn; /* struct passed to in_id_list() */
|
|
143 short sp_syn_match_id; /* highlight group ID of pattern */
|
|
144 char_u *sp_pattern; /* regexp to match, pattern */
|
|
145 regprog_T *sp_prog; /* regexp to match, program */
|
|
146 int sp_ic; /* ignore-case flag for sp_prog */
|
|
147 short sp_off_flags; /* see below */
|
|
148 int sp_offsets[SPO_COUNT]; /* offsets */
|
|
149 short *sp_cont_list; /* cont. group IDs, if non-zero */
|
|
150 short *sp_next_list; /* next group IDs, if non-zero */
|
|
151 int sp_sync_idx; /* sync item index (syncing only) */
|
|
152 int sp_line_id; /* ID of last line where tried */
|
|
153 int sp_startcol; /* next match in sp_line_id line */
|
|
154 } synpat_T;
|
|
155
|
|
156 /* The sp_off_flags are computed like this:
|
|
157 * offset from the start of the matched text: (1 << SPO_XX_OFF)
|
|
158 * offset from the end of the matched text: (1 << (SPO_XX_OFF + SPO_COUNT))
|
|
159 * When both are present, only one is used.
|
|
160 */
|
|
161
|
|
162 #define SPTYPE_MATCH 1 /* match keyword with this group ID */
|
|
163 #define SPTYPE_START 2 /* match a regexp, start of item */
|
|
164 #define SPTYPE_END 3 /* match a regexp, end of item */
|
|
165 #define SPTYPE_SKIP 4 /* match a regexp, skip within item */
|
|
166
|
|
167 #define HL_CONTAINED 0x01 /* not used on toplevel */
|
|
168 #define HL_TRANSP 0x02 /* has no highlighting */
|
|
169 #define HL_ONELINE 0x04 /* match within one line only */
|
|
170 #define HL_HAS_EOL 0x08 /* end pattern that matches with $ */
|
|
171 #define HL_SYNC_HERE 0x10 /* sync point after this item (syncing only) */
|
|
172 #define HL_SYNC_THERE 0x20 /* sync point at current line (syncing only) */
|
|
173 #define HL_MATCH 0x40 /* use match ID instead of item ID */
|
|
174 #define HL_SKIPNL 0x80 /* nextgroup can skip newlines */
|
|
175 #define HL_SKIPWHITE 0x100 /* nextgroup can skip white space */
|
|
176 #define HL_SKIPEMPTY 0x200 /* nextgroup can skip empty lines */
|
|
177 #define HL_KEEPEND 0x400 /* end match always kept */
|
|
178 #define HL_EXCLUDENL 0x800 /* exclude NL from match */
|
|
179 #define HL_DISPLAY 0x1000 /* only used for displaying, not syncing */
|
|
180 #define HL_FOLD 0x2000 /* define fold */
|
|
181 #define HL_EXTEND 0x4000 /* ignore a keepend */
|
|
182 /* These don't fit in a short, thus can't be used for syntax items, only for
|
|
183 * si_flags and bs_flags. */
|
|
184 #define HL_MATCHCONT 0x8000 /* match continued from previous line */
|
|
185 #define HL_TRANS_CONT 0x10000L /* transparent item without contains arg */
|
|
186
|
|
187 #define SYN_ITEMS(buf) ((synpat_T *)((buf)->b_syn_patterns.ga_data))
|
|
188
|
|
189 #define NONE_IDX -2 /* value of sp_sync_idx for "NONE" */
|
|
190
|
|
191 /*
|
|
192 * Flags for b_syn_sync_flags:
|
|
193 */
|
|
194 #define SF_CCOMMENT 0x01 /* sync on a C-style comment */
|
|
195 #define SF_MATCH 0x02 /* sync by matching a pattern */
|
|
196
|
|
197 #define SYN_STATE_P(ssp) ((bufstate_T *)((ssp)->ga_data))
|
|
198
|
|
199 #define MAXKEYWLEN 80 /* maximum length of a keyword */
|
|
200
|
|
201 /*
|
|
202 * The attributes of the syntax item that has been recognized.
|
|
203 */
|
|
204 static int current_attr = 0; /* attr of current syntax word */
|
|
205 #ifdef FEAT_EVAL
|
|
206 static int current_id = 0; /* ID of current char for syn_get_id() */
|
|
207 static int current_trans_id = 0; /* idem, transparancy removed */
|
|
208 #endif
|
|
209
|
221
|
210 typedef struct syn_cluster_S
|
7
|
211 {
|
|
212 char_u *scl_name; /* syntax cluster name */
|
|
213 char_u *scl_name_u; /* uppercase of scl_name */
|
|
214 short *scl_list; /* IDs in this syntax cluster */
|
221
|
215 } syn_cluster_T;
|
7
|
216
|
|
217 /*
|
|
218 * Methods of combining two clusters
|
|
219 */
|
|
220 #define CLUSTER_REPLACE 1 /* replace first list with second */
|
|
221 #define CLUSTER_ADD 2 /* add second list to first */
|
|
222 #define CLUSTER_SUBTRACT 3 /* subtract second list from first */
|
|
223
|
221
|
224 #define SYN_CLSTR(buf) ((syn_cluster_T *)((buf)->b_syn_clusters.ga_data))
|
7
|
225
|
|
226 /*
|
|
227 * Syntax group IDs have different types:
|
|
228 * 0 - 9999 normal syntax groups
|
|
229 * 10000 - 14999 ALLBUT indicator (current_syn_inc_tag added)
|
|
230 * 15000 - 19999 TOP indicator (current_syn_inc_tag added)
|
|
231 * 20000 - 24999 CONTAINED indicator (current_syn_inc_tag added)
|
|
232 * >= 25000 cluster IDs (subtract SYNID_CLUSTER for the cluster ID)
|
|
233 */
|
|
234 #define SYNID_ALLBUT 10000 /* syntax group ID for contains=ALLBUT */
|
|
235 #define SYNID_TOP 15000 /* syntax group ID for contains=TOP */
|
|
236 #define SYNID_CONTAINED 20000 /* syntax group ID for contains=CONTAINED */
|
|
237 #define SYNID_CLUSTER 25000 /* first syntax group ID for clusters */
|
|
238
|
|
239 /*
|
|
240 * Annoying Hack(TM): ":syn include" needs this pointer to pass to
|
|
241 * expand_filename(). Most of the other syntax commands don't need it, so
|
|
242 * instead of passing it to them, we stow it here.
|
|
243 */
|
|
244 static char_u **syn_cmdlinep;
|
|
245
|
|
246 /*
|
|
247 * Another Annoying Hack(TM): To prevent rules from other ":syn include"'d
|
|
248 * files from from leaking into ALLBUT lists, we assign a unique ID to the
|
|
249 * rules in each ":syn include"'d file.
|
|
250 */
|
|
251 static int current_syn_inc_tag = 0;
|
|
252 static int running_syn_inc_tag = 0;
|
|
253
|
|
254 /*
|
134
|
255 * In a hashtable item "hi_key" points to "keyword" in a keyentry.
|
|
256 * This avoids adding a pointer to the hashtable item.
|
|
257 * KE2HIKEY() converts a var pointer to a hashitem key pointer.
|
|
258 * HIKEY2KE() converts a hashitem key pointer to a var pointer.
|
|
259 * HI2KE() converts a hashitem pointer to a var pointer.
|
|
260 */
|
|
261 static keyentry_T dumkey;
|
|
262 #define KE2HIKEY(kp) ((kp)->keyword)
|
|
263 #define HIKEY2KE(p) ((keyentry_T *)((p) - (dumkey.keyword - (char_u *)&dumkey)))
|
|
264 #define HI2KE(hi) HIKEY2KE((hi)->hi_key)
|
|
265
|
|
266 /*
|
7
|
267 * To reduce the time spent in keepend(), remember at which level in the state
|
|
268 * stack the first item with "keepend" is present. When "-1", there is no
|
|
269 * "keepend" on the stack.
|
|
270 */
|
|
271 static int keepend_level = -1;
|
|
272
|
|
273 /*
|
|
274 * For the current state we need to remember more than just the idx.
|
|
275 * When si_m_endpos.lnum is 0, the items other than si_idx are unknown.
|
|
276 * (The end positions have the column number of the next char)
|
|
277 */
|
|
278 typedef struct state_item
|
|
279 {
|
|
280 int si_idx; /* index of syntax pattern */
|
|
281 int si_id; /* highlight group ID for keywords */
|
|
282 int si_trans_id; /* idem, transparancy removed */
|
|
283 int si_m_lnum; /* lnum of the match */
|
|
284 int si_m_startcol; /* starting column of the match */
|
|
285 lpos_T si_m_endpos; /* just after end posn of the match */
|
|
286 lpos_T si_h_startpos; /* start position of the highlighting */
|
|
287 lpos_T si_h_endpos; /* end position of the highlighting */
|
|
288 lpos_T si_eoe_pos; /* end position of end pattern */
|
|
289 int si_end_idx; /* group ID for end pattern or zero */
|
|
290 int si_ends; /* if match ends before si_m_endpos */
|
|
291 int si_attr; /* attributes in this state */
|
|
292 long si_flags; /* HL_HAS_EOL flag in this state, and
|
|
293 * HL_SKIP* for si_next_list */
|
|
294 short *si_cont_list; /* list of contained groups */
|
|
295 short *si_next_list; /* nextgroup IDs after this item ends */
|
|
296 reg_extmatch_T *si_extmatch; /* \z(...\) matches from start
|
|
297 * pattern */
|
|
298 } stateitem_T;
|
|
299
|
|
300 #define KEYWORD_IDX -1 /* value of si_idx for keywords */
|
|
301 #define ID_LIST_ALL (short *)-1 /* valid of si_cont_list for containing all
|
|
302 but contained groups */
|
|
303
|
|
304 /*
|
154
|
305 * Struct to reduce the number of arguments to get_syn_options(), it's used
|
|
306 * very often.
|
|
307 */
|
|
308 typedef struct
|
|
309 {
|
1222
|
310 int flags; /* flags for contained and transparent */
|
154
|
311 int keyword; /* TRUE for ":syn keyword" */
|
|
312 int *sync_idx; /* syntax item for "grouphere" argument, NULL
|
|
313 if not allowed */
|
|
314 char has_cont_list; /* TRUE if "cont_list" can be used */
|
|
315 short *cont_list; /* group IDs for "contains" argument */
|
|
316 short *cont_in_list; /* group IDs for "containedin" argument */
|
|
317 short *next_list; /* group IDs for "nextgroup" argument */
|
|
318 } syn_opt_arg_T;
|
|
319
|
|
320 /*
|
7
|
321 * The next possible match in the current line for any pattern is remembered,
|
|
322 * to avoid having to try for a match in each column.
|
|
323 * If next_match_idx == -1, not tried (in this line) yet.
|
|
324 * If next_match_col == MAXCOL, no match found in this line.
|
|
325 * (All end positions have the column of the char after the end)
|
|
326 */
|
|
327 static int next_match_col; /* column for start of next match */
|
|
328 static lpos_T next_match_m_endpos; /* position for end of next match */
|
|
329 static lpos_T next_match_h_startpos; /* pos. for highl. start of next match */
|
|
330 static lpos_T next_match_h_endpos; /* pos. for highl. end of next match */
|
|
331 static int next_match_idx; /* index of matched item */
|
|
332 static long next_match_flags; /* flags for next match */
|
|
333 static lpos_T next_match_eos_pos; /* end of start pattn (start region) */
|
|
334 static lpos_T next_match_eoe_pos; /* pos. for end of end pattern */
|
|
335 static int next_match_end_idx; /* ID of group for end pattn or zero */
|
|
336 static reg_extmatch_T *next_match_extmatch = NULL;
|
|
337
|
|
338 /*
|
|
339 * A state stack is an array of integers or stateitem_T, stored in a
|
|
340 * garray_T. A state stack is invalid if it's itemsize entry is zero.
|
|
341 */
|
|
342 #define INVALID_STATE(ssp) ((ssp)->ga_itemsize == 0)
|
|
343 #define VALID_STATE(ssp) ((ssp)->ga_itemsize != 0)
|
|
344
|
|
345 /*
|
|
346 * The current state (within the line) of the recognition engine.
|
|
347 * When current_state.ga_itemsize is 0 the current state is invalid.
|
|
348 */
|
|
349 static win_T *syn_win; /* current window for highlighting */
|
|
350 static buf_T *syn_buf; /* current buffer for highlighting */
|
|
351 static linenr_T current_lnum = 0; /* lnum of current state */
|
|
352 static colnr_T current_col = 0; /* column of current state */
|
|
353 static int current_state_stored = 0; /* TRUE if stored current state
|
|
354 * after setting current_finished */
|
|
355 static int current_finished = 0; /* current line has been finished */
|
|
356 static garray_T current_state /* current stack of state_items */
|
|
357 = {0, 0, 0, 0, NULL};
|
|
358 static short *current_next_list = NULL; /* when non-zero, nextgroup list */
|
|
359 static int current_next_flags = 0; /* flags for current_next_list */
|
|
360 static int current_line_id = 0; /* unique number for current line */
|
|
361
|
|
362 #define CUR_STATE(idx) ((stateitem_T *)(current_state.ga_data))[idx]
|
|
363
|
|
364 static void syn_sync __ARGS((win_T *wp, linenr_T lnum, synstate_T *last_valid));
|
|
365 static int syn_match_linecont __ARGS((linenr_T lnum));
|
|
366 static void syn_start_line __ARGS((void));
|
|
367 static void syn_update_ends __ARGS((int startofline));
|
|
368 static void syn_stack_alloc __ARGS((void));
|
|
369 static int syn_stack_cleanup __ARGS((void));
|
|
370 static void syn_stack_free_entry __ARGS((buf_T *buf, synstate_T *p));
|
|
371 static synstate_T *syn_stack_find_entry __ARGS((linenr_T lnum));
|
|
372 static synstate_T *store_current_state __ARGS((synstate_T *sp));
|
|
373 static void load_current_state __ARGS((synstate_T *from));
|
|
374 static void invalidate_current_state __ARGS((void));
|
|
375 static int syn_stack_equal __ARGS((synstate_T *sp));
|
|
376 static void validate_current_state __ARGS((void));
|
|
377 static int syn_finish_line __ARGS((int syncing));
|
221
|
378 static int syn_current_attr __ARGS((int syncing, int displaying, int *can_spell));
|
7
|
379 static int did_match_already __ARGS((int idx, garray_T *gap));
|
|
380 static stateitem_T *push_next_match __ARGS((stateitem_T *cur_si));
|
|
381 static void check_state_ends __ARGS((void));
|
|
382 static void update_si_attr __ARGS((int idx));
|
|
383 static void check_keepend __ARGS((void));
|
|
384 static void update_si_end __ARGS((stateitem_T *sip, int startcol, int force));
|
|
385 static short *copy_id_list __ARGS((short *list));
|
|
386 static int in_id_list __ARGS((stateitem_T *item, short *cont_list, struct sp_syn *ssp, int contained));
|
|
387 static int push_current_state __ARGS((int idx));
|
|
388 static void pop_current_state __ARGS((void));
|
|
389
|
|
390 static void find_endpos __ARGS((int idx, lpos_T *startpos, lpos_T *m_endpos, lpos_T *hl_endpos, long *flagsp, lpos_T *end_endpos, int *end_idx, reg_extmatch_T *start_ext));
|
|
391 static void clear_syn_state __ARGS((synstate_T *p));
|
|
392 static void clear_current_state __ARGS((void));
|
|
393
|
|
394 static void limit_pos __ARGS((lpos_T *pos, lpos_T *limit));
|
|
395 static void limit_pos_zero __ARGS((lpos_T *pos, lpos_T *limit));
|
|
396 static void syn_add_end_off __ARGS((lpos_T *result, regmmatch_T *regmatch, synpat_T *spp, int idx, int extra));
|
|
397 static void syn_add_start_off __ARGS((lpos_T *result, regmmatch_T *regmatch, synpat_T *spp, int idx, int extra));
|
|
398 static char_u *syn_getcurline __ARGS((void));
|
|
399 static int syn_regexec __ARGS((regmmatch_T *rmp, linenr_T lnum, colnr_T col));
|
|
400 static int check_keyword_id __ARGS((char_u *line, int startcol, int *endcol, long *flags, short **next_list, stateitem_T *cur_si));
|
|
401 static void syn_cmd_case __ARGS((exarg_T *eap, int syncing));
|
419
|
402 static void syn_cmd_spell __ARGS((exarg_T *eap, int syncing));
|
7
|
403 static void syntax_sync_clear __ARGS((void));
|
|
404 static void syn_remove_pattern __ARGS((buf_T *buf, int idx));
|
|
405 static void syn_clear_pattern __ARGS((buf_T *buf, int i));
|
|
406 static void syn_clear_cluster __ARGS((buf_T *buf, int i));
|
|
407 static void syn_cmd_clear __ARGS((exarg_T *eap, int syncing));
|
|
408 static void syn_clear_one __ARGS((int id, int syncing));
|
|
409 static void syn_cmd_on __ARGS((exarg_T *eap, int syncing));
|
|
410 static void syn_cmd_enable __ARGS((exarg_T *eap, int syncing));
|
|
411 static void syn_cmd_reset __ARGS((exarg_T *eap, int syncing));
|
|
412 static void syn_cmd_manual __ARGS((exarg_T *eap, int syncing));
|
|
413 static void syn_cmd_off __ARGS((exarg_T *eap, int syncing));
|
|
414 static void syn_cmd_onoff __ARGS((exarg_T *eap, char *name));
|
|
415 static void syn_cmd_list __ARGS((exarg_T *eap, int syncing));
|
|
416 static void syn_lines_msg __ARGS((void));
|
|
417 static void syn_match_msg __ARGS((void));
|
|
418 static void syn_list_one __ARGS((int id, int syncing, int link_only));
|
|
419 static void syn_list_cluster __ARGS((int id));
|
|
420 static void put_id_list __ARGS((char_u *name, short *list, int attr));
|
|
421 static void put_pattern __ARGS((char *s, int c, synpat_T *spp, int attr));
|
134
|
422 static int syn_list_keywords __ARGS((int id, hashtab_T *ht, int did_header, int attr));
|
|
423 static void syn_clear_keyword __ARGS((int id, hashtab_T *ht));
|
|
424 static void clear_keywtab __ARGS((hashtab_T *ht));
|
7
|
425 static void add_keyword __ARGS((char_u *name, int id, int flags, short *cont_in_list, short *next_list));
|
|
426 static char_u *get_group_name __ARGS((char_u *arg, char_u **name_end));
|
154
|
427 static char_u *get_syn_options __ARGS((char_u *arg, syn_opt_arg_T *opt));
|
7
|
428 static void syn_cmd_include __ARGS((exarg_T *eap, int syncing));
|
|
429 static void syn_cmd_keyword __ARGS((exarg_T *eap, int syncing));
|
|
430 static void syn_cmd_match __ARGS((exarg_T *eap, int syncing));
|
|
431 static void syn_cmd_region __ARGS((exarg_T *eap, int syncing));
|
|
432 #ifdef __BORLANDC__
|
|
433 static int _RTLENTRYF syn_compare_stub __ARGS((const void *v1, const void *v2));
|
|
434 #else
|
|
435 static int syn_compare_stub __ARGS((const void *v1, const void *v2));
|
|
436 #endif
|
|
437 static void syn_cmd_cluster __ARGS((exarg_T *eap, int syncing));
|
|
438 static int syn_scl_name2id __ARGS((char_u *name));
|
|
439 static int syn_scl_namen2id __ARGS((char_u *linep, int len));
|
|
440 static int syn_check_cluster __ARGS((char_u *pp, int len));
|
|
441 static int syn_add_cluster __ARGS((char_u *name));
|
|
442 static void init_syn_patterns __ARGS((void));
|
|
443 static char_u *get_syn_pattern __ARGS((char_u *arg, synpat_T *ci));
|
|
444 static void syn_cmd_sync __ARGS((exarg_T *eap, int syncing));
|
|
445 static int get_id_list __ARGS((char_u **arg, int keylen, short **list));
|
|
446 static void syn_combine_list __ARGS((short **clstr1, short **clstr2, int list_op));
|
|
447 static void syn_incl_toplevel __ARGS((int id, int *flagsp));
|
|
448
|
|
449 /*
|
|
450 * Start the syntax recognition for a line. This function is normally called
|
|
451 * from the screen updating, once for each displayed line.
|
|
452 * The buffer is remembered in syn_buf, because get_syntax_attr() doesn't get
|
|
453 * it. Careful: curbuf and curwin are likely to point to another buffer and
|
|
454 * window.
|
|
455 */
|
|
456 void
|
|
457 syntax_start(wp, lnum)
|
|
458 win_T *wp;
|
|
459 linenr_T lnum;
|
|
460 {
|
|
461 synstate_T *p;
|
|
462 synstate_T *last_valid = NULL;
|
|
463 synstate_T *last_min_valid = NULL;
|
|
464 synstate_T *sp, *prev;
|
|
465 linenr_T parsed_lnum;
|
|
466 linenr_T first_stored;
|
|
467 int dist;
|
26
|
468 static int changedtick = 0; /* remember the last change ID */
|
7
|
469
|
|
470 /*
|
|
471 * After switching buffers, invalidate current_state.
|
26
|
472 * Also do this when a change was made, the current state may be invalid
|
|
473 * then.
|
7
|
474 */
|
26
|
475 if (syn_buf != wp->w_buffer || changedtick != syn_buf->b_changedtick)
|
7
|
476 {
|
|
477 invalidate_current_state();
|
|
478 syn_buf = wp->w_buffer;
|
|
479 }
|
26
|
480 changedtick = syn_buf->b_changedtick;
|
7
|
481 syn_win = wp;
|
|
482
|
|
483 /*
|
|
484 * Allocate syntax stack when needed.
|
|
485 */
|
|
486 syn_stack_alloc();
|
|
487 if (syn_buf->b_sst_array == NULL)
|
410
|
488 return; /* out of memory */
|
7
|
489 syn_buf->b_sst_lasttick = display_tick;
|
|
490
|
|
491 /*
|
|
492 * If the state of the end of the previous line is useful, store it.
|
|
493 */
|
|
494 if (VALID_STATE(¤t_state)
|
|
495 && current_lnum < lnum
|
|
496 && current_lnum < syn_buf->b_ml.ml_line_count)
|
|
497 {
|
|
498 (void)syn_finish_line(FALSE);
|
|
499 if (!current_state_stored)
|
|
500 {
|
|
501 ++current_lnum;
|
|
502 (void)store_current_state(NULL);
|
|
503 }
|
|
504
|
|
505 /*
|
|
506 * If the current_lnum is now the same as "lnum", keep the current
|
|
507 * state (this happens very often!). Otherwise invalidate
|
|
508 * current_state and figure it out below.
|
|
509 */
|
|
510 if (current_lnum != lnum)
|
|
511 invalidate_current_state();
|
|
512 }
|
|
513 else
|
|
514 invalidate_current_state();
|
|
515
|
|
516 /*
|
|
517 * Try to synchronize from a saved state in b_sst_array[].
|
|
518 * Only do this if lnum is not before and not to far beyond a saved state.
|
|
519 */
|
|
520 if (INVALID_STATE(¤t_state) && syn_buf->b_sst_array != NULL)
|
|
521 {
|
|
522 /* Find last valid saved state before start_lnum. */
|
|
523 for (p = syn_buf->b_sst_first; p != NULL; p = p->sst_next)
|
|
524 {
|
|
525 if (p->sst_lnum > lnum)
|
|
526 break;
|
|
527 if (p->sst_lnum <= lnum && p->sst_change_lnum == 0)
|
|
528 {
|
|
529 last_valid = p;
|
|
530 if (p->sst_lnum >= lnum - syn_buf->b_syn_sync_minlines)
|
|
531 last_min_valid = p;
|
|
532 }
|
|
533 }
|
|
534 if (last_min_valid != NULL)
|
|
535 load_current_state(last_min_valid);
|
|
536 }
|
|
537
|
|
538 /*
|
|
539 * If "lnum" is before or far beyond a line with a saved state, need to
|
|
540 * re-synchronize.
|
|
541 */
|
|
542 if (INVALID_STATE(¤t_state))
|
|
543 {
|
|
544 syn_sync(wp, lnum, last_valid);
|
|
545 first_stored = current_lnum + syn_buf->b_syn_sync_minlines;
|
|
546 }
|
|
547 else
|
|
548 first_stored = current_lnum;
|
|
549
|
|
550 /*
|
|
551 * Advance from the sync point or saved state until the current line.
|
|
552 * Save some entries for syncing with later on.
|
|
553 */
|
819
|
554 if (syn_buf->b_sst_len <= Rows)
|
|
555 dist = 999999;
|
|
556 else
|
|
557 dist = syn_buf->b_ml.ml_line_count / (syn_buf->b_sst_len - Rows) + 1;
|
7
|
558 prev = syn_stack_find_entry(current_lnum);
|
|
559 while (current_lnum < lnum)
|
|
560 {
|
|
561 syn_start_line();
|
|
562 (void)syn_finish_line(FALSE);
|
|
563 ++current_lnum;
|
|
564
|
|
565 /* If we parsed at least "minlines" lines or started at a valid
|
|
566 * state, the current state is considered valid. */
|
|
567 if (current_lnum >= first_stored)
|
|
568 {
|
|
569 /* Check if the saved state entry is for the current line and is
|
|
570 * equal to the current state. If so, then validate all saved
|
|
571 * states that depended on a change before the parsed line. */
|
|
572 if (prev == NULL)
|
|
573 sp = syn_buf->b_sst_first;
|
|
574 else
|
|
575 sp = prev->sst_next;
|
|
576 if (sp != NULL
|
|
577 && sp->sst_lnum == current_lnum
|
|
578 && syn_stack_equal(sp))
|
|
579 {
|
|
580 parsed_lnum = current_lnum;
|
|
581 prev = sp;
|
|
582 while (sp != NULL && sp->sst_change_lnum <= parsed_lnum)
|
|
583 {
|
|
584 if (sp->sst_lnum <= lnum)
|
|
585 /* valid state before desired line, use this one */
|
|
586 prev = sp;
|
|
587 else if (sp->sst_change_lnum == 0)
|
|
588 /* past saved states depending on change, break here. */
|
|
589 break;
|
|
590 sp->sst_change_lnum = 0;
|
|
591 sp = sp->sst_next;
|
|
592 }
|
|
593 load_current_state(prev);
|
|
594 }
|
|
595 /* Store the state at this line when it's the first one, the line
|
|
596 * where we start parsing, or some distance from the previously
|
|
597 * saved state. But only when parsed at least 'minlines'. */
|
|
598 else if (prev == NULL
|
|
599 || current_lnum == lnum
|
|
600 || current_lnum >= prev->sst_lnum + dist)
|
|
601 prev = store_current_state(prev);
|
|
602 }
|
|
603
|
|
604 /* This can take a long time: break when CTRL-C pressed. The current
|
|
605 * state will be wrong then. */
|
|
606 line_breakcheck();
|
|
607 if (got_int)
|
|
608 {
|
|
609 current_lnum = lnum;
|
|
610 break;
|
|
611 }
|
|
612 }
|
|
613
|
|
614 syn_start_line();
|
|
615 }
|
|
616
|
|
617 /*
|
|
618 * We cannot simply discard growarrays full of state_items or buf_states; we
|
|
619 * have to manually release their extmatch pointers first.
|
|
620 */
|
|
621 static void
|
|
622 clear_syn_state(p)
|
|
623 synstate_T *p;
|
|
624 {
|
|
625 int i;
|
|
626 garray_T *gap;
|
|
627
|
|
628 if (p->sst_stacksize > SST_FIX_STATES)
|
|
629 {
|
|
630 gap = &(p->sst_union.sst_ga);
|
|
631 for (i = 0; i < gap->ga_len; i++)
|
|
632 unref_extmatch(SYN_STATE_P(gap)[i].bs_extmatch);
|
|
633 ga_clear(gap);
|
|
634 }
|
|
635 else
|
|
636 {
|
|
637 for (i = 0; i < p->sst_stacksize; i++)
|
|
638 unref_extmatch(p->sst_union.sst_stack[i].bs_extmatch);
|
|
639 }
|
|
640 }
|
|
641
|
|
642 /*
|
|
643 * Cleanup the current_state stack.
|
|
644 */
|
|
645 static void
|
|
646 clear_current_state()
|
|
647 {
|
|
648 int i;
|
|
649 stateitem_T *sip;
|
|
650
|
|
651 sip = (stateitem_T *)(current_state.ga_data);
|
|
652 for (i = 0; i < current_state.ga_len; i++)
|
|
653 unref_extmatch(sip[i].si_extmatch);
|
|
654 ga_clear(¤t_state);
|
|
655 }
|
|
656
|
|
657 /*
|
|
658 * Try to find a synchronisation point for line "lnum".
|
|
659 *
|
|
660 * This sets current_lnum and the current state. One of three methods is
|
|
661 * used:
|
|
662 * 1. Search backwards for the end of a C-comment.
|
|
663 * 2. Search backwards for given sync patterns.
|
|
664 * 3. Simply start on a given number of lines above "lnum".
|
|
665 */
|
|
666 static void
|
|
667 syn_sync(wp, start_lnum, last_valid)
|
|
668 win_T *wp;
|
|
669 linenr_T start_lnum;
|
|
670 synstate_T *last_valid;
|
|
671 {
|
|
672 buf_T *curbuf_save;
|
|
673 win_T *curwin_save;
|
|
674 pos_T cursor_save;
|
|
675 int idx;
|
|
676 linenr_T lnum;
|
|
677 linenr_T end_lnum;
|
|
678 linenr_T break_lnum;
|
|
679 int had_sync_point;
|
|
680 stateitem_T *cur_si;
|
|
681 synpat_T *spp;
|
|
682 char_u *line;
|
|
683 int found_flags = 0;
|
|
684 int found_match_idx = 0;
|
|
685 linenr_T found_current_lnum = 0;
|
|
686 int found_current_col= 0;
|
|
687 lpos_T found_m_endpos;
|
442
|
688 colnr_T prev_current_col;
|
7
|
689
|
|
690 /*
|
|
691 * Clear any current state that might be hanging around.
|
|
692 */
|
|
693 invalidate_current_state();
|
|
694
|
|
695 /*
|
|
696 * Start at least "minlines" back. Default starting point for parsing is
|
|
697 * there.
|
|
698 * Start further back, to avoid that scrolling backwards will result in
|
|
699 * resyncing for every line. Now it resyncs only one out of N lines,
|
|
700 * where N is minlines * 1.5, or minlines * 2 if minlines is small.
|
|
701 * Watch out for overflow when minlines is MAXLNUM.
|
|
702 */
|
|
703 if (syn_buf->b_syn_sync_minlines > start_lnum)
|
|
704 start_lnum = 1;
|
|
705 else
|
|
706 {
|
|
707 if (syn_buf->b_syn_sync_minlines == 1)
|
|
708 lnum = 1;
|
|
709 else if (syn_buf->b_syn_sync_minlines < 10)
|
|
710 lnum = syn_buf->b_syn_sync_minlines * 2;
|
|
711 else
|
|
712 lnum = syn_buf->b_syn_sync_minlines * 3 / 2;
|
|
713 if (syn_buf->b_syn_sync_maxlines != 0
|
|
714 && lnum > syn_buf->b_syn_sync_maxlines)
|
|
715 lnum = syn_buf->b_syn_sync_maxlines;
|
|
716 if (lnum >= start_lnum)
|
|
717 start_lnum = 1;
|
|
718 else
|
|
719 start_lnum -= lnum;
|
|
720 }
|
|
721 current_lnum = start_lnum;
|
|
722
|
|
723 /*
|
|
724 * 1. Search backwards for the end of a C-style comment.
|
|
725 */
|
|
726 if (syn_buf->b_syn_sync_flags & SF_CCOMMENT)
|
|
727 {
|
|
728 /* Need to make syn_buf the current buffer for a moment, to be able to
|
|
729 * use find_start_comment(). */
|
|
730 curwin_save = curwin;
|
|
731 curwin = wp;
|
|
732 curbuf_save = curbuf;
|
|
733 curbuf = syn_buf;
|
|
734
|
|
735 /*
|
|
736 * Skip lines that end in a backslash.
|
|
737 */
|
|
738 for ( ; start_lnum > 1; --start_lnum)
|
|
739 {
|
|
740 line = ml_get(start_lnum - 1);
|
|
741 if (*line == NUL || *(line + STRLEN(line) - 1) != '\\')
|
|
742 break;
|
|
743 }
|
|
744 current_lnum = start_lnum;
|
|
745
|
|
746 /* set cursor to start of search */
|
|
747 cursor_save = wp->w_cursor;
|
|
748 wp->w_cursor.lnum = start_lnum;
|
|
749 wp->w_cursor.col = 0;
|
|
750
|
|
751 /*
|
|
752 * If the line is inside a comment, need to find the syntax item that
|
|
753 * defines the comment.
|
|
754 * Restrict the search for the end of a comment to b_syn_sync_maxlines.
|
|
755 */
|
|
756 if (find_start_comment((int)syn_buf->b_syn_sync_maxlines) != NULL)
|
|
757 {
|
|
758 for (idx = syn_buf->b_syn_patterns.ga_len; --idx >= 0; )
|
|
759 if (SYN_ITEMS(syn_buf)[idx].sp_syn.id == syn_buf->b_syn_sync_id
|
|
760 && SYN_ITEMS(syn_buf)[idx].sp_type == SPTYPE_START)
|
|
761 {
|
|
762 validate_current_state();
|
|
763 if (push_current_state(idx) == OK)
|
|
764 update_si_attr(current_state.ga_len - 1);
|
|
765 break;
|
|
766 }
|
|
767 }
|
|
768
|
|
769 /* restore cursor and buffer */
|
|
770 wp->w_cursor = cursor_save;
|
|
771 curwin = curwin_save;
|
|
772 curbuf = curbuf_save;
|
|
773 }
|
|
774
|
|
775 /*
|
|
776 * 2. Search backwards for given sync patterns.
|
|
777 */
|
|
778 else if (syn_buf->b_syn_sync_flags & SF_MATCH)
|
|
779 {
|
|
780 if (syn_buf->b_syn_sync_maxlines != 0
|
|
781 && start_lnum > syn_buf->b_syn_sync_maxlines)
|
|
782 break_lnum = start_lnum - syn_buf->b_syn_sync_maxlines;
|
|
783 else
|
|
784 break_lnum = 0;
|
|
785
|
699
|
786 found_m_endpos.lnum = 0;
|
|
787 found_m_endpos.col = 0;
|
7
|
788 end_lnum = start_lnum;
|
|
789 lnum = start_lnum;
|
|
790 while (--lnum > break_lnum)
|
|
791 {
|
|
792 /* This can take a long time: break when CTRL-C pressed. */
|
|
793 line_breakcheck();
|
|
794 if (got_int)
|
|
795 {
|
|
796 invalidate_current_state();
|
|
797 current_lnum = start_lnum;
|
|
798 break;
|
|
799 }
|
|
800
|
|
801 /* Check if we have run into a valid saved state stack now. */
|
|
802 if (last_valid != NULL && lnum == last_valid->sst_lnum)
|
|
803 {
|
|
804 load_current_state(last_valid);
|
|
805 break;
|
|
806 }
|
|
807
|
|
808 /*
|
|
809 * Check if the previous line has the line-continuation pattern.
|
|
810 */
|
|
811 if (lnum > 1 && syn_match_linecont(lnum - 1))
|
|
812 continue;
|
|
813
|
|
814 /*
|
|
815 * Start with nothing on the state stack
|
|
816 */
|
|
817 validate_current_state();
|
|
818
|
|
819 for (current_lnum = lnum; current_lnum < end_lnum; ++current_lnum)
|
|
820 {
|
|
821 syn_start_line();
|
|
822 for (;;)
|
|
823 {
|
|
824 had_sync_point = syn_finish_line(TRUE);
|
|
825 /*
|
|
826 * When a sync point has been found, remember where, and
|
|
827 * continue to look for another one, further on in the line.
|
|
828 */
|
|
829 if (had_sync_point && current_state.ga_len)
|
|
830 {
|
|
831 cur_si = &CUR_STATE(current_state.ga_len - 1);
|
|
832 if (cur_si->si_m_endpos.lnum > start_lnum)
|
|
833 {
|
|
834 /* ignore match that goes to after where started */
|
|
835 current_lnum = end_lnum;
|
|
836 break;
|
|
837 }
|
|
838 spp = &(SYN_ITEMS(syn_buf)[cur_si->si_idx]);
|
|
839 found_flags = spp->sp_flags;
|
|
840 found_match_idx = spp->sp_sync_idx;
|
|
841 found_current_lnum = current_lnum;
|
|
842 found_current_col = current_col;
|
|
843 found_m_endpos = cur_si->si_m_endpos;
|
|
844 /*
|
|
845 * Continue after the match (be aware of a zero-length
|
|
846 * match).
|
|
847 */
|
|
848 if (found_m_endpos.lnum > current_lnum)
|
|
849 {
|
|
850 current_lnum = found_m_endpos.lnum;
|
|
851 current_col = found_m_endpos.col;
|
|
852 if (current_lnum >= end_lnum)
|
|
853 break;
|
|
854 }
|
|
855 else if (found_m_endpos.col > current_col)
|
|
856 current_col = found_m_endpos.col;
|
|
857 else
|
|
858 ++current_col;
|
|
859
|
|
860 /* syn_current_attr() will have skipped the check for
|
442
|
861 * an item that ends here, need to do that now. Be
|
|
862 * careful not to go past the NUL. */
|
|
863 prev_current_col = current_col;
|
|
864 if (syn_getcurline()[current_col] != NUL)
|
|
865 ++current_col;
|
7
|
866 check_state_ends();
|
442
|
867 current_col = prev_current_col;
|
7
|
868 }
|
|
869 else
|
|
870 break;
|
|
871 }
|
|
872 }
|
|
873
|
|
874 /*
|
|
875 * If a sync point was encountered, break here.
|
|
876 */
|
|
877 if (found_flags)
|
|
878 {
|
|
879 /*
|
|
880 * Put the item that was specified by the sync point on the
|
|
881 * state stack. If there was no item specified, make the
|
|
882 * state stack empty.
|
|
883 */
|
|
884 clear_current_state();
|
|
885 if (found_match_idx >= 0
|
|
886 && push_current_state(found_match_idx) == OK)
|
|
887 update_si_attr(current_state.ga_len - 1);
|
|
888
|
|
889 /*
|
|
890 * When using "grouphere", continue from the sync point
|
|
891 * match, until the end of the line. Parsing starts at
|
|
892 * the next line.
|
|
893 * For "groupthere" the parsing starts at start_lnum.
|
|
894 */
|
|
895 if (found_flags & HL_SYNC_HERE)
|
|
896 {
|
|
897 if (current_state.ga_len)
|
|
898 {
|
|
899 cur_si = &CUR_STATE(current_state.ga_len - 1);
|
|
900 cur_si->si_h_startpos.lnum = found_current_lnum;
|
|
901 cur_si->si_h_startpos.col = found_current_col;
|
|
902 update_si_end(cur_si, (int)current_col, TRUE);
|
|
903 check_keepend();
|
|
904 }
|
|
905 current_col = found_m_endpos.col;
|
|
906 current_lnum = found_m_endpos.lnum;
|
|
907 (void)syn_finish_line(FALSE);
|
|
908 ++current_lnum;
|
|
909 }
|
|
910 else
|
|
911 current_lnum = start_lnum;
|
|
912
|
|
913 break;
|
|
914 }
|
|
915
|
|
916 end_lnum = lnum;
|
|
917 invalidate_current_state();
|
|
918 }
|
|
919
|
|
920 /* Ran into start of the file or exceeded maximum number of lines */
|
|
921 if (lnum <= break_lnum)
|
|
922 {
|
|
923 invalidate_current_state();
|
|
924 current_lnum = break_lnum + 1;
|
|
925 }
|
|
926 }
|
|
927
|
|
928 validate_current_state();
|
|
929 }
|
|
930
|
|
931 /*
|
|
932 * Return TRUE if the line-continuation pattern matches in line "lnum".
|
|
933 */
|
|
934 static int
|
|
935 syn_match_linecont(lnum)
|
|
936 linenr_T lnum;
|
|
937 {
|
|
938 regmmatch_T regmatch;
|
|
939
|
|
940 if (syn_buf->b_syn_linecont_prog != NULL)
|
|
941 {
|
|
942 regmatch.rmm_ic = syn_buf->b_syn_linecont_ic;
|
|
943 regmatch.regprog = syn_buf->b_syn_linecont_prog;
|
|
944 return syn_regexec(®match, lnum, (colnr_T)0);
|
|
945 }
|
|
946 return FALSE;
|
|
947 }
|
|
948
|
|
949 /*
|
|
950 * Prepare the current state for the start of a line.
|
|
951 */
|
|
952 static void
|
|
953 syn_start_line()
|
|
954 {
|
|
955 current_finished = FALSE;
|
|
956 current_col = 0;
|
|
957
|
|
958 /*
|
|
959 * Need to update the end of a start/skip/end that continues from the
|
|
960 * previous line and regions that have "keepend".
|
|
961 */
|
|
962 if (current_state.ga_len > 0)
|
|
963 syn_update_ends(TRUE);
|
|
964
|
|
965 next_match_idx = -1;
|
|
966 ++current_line_id;
|
|
967 }
|
|
968
|
|
969 /*
|
|
970 * Check for items in the stack that need their end updated.
|
|
971 * When "startofline" is TRUE the last item is always updated.
|
|
972 * When "startofline" is FALSE the item with "keepend" is forcefully updated.
|
|
973 */
|
|
974 static void
|
|
975 syn_update_ends(startofline)
|
|
976 int startofline;
|
|
977 {
|
|
978 stateitem_T *cur_si;
|
|
979 int i;
|
991
|
980 int seen_keepend;
|
7
|
981
|
|
982 if (startofline)
|
|
983 {
|
|
984 /* Check for a match carried over from a previous line with a
|
|
985 * contained region. The match ends as soon as the region ends. */
|
|
986 for (i = 0; i < current_state.ga_len; ++i)
|
|
987 {
|
|
988 cur_si = &CUR_STATE(i);
|
|
989 if (cur_si->si_idx >= 0
|
|
990 && (SYN_ITEMS(syn_buf)[cur_si->si_idx]).sp_type
|
|
991 == SPTYPE_MATCH
|
|
992 && cur_si->si_m_endpos.lnum < current_lnum)
|
|
993 {
|
|
994 cur_si->si_flags |= HL_MATCHCONT;
|
|
995 cur_si->si_m_endpos.lnum = 0;
|
|
996 cur_si->si_m_endpos.col = 0;
|
|
997 cur_si->si_h_endpos = cur_si->si_m_endpos;
|
|
998 cur_si->si_ends = TRUE;
|
|
999 }
|
|
1000 }
|
|
1001 }
|
|
1002
|
|
1003 /*
|
|
1004 * Need to update the end of a start/skip/end that continues from the
|
|
1005 * previous line. And regions that have "keepend", because they may
|
991
|
1006 * influence contained items. If we've just removed "extend"
|
|
1007 * (startofline == 0) then we should update ends of normal regions
|
|
1008 * contained inside "keepend" because "extend" could have extended
|
|
1009 * these "keepend" regions as well as contained normal regions.
|
7
|
1010 * Then check for items ending in column 0.
|
|
1011 */
|
|
1012 i = current_state.ga_len - 1;
|
|
1013 if (keepend_level >= 0)
|
|
1014 for ( ; i > keepend_level; --i)
|
|
1015 if (CUR_STATE(i).si_flags & HL_EXTEND)
|
|
1016 break;
|
991
|
1017
|
|
1018 seen_keepend = FALSE;
|
7
|
1019 for ( ; i < current_state.ga_len; ++i)
|
|
1020 {
|
|
1021 cur_si = &CUR_STATE(i);
|
|
1022 if ((cur_si->si_flags & HL_KEEPEND)
|
991
|
1023 || (seen_keepend && !startofline)
|
7
|
1024 || (i == current_state.ga_len - 1 && startofline))
|
|
1025 {
|
|
1026 cur_si->si_h_startpos.col = 0; /* start highl. in col 0 */
|
|
1027 cur_si->si_h_startpos.lnum = current_lnum;
|
|
1028
|
|
1029 if (!(cur_si->si_flags & HL_MATCHCONT))
|
|
1030 update_si_end(cur_si, (int)current_col, !startofline);
|
991
|
1031
|
|
1032 if (!startofline && (cur_si->si_flags & HL_KEEPEND))
|
|
1033 seen_keepend = TRUE;
|
7
|
1034 }
|
|
1035 }
|
|
1036 check_keepend();
|
|
1037 check_state_ends();
|
|
1038 }
|
|
1039
|
|
1040 /****************************************
|
|
1041 * Handling of the state stack cache.
|
|
1042 */
|
|
1043
|
|
1044 /*
|
|
1045 * EXPLANATION OF THE SYNTAX STATE STACK CACHE
|
|
1046 *
|
|
1047 * To speed up syntax highlighting, the state stack for the start of some
|
|
1048 * lines is cached. These entries can be used to start parsing at that point.
|
|
1049 *
|
|
1050 * The stack is kept in b_sst_array[] for each buffer. There is a list of
|
|
1051 * valid entries. b_sst_first points to the first one, then follow sst_next.
|
|
1052 * The entries are sorted on line number. The first entry is often for line 2
|
|
1053 * (line 1 always starts with an empty stack).
|
|
1054 * There is also a list for free entries. This construction is used to avoid
|
|
1055 * having to allocate and free memory blocks too often.
|
|
1056 *
|
|
1057 * When making changes to the buffer, this is logged in b_mod_*. When calling
|
|
1058 * update_screen() to update the display, it will call
|
|
1059 * syn_stack_apply_changes() for each displayed buffer to adjust the cached
|
|
1060 * entries. The entries which are inside the changed area are removed,
|
|
1061 * because they must be recomputed. Entries below the changed have their line
|
|
1062 * number adjusted for deleted/inserted lines, and have their sst_change_lnum
|
|
1063 * set to indicate that a check must be made if the changed lines would change
|
|
1064 * the cached entry.
|
|
1065 *
|
|
1066 * When later displaying lines, an entry is stored for each line. Displayed
|
|
1067 * lines are likely to be displayed again, in which case the state at the
|
|
1068 * start of the line is needed.
|
|
1069 * For not displayed lines, an entry is stored for every so many lines. These
|
|
1070 * entries will be used e.g., when scrolling backwards. The distance between
|
|
1071 * entries depends on the number of lines in the buffer. For small buffers
|
|
1072 * the distance is fixed at SST_DIST, for large buffers there is a fixed
|
|
1073 * number of entries SST_MAX_ENTRIES, and the distance is computed.
|
|
1074 */
|
|
1075
|
|
1076 /*
|
|
1077 * Free b_sst_array[] for buffer "buf".
|
|
1078 * Used when syntax items changed to force resyncing everywhere.
|
|
1079 */
|
|
1080 void
|
|
1081 syn_stack_free_all(buf)
|
|
1082 buf_T *buf;
|
|
1083 {
|
|
1084 synstate_T *p;
|
|
1085 win_T *wp;
|
|
1086
|
|
1087 if (buf->b_sst_array != NULL)
|
|
1088 {
|
|
1089 for (p = buf->b_sst_first; p != NULL; p = p->sst_next)
|
|
1090 clear_syn_state(p);
|
|
1091 vim_free(buf->b_sst_array);
|
|
1092 buf->b_sst_array = NULL;
|
|
1093 buf->b_sst_len = 0;
|
|
1094 }
|
|
1095 #ifdef FEAT_FOLDING
|
|
1096 /* When using "syntax" fold method, must update all folds. */
|
|
1097 FOR_ALL_WINDOWS(wp)
|
|
1098 {
|
|
1099 if (wp->w_buffer == buf && foldmethodIsSyntax(wp))
|
|
1100 foldUpdateAll(wp);
|
|
1101 }
|
|
1102 #endif
|
|
1103 }
|
|
1104
|
|
1105 /*
|
|
1106 * Allocate the syntax state stack for syn_buf when needed.
|
|
1107 * If the number of entries in b_sst_array[] is much too big or a bit too
|
|
1108 * small, reallocate it.
|
|
1109 * Also used to allocate b_sst_array[] for the first time.
|
|
1110 */
|
|
1111 static void
|
|
1112 syn_stack_alloc()
|
|
1113 {
|
|
1114 long len;
|
|
1115 synstate_T *to, *from;
|
|
1116 synstate_T *sstp;
|
|
1117
|
|
1118 len = syn_buf->b_ml.ml_line_count / SST_DIST + Rows * 2;
|
|
1119 if (len < SST_MIN_ENTRIES)
|
|
1120 len = SST_MIN_ENTRIES;
|
|
1121 else if (len > SST_MAX_ENTRIES)
|
|
1122 len = SST_MAX_ENTRIES;
|
|
1123 if (syn_buf->b_sst_len > len * 2 || syn_buf->b_sst_len < len)
|
|
1124 {
|
|
1125 /* Allocate 50% too much, to avoid reallocating too often. */
|
|
1126 len = syn_buf->b_ml.ml_line_count;
|
|
1127 len = (len + len / 2) / SST_DIST + Rows * 2;
|
|
1128 if (len < SST_MIN_ENTRIES)
|
|
1129 len = SST_MIN_ENTRIES;
|
|
1130 else if (len > SST_MAX_ENTRIES)
|
|
1131 len = SST_MAX_ENTRIES;
|
|
1132
|
|
1133 if (syn_buf->b_sst_array != NULL)
|
|
1134 {
|
|
1135 /* When shrinking the array, cleanup the existing stack.
|
|
1136 * Make sure that all valid entries fit in the new array. */
|
|
1137 while (syn_buf->b_sst_len - syn_buf->b_sst_freecount + 2 > len
|
|
1138 && syn_stack_cleanup())
|
|
1139 ;
|
|
1140 if (len < syn_buf->b_sst_len - syn_buf->b_sst_freecount + 2)
|
|
1141 len = syn_buf->b_sst_len - syn_buf->b_sst_freecount + 2;
|
|
1142 }
|
|
1143
|
|
1144 sstp = (synstate_T *)alloc_clear((unsigned)(len * sizeof(synstate_T)));
|
|
1145 if (sstp == NULL) /* out of memory! */
|
|
1146 return;
|
|
1147
|
|
1148 to = sstp - 1;
|
|
1149 if (syn_buf->b_sst_array != NULL)
|
|
1150 {
|
|
1151 /* Move the states from the old array to the new one. */
|
|
1152 for (from = syn_buf->b_sst_first; from != NULL;
|
|
1153 from = from->sst_next)
|
|
1154 {
|
|
1155 ++to;
|
|
1156 *to = *from;
|
|
1157 to->sst_next = to + 1;
|
|
1158 }
|
|
1159 }
|
|
1160 if (to != sstp - 1)
|
|
1161 {
|
|
1162 to->sst_next = NULL;
|
|
1163 syn_buf->b_sst_first = sstp;
|
|
1164 syn_buf->b_sst_freecount = len - (int)(to - sstp) - 1;
|
|
1165 }
|
|
1166 else
|
|
1167 {
|
|
1168 syn_buf->b_sst_first = NULL;
|
|
1169 syn_buf->b_sst_freecount = len;
|
|
1170 }
|
|
1171
|
|
1172 /* Create the list of free entries. */
|
|
1173 syn_buf->b_sst_firstfree = to + 1;
|
|
1174 while (++to < sstp + len)
|
|
1175 to->sst_next = to + 1;
|
|
1176 (sstp + len - 1)->sst_next = NULL;
|
|
1177
|
|
1178 vim_free(syn_buf->b_sst_array);
|
|
1179 syn_buf->b_sst_array = sstp;
|
|
1180 syn_buf->b_sst_len = len;
|
|
1181 }
|
|
1182 }
|
|
1183
|
|
1184 /*
|
|
1185 * Check for changes in a buffer to affect stored syntax states. Uses the
|
|
1186 * b_mod_* fields.
|
|
1187 * Called from update_screen(), before screen is being updated, once for each
|
|
1188 * displayed buffer.
|
|
1189 */
|
|
1190 void
|
|
1191 syn_stack_apply_changes(buf)
|
|
1192 buf_T *buf;
|
|
1193 {
|
|
1194 synstate_T *p, *prev, *np;
|
|
1195 linenr_T n;
|
|
1196
|
|
1197 if (buf->b_sst_array == NULL) /* nothing to do */
|
|
1198 return;
|
|
1199
|
|
1200 prev = NULL;
|
|
1201 for (p = buf->b_sst_first; p != NULL; )
|
|
1202 {
|
383
|
1203 if (p->sst_lnum + buf->b_syn_sync_linebreaks > buf->b_mod_top)
|
7
|
1204 {
|
|
1205 n = p->sst_lnum + buf->b_mod_xlines;
|
|
1206 if (n <= buf->b_mod_bot)
|
|
1207 {
|
|
1208 /* this state is inside the changed area, remove it */
|
|
1209 np = p->sst_next;
|
|
1210 if (prev == NULL)
|
|
1211 buf->b_sst_first = np;
|
|
1212 else
|
|
1213 prev->sst_next = np;
|
|
1214 syn_stack_free_entry(buf, p);
|
|
1215 p = np;
|
|
1216 continue;
|
|
1217 }
|
|
1218 /* This state is below the changed area. Remember the line
|
|
1219 * that needs to be parsed before this entry can be made valid
|
|
1220 * again. */
|
|
1221 if (p->sst_change_lnum != 0 && p->sst_change_lnum > buf->b_mod_top)
|
|
1222 {
|
|
1223 if (p->sst_change_lnum + buf->b_mod_xlines > buf->b_mod_top)
|
|
1224 p->sst_change_lnum += buf->b_mod_xlines;
|
|
1225 else
|
|
1226 p->sst_change_lnum = buf->b_mod_top;
|
|
1227 }
|
|
1228 if (p->sst_change_lnum == 0
|
|
1229 || p->sst_change_lnum < buf->b_mod_bot)
|
|
1230 p->sst_change_lnum = buf->b_mod_bot;
|
|
1231
|
|
1232 p->sst_lnum = n;
|
|
1233 }
|
|
1234 prev = p;
|
|
1235 p = p->sst_next;
|
|
1236 }
|
|
1237 }
|
|
1238
|
|
1239 /*
|
|
1240 * Reduce the number of entries in the state stack for syn_buf.
|
|
1241 * Returns TRUE if at least one entry was freed.
|
|
1242 */
|
|
1243 static int
|
|
1244 syn_stack_cleanup()
|
|
1245 {
|
|
1246 synstate_T *p, *prev;
|
|
1247 disptick_T tick;
|
|
1248 int above;
|
|
1249 int dist;
|
|
1250 int retval = FALSE;
|
|
1251
|
|
1252 if (syn_buf->b_sst_array == NULL || syn_buf->b_sst_first == NULL)
|
|
1253 return retval;
|
|
1254
|
|
1255 /* Compute normal distance between non-displayed entries. */
|
819
|
1256 if (syn_buf->b_sst_len <= Rows)
|
|
1257 dist = 999999;
|
|
1258 else
|
|
1259 dist = syn_buf->b_ml.ml_line_count / (syn_buf->b_sst_len - Rows) + 1;
|
7
|
1260
|
|
1261 /*
|
|
1262 * Go throught the list to find the "tick" for the oldest entry that can
|
|
1263 * be removed. Set "above" when the "tick" for the oldest entry is above
|
|
1264 * "b_sst_lasttick" (the display tick wraps around).
|
|
1265 */
|
|
1266 tick = syn_buf->b_sst_lasttick;
|
|
1267 above = FALSE;
|
|
1268 prev = syn_buf->b_sst_first;
|
|
1269 for (p = prev->sst_next; p != NULL; prev = p, p = p->sst_next)
|
|
1270 {
|
|
1271 if (prev->sst_lnum + dist > p->sst_lnum)
|
|
1272 {
|
|
1273 if (p->sst_tick > syn_buf->b_sst_lasttick)
|
|
1274 {
|
|
1275 if (!above || p->sst_tick < tick)
|
|
1276 tick = p->sst_tick;
|
|
1277 above = TRUE;
|
|
1278 }
|
|
1279 else if (!above && p->sst_tick < tick)
|
|
1280 tick = p->sst_tick;
|
|
1281 }
|
|
1282 }
|
|
1283
|
|
1284 /*
|
|
1285 * Go through the list to make the entries for the oldest tick at an
|
|
1286 * interval of several lines.
|
|
1287 */
|
|
1288 prev = syn_buf->b_sst_first;
|
|
1289 for (p = prev->sst_next; p != NULL; prev = p, p = p->sst_next)
|
|
1290 {
|
|
1291 if (p->sst_tick == tick && prev->sst_lnum + dist > p->sst_lnum)
|
|
1292 {
|
|
1293 /* Move this entry from used list to free list */
|
|
1294 prev->sst_next = p->sst_next;
|
|
1295 syn_stack_free_entry(syn_buf, p);
|
|
1296 p = prev;
|
|
1297 retval = TRUE;
|
|
1298 }
|
|
1299 }
|
|
1300 return retval;
|
|
1301 }
|
|
1302
|
|
1303 /*
|
|
1304 * Free the allocated memory for a syn_state item.
|
|
1305 * Move the entry into the free list.
|
|
1306 */
|
|
1307 static void
|
|
1308 syn_stack_free_entry(buf, p)
|
|
1309 buf_T *buf;
|
|
1310 synstate_T *p;
|
|
1311 {
|
|
1312 clear_syn_state(p);
|
|
1313 p->sst_next = buf->b_sst_firstfree;
|
|
1314 buf->b_sst_firstfree = p;
|
|
1315 ++buf->b_sst_freecount;
|
|
1316 }
|
|
1317
|
|
1318 /*
|
|
1319 * Find an entry in the list of state stacks at or before "lnum".
|
|
1320 * Returns NULL when there is no entry or the first entry is after "lnum".
|
|
1321 */
|
|
1322 static synstate_T *
|
|
1323 syn_stack_find_entry(lnum)
|
|
1324 linenr_T lnum;
|
|
1325 {
|
|
1326 synstate_T *p, *prev;
|
|
1327
|
|
1328 prev = NULL;
|
|
1329 for (p = syn_buf->b_sst_first; p != NULL; prev = p, p = p->sst_next)
|
|
1330 {
|
|
1331 if (p->sst_lnum == lnum)
|
|
1332 return p;
|
|
1333 if (p->sst_lnum > lnum)
|
|
1334 break;
|
|
1335 }
|
|
1336 return prev;
|
|
1337 }
|
|
1338
|
|
1339 /*
|
|
1340 * Try saving the current state in b_sst_array[].
|
|
1341 * The current state must be valid for the start of the current_lnum line!
|
|
1342 */
|
|
1343 static synstate_T *
|
|
1344 store_current_state(sp)
|
|
1345 synstate_T *sp; /* at or before where state is to be saved or
|
|
1346 NULL */
|
|
1347 {
|
|
1348 int i;
|
|
1349 synstate_T *p;
|
|
1350 bufstate_T *bp;
|
|
1351 stateitem_T *cur_si;
|
|
1352
|
|
1353 if (sp == NULL)
|
|
1354 sp = syn_stack_find_entry(current_lnum);
|
|
1355
|
|
1356 /*
|
|
1357 * If the current state contains a start or end pattern that continues
|
|
1358 * from the previous line, we can't use it. Don't store it then.
|
|
1359 */
|
|
1360 for (i = current_state.ga_len - 1; i >= 0; --i)
|
|
1361 {
|
|
1362 cur_si = &CUR_STATE(i);
|
|
1363 if (cur_si->si_h_startpos.lnum >= current_lnum
|
|
1364 || cur_si->si_m_endpos.lnum >= current_lnum
|
|
1365 || cur_si->si_h_endpos.lnum >= current_lnum
|
|
1366 || (cur_si->si_end_idx
|
|
1367 && cur_si->si_eoe_pos.lnum >= current_lnum))
|
|
1368 break;
|
|
1369 }
|
|
1370 if (i >= 0)
|
|
1371 {
|
|
1372 if (sp != NULL)
|
|
1373 {
|
|
1374 /* find "sp" in the list and remove it */
|
|
1375 if (syn_buf->b_sst_first == sp)
|
|
1376 /* it's the first entry */
|
|
1377 syn_buf->b_sst_first = sp->sst_next;
|
|
1378 else
|
|
1379 {
|
|
1380 /* find the entry just before this one to adjust sst_next */
|
|
1381 for (p = syn_buf->b_sst_first; p != NULL; p = p->sst_next)
|
|
1382 if (p->sst_next == sp)
|
|
1383 break;
|
840
|
1384 if (p != NULL) /* just in case */
|
|
1385 p->sst_next = sp->sst_next;
|
7
|
1386 }
|
|
1387 syn_stack_free_entry(syn_buf, sp);
|
|
1388 sp = NULL;
|
|
1389 }
|
|
1390 }
|
|
1391 else if (sp == NULL || sp->sst_lnum != current_lnum)
|
|
1392 {
|
|
1393 /*
|
|
1394 * Add a new entry
|
|
1395 */
|
|
1396 /* If no free items, cleanup the array first. */
|
|
1397 if (syn_buf->b_sst_freecount == 0)
|
|
1398 {
|
|
1399 (void)syn_stack_cleanup();
|
|
1400 /* "sp" may have been moved to the freelist now */
|
|
1401 sp = syn_stack_find_entry(current_lnum);
|
|
1402 }
|
|
1403 /* Still no free items? Must be a strange problem... */
|
|
1404 if (syn_buf->b_sst_freecount == 0)
|
|
1405 sp = NULL;
|
|
1406 else
|
|
1407 {
|
|
1408 /* Take the first item from the free list and put it in the used
|
|
1409 * list, after *sp */
|
|
1410 p = syn_buf->b_sst_firstfree;
|
|
1411 syn_buf->b_sst_firstfree = p->sst_next;
|
|
1412 --syn_buf->b_sst_freecount;
|
|
1413 if (sp == NULL)
|
|
1414 {
|
|
1415 /* Insert in front of the list */
|
|
1416 p->sst_next = syn_buf->b_sst_first;
|
|
1417 syn_buf->b_sst_first = p;
|
|
1418 }
|
|
1419 else
|
|
1420 {
|
|
1421 /* insert in list after *sp */
|
|
1422 p->sst_next = sp->sst_next;
|
|
1423 sp->sst_next = p;
|
|
1424 }
|
|
1425 sp = p;
|
|
1426 sp->sst_stacksize = 0;
|
|
1427 sp->sst_lnum = current_lnum;
|
|
1428 }
|
|
1429 }
|
|
1430 if (sp != NULL)
|
|
1431 {
|
|
1432 /* When overwriting an existing state stack, clear it first */
|
|
1433 clear_syn_state(sp);
|
|
1434 sp->sst_stacksize = current_state.ga_len;
|
|
1435 if (current_state.ga_len > SST_FIX_STATES)
|
|
1436 {
|
|
1437 /* Need to clear it, might be something remaining from when the
|
|
1438 * length was less than SST_FIX_STATES. */
|
|
1439 ga_init2(&sp->sst_union.sst_ga, (int)sizeof(bufstate_T), 1);
|
|
1440 if (ga_grow(&sp->sst_union.sst_ga, current_state.ga_len) == FAIL)
|
|
1441 sp->sst_stacksize = 0;
|
|
1442 else
|
|
1443 sp->sst_union.sst_ga.ga_len = current_state.ga_len;
|
|
1444 bp = SYN_STATE_P(&(sp->sst_union.sst_ga));
|
|
1445 }
|
|
1446 else
|
|
1447 bp = sp->sst_union.sst_stack;
|
|
1448 for (i = 0; i < sp->sst_stacksize; ++i)
|
|
1449 {
|
|
1450 bp[i].bs_idx = CUR_STATE(i).si_idx;
|
|
1451 bp[i].bs_flags = CUR_STATE(i).si_flags;
|
|
1452 bp[i].bs_extmatch = ref_extmatch(CUR_STATE(i).si_extmatch);
|
|
1453 }
|
|
1454 sp->sst_next_flags = current_next_flags;
|
|
1455 sp->sst_next_list = current_next_list;
|
|
1456 sp->sst_tick = display_tick;
|
|
1457 sp->sst_change_lnum = 0;
|
|
1458 }
|
|
1459 current_state_stored = TRUE;
|
|
1460 return sp;
|
|
1461 }
|
|
1462
|
|
1463 /*
|
|
1464 * Copy a state stack from "from" in b_sst_array[] to current_state;
|
|
1465 */
|
|
1466 static void
|
|
1467 load_current_state(from)
|
|
1468 synstate_T *from;
|
|
1469 {
|
|
1470 int i;
|
|
1471 bufstate_T *bp;
|
|
1472
|
|
1473 clear_current_state();
|
|
1474 validate_current_state();
|
|
1475 keepend_level = -1;
|
|
1476 if (from->sst_stacksize
|
|
1477 && ga_grow(¤t_state, from->sst_stacksize) != FAIL)
|
|
1478 {
|
|
1479 if (from->sst_stacksize > SST_FIX_STATES)
|
|
1480 bp = SYN_STATE_P(&(from->sst_union.sst_ga));
|
|
1481 else
|
|
1482 bp = from->sst_union.sst_stack;
|
|
1483 for (i = 0; i < from->sst_stacksize; ++i)
|
|
1484 {
|
|
1485 CUR_STATE(i).si_idx = bp[i].bs_idx;
|
|
1486 CUR_STATE(i).si_flags = bp[i].bs_flags;
|
|
1487 CUR_STATE(i).si_extmatch = ref_extmatch(bp[i].bs_extmatch);
|
|
1488 if (keepend_level < 0 && (CUR_STATE(i).si_flags & HL_KEEPEND))
|
|
1489 keepend_level = i;
|
|
1490 CUR_STATE(i).si_ends = FALSE;
|
|
1491 CUR_STATE(i).si_m_lnum = 0;
|
|
1492 if (CUR_STATE(i).si_idx >= 0)
|
|
1493 CUR_STATE(i).si_next_list =
|
|
1494 (SYN_ITEMS(syn_buf)[CUR_STATE(i).si_idx]).sp_next_list;
|
|
1495 else
|
|
1496 CUR_STATE(i).si_next_list = NULL;
|
|
1497 update_si_attr(i);
|
|
1498 }
|
|
1499 current_state.ga_len = from->sst_stacksize;
|
|
1500 }
|
|
1501 current_next_list = from->sst_next_list;
|
|
1502 current_next_flags = from->sst_next_flags;
|
|
1503 current_lnum = from->sst_lnum;
|
|
1504 }
|
|
1505
|
|
1506 /*
|
|
1507 * Compare saved state stack "*sp" with the current state.
|
|
1508 * Return TRUE when they are equal.
|
|
1509 */
|
|
1510 static int
|
|
1511 syn_stack_equal(sp)
|
|
1512 synstate_T *sp;
|
|
1513 {
|
|
1514 int i, j;
|
|
1515 bufstate_T *bp;
|
|
1516 reg_extmatch_T *six, *bsx;
|
|
1517
|
|
1518 /* First a quick check if the stacks have the same size end nextlist. */
|
|
1519 if (sp->sst_stacksize == current_state.ga_len
|
|
1520 && sp->sst_next_list == current_next_list)
|
|
1521 {
|
|
1522 /* Need to compare all states on both stacks. */
|
|
1523 if (sp->sst_stacksize > SST_FIX_STATES)
|
|
1524 bp = SYN_STATE_P(&(sp->sst_union.sst_ga));
|
|
1525 else
|
|
1526 bp = sp->sst_union.sst_stack;
|
|
1527
|
|
1528 for (i = current_state.ga_len; --i >= 0; )
|
|
1529 {
|
|
1530 /* If the item has another index the state is different. */
|
|
1531 if (bp[i].bs_idx != CUR_STATE(i).si_idx)
|
|
1532 break;
|
|
1533 if (bp[i].bs_extmatch != CUR_STATE(i).si_extmatch)
|
|
1534 {
|
|
1535 /* When the extmatch pointers are different, the strings in
|
|
1536 * them can still be the same. Check if the extmatch
|
|
1537 * references are equal. */
|
|
1538 bsx = bp[i].bs_extmatch;
|
|
1539 six = CUR_STATE(i).si_extmatch;
|
|
1540 /* If one of the extmatch pointers is NULL the states are
|
|
1541 * different. */
|
|
1542 if (bsx == NULL || six == NULL)
|
|
1543 break;
|
|
1544 for (j = 0; j < NSUBEXP; ++j)
|
|
1545 {
|
|
1546 /* Check each referenced match string. They must all be
|
|
1547 * equal. */
|
|
1548 if (bsx->matches[j] != six->matches[j])
|
|
1549 {
|
|
1550 /* If the pointer is different it can still be the
|
|
1551 * same text. Compare the strings, ignore case when
|
|
1552 * the start item has the sp_ic flag set. */
|
|
1553 if (bsx->matches[j] == NULL
|
|
1554 || six->matches[j] == NULL)
|
|
1555 break;
|
|
1556 if ((SYN_ITEMS(syn_buf)[CUR_STATE(i).si_idx]).sp_ic
|
|
1557 ? MB_STRICMP(bsx->matches[j],
|
|
1558 six->matches[j]) != 0
|
|
1559 : STRCMP(bsx->matches[j], six->matches[j]) != 0)
|
|
1560 break;
|
|
1561 }
|
|
1562 }
|
|
1563 if (j != NSUBEXP)
|
|
1564 break;
|
|
1565 }
|
|
1566 }
|
|
1567 if (i < 0)
|
|
1568 return TRUE;
|
|
1569 }
|
|
1570 return FALSE;
|
|
1571 }
|
|
1572
|
|
1573 /*
|
|
1574 * We stop parsing syntax above line "lnum". If the stored state at or below
|
|
1575 * this line depended on a change before it, it now depends on the line below
|
|
1576 * the last parsed line.
|
|
1577 * The window looks like this:
|
|
1578 * line which changed
|
|
1579 * displayed line
|
|
1580 * displayed line
|
|
1581 * lnum -> line below window
|
|
1582 */
|
|
1583 void
|
|
1584 syntax_end_parsing(lnum)
|
|
1585 linenr_T lnum;
|
|
1586 {
|
|
1587 synstate_T *sp;
|
|
1588
|
|
1589 sp = syn_stack_find_entry(lnum);
|
|
1590 if (sp != NULL && sp->sst_lnum < lnum)
|
|
1591 sp = sp->sst_next;
|
|
1592
|
|
1593 if (sp != NULL && sp->sst_change_lnum != 0)
|
|
1594 sp->sst_change_lnum = lnum;
|
|
1595 }
|
|
1596
|
|
1597 /*
|
|
1598 * End of handling of the state stack.
|
|
1599 ****************************************/
|
|
1600
|
|
1601 static void
|
|
1602 invalidate_current_state()
|
|
1603 {
|
|
1604 clear_current_state();
|
|
1605 current_state.ga_itemsize = 0; /* mark current_state invalid */
|
|
1606 current_next_list = NULL;
|
|
1607 keepend_level = -1;
|
|
1608 }
|
|
1609
|
|
1610 static void
|
|
1611 validate_current_state()
|
|
1612 {
|
|
1613 current_state.ga_itemsize = sizeof(stateitem_T);
|
|
1614 current_state.ga_growsize = 3;
|
|
1615 }
|
|
1616
|
|
1617 /*
|
|
1618 * Return TRUE if the syntax at start of lnum changed since last time.
|
|
1619 * This will only be called just after get_syntax_attr() for the previous
|
|
1620 * line, to check if the next line needs to be redrawn too.
|
|
1621 */
|
|
1622 int
|
|
1623 syntax_check_changed(lnum)
|
|
1624 linenr_T lnum;
|
|
1625 {
|
|
1626 int retval = TRUE;
|
|
1627 synstate_T *sp;
|
|
1628
|
|
1629 /*
|
|
1630 * Check the state stack when:
|
|
1631 * - lnum is just below the previously syntaxed line.
|
|
1632 * - lnum is not before the lines with saved states.
|
|
1633 * - lnum is not past the lines with saved states.
|
|
1634 * - lnum is at or before the last changed line.
|
|
1635 */
|
|
1636 if (VALID_STATE(¤t_state) && lnum == current_lnum + 1)
|
|
1637 {
|
|
1638 sp = syn_stack_find_entry(lnum);
|
|
1639 if (sp != NULL && sp->sst_lnum == lnum)
|
|
1640 {
|
|
1641 /*
|
|
1642 * finish the previous line (needed when not all of the line was
|
|
1643 * drawn)
|
|
1644 */
|
|
1645 (void)syn_finish_line(FALSE);
|
|
1646
|
|
1647 /*
|
|
1648 * Compare the current state with the previously saved state of
|
|
1649 * the line.
|
|
1650 */
|
|
1651 if (syn_stack_equal(sp))
|
|
1652 retval = FALSE;
|
|
1653
|
|
1654 /*
|
|
1655 * Store the current state in b_sst_array[] for later use.
|
|
1656 */
|
|
1657 ++current_lnum;
|
|
1658 (void)store_current_state(NULL);
|
|
1659 }
|
|
1660 }
|
|
1661
|
|
1662 return retval;
|
|
1663 }
|
|
1664
|
|
1665 /*
|
|
1666 * Finish the current line.
|
|
1667 * This doesn't return any attributes, it only gets the state at the end of
|
|
1668 * the line. It can start anywhere in the line, as long as the current state
|
|
1669 * is valid.
|
|
1670 */
|
|
1671 static int
|
|
1672 syn_finish_line(syncing)
|
|
1673 int syncing; /* called for syncing */
|
|
1674 {
|
|
1675 stateitem_T *cur_si;
|
442
|
1676 colnr_T prev_current_col;
|
7
|
1677
|
|
1678 if (!current_finished)
|
|
1679 {
|
|
1680 while (!current_finished)
|
|
1681 {
|
221
|
1682 (void)syn_current_attr(syncing, FALSE, NULL);
|
7
|
1683 /*
|
|
1684 * When syncing, and found some item, need to check the item.
|
|
1685 */
|
|
1686 if (syncing && current_state.ga_len)
|
|
1687 {
|
|
1688 /*
|
|
1689 * Check for match with sync item.
|
|
1690 */
|
|
1691 cur_si = &CUR_STATE(current_state.ga_len - 1);
|
|
1692 if (cur_si->si_idx >= 0
|
|
1693 && (SYN_ITEMS(syn_buf)[cur_si->si_idx].sp_flags
|
|
1694 & (HL_SYNC_HERE|HL_SYNC_THERE)))
|
|
1695 return TRUE;
|
|
1696
|
|
1697 /* syn_current_attr() will have skipped the check for an item
|
442
|
1698 * that ends here, need to do that now. Be careful not to go
|
|
1699 * past the NUL. */
|
|
1700 prev_current_col = current_col;
|
|
1701 if (syn_getcurline()[current_col] != NUL)
|
|
1702 ++current_col;
|
7
|
1703 check_state_ends();
|
442
|
1704 current_col = prev_current_col;
|
7
|
1705 }
|
|
1706 ++current_col;
|
|
1707 }
|
|
1708 }
|
|
1709 return FALSE;
|
|
1710 }
|
|
1711
|
|
1712 /*
|
|
1713 * Return highlight attributes for next character.
|
|
1714 * Must first call syntax_start() once for the line.
|
|
1715 * "col" is normally 0 for the first use in a line, and increments by one each
|
|
1716 * time. It's allowed to skip characters and to stop before the end of the
|
|
1717 * line. But only a "col" after a previously used column is allowed.
|
221
|
1718 * When "can_spell" is not NULL set it to TRUE when spell-checking should be
|
|
1719 * done.
|
7
|
1720 */
|
|
1721 int
|
221
|
1722 get_syntax_attr(col, can_spell)
|
7
|
1723 colnr_T col;
|
221
|
1724 int *can_spell;
|
7
|
1725 {
|
|
1726 int attr = 0;
|
|
1727
|
|
1728 /* check for out of memory situation */
|
|
1729 if (syn_buf->b_sst_array == NULL)
|
|
1730 return 0;
|
|
1731
|
419
|
1732 /* After 'synmaxcol' the attribute is always zero. */
|
431
|
1733 if (syn_buf->b_p_smc > 0 && col >= (colnr_T)syn_buf->b_p_smc)
|
419
|
1734 {
|
|
1735 clear_current_state();
|
|
1736 #ifdef FEAT_EVAL
|
|
1737 current_id = 0;
|
|
1738 current_trans_id = 0;
|
|
1739 #endif
|
|
1740 return 0;
|
|
1741 }
|
|
1742
|
7
|
1743 /* Make sure current_state is valid */
|
|
1744 if (INVALID_STATE(¤t_state))
|
|
1745 validate_current_state();
|
|
1746
|
|
1747 /*
|
|
1748 * Skip from the current column to "col", get the attributes for "col".
|
|
1749 */
|
|
1750 while (current_col <= col)
|
|
1751 {
|
221
|
1752 attr = syn_current_attr(FALSE, TRUE, can_spell);
|
7
|
1753 ++current_col;
|
|
1754 }
|
|
1755
|
|
1756 return attr;
|
|
1757 }
|
|
1758
|
|
1759 /*
|
|
1760 * Get syntax attributes for current_lnum, current_col.
|
|
1761 */
|
|
1762 static int
|
221
|
1763 syn_current_attr(syncing, displaying, can_spell)
|
7
|
1764 int syncing; /* When 1: called for syncing */
|
|
1765 int displaying; /* result will be displayed */
|
221
|
1766 int *can_spell; /* return: do spell checking */
|
7
|
1767 {
|
|
1768 int syn_id;
|
|
1769 lpos_T endpos; /* was: char_u *endp; */
|
|
1770 lpos_T hl_startpos; /* was: int hl_startcol; */
|
|
1771 lpos_T hl_endpos;
|
|
1772 lpos_T eos_pos; /* end-of-start match (start region) */
|
|
1773 lpos_T eoe_pos; /* end-of-end pattern */
|
|
1774 int end_idx; /* group ID for end pattern */
|
|
1775 int idx;
|
|
1776 synpat_T *spp;
|
221
|
1777 stateitem_T *cur_si, *sip = NULL;
|
7
|
1778 int startcol;
|
|
1779 int endcol;
|
|
1780 long flags;
|
|
1781 short *next_list;
|
|
1782 int found_match; /* found usable match */
|
|
1783 static int try_next_column = FALSE; /* must try in next col */
|
|
1784 int do_keywords;
|
|
1785 regmmatch_T regmatch;
|
|
1786 lpos_T pos;
|
|
1787 int lc_col;
|
|
1788 reg_extmatch_T *cur_extmatch = NULL;
|
|
1789 char_u *line; /* current line. NOTE: becomes invalid after
|
|
1790 looking for a pattern match! */
|
|
1791
|
|
1792 /* variables for zero-width matches that have a "nextgroup" argument */
|
|
1793 int keep_next_list;
|
|
1794 int zero_width_next_list = FALSE;
|
|
1795 garray_T zero_width_next_ga;
|
|
1796
|
|
1797 /*
|
|
1798 * No character, no attributes! Past end of line?
|
|
1799 * Do try matching with an empty line (could be the start of a region).
|
|
1800 */
|
|
1801 line = syn_getcurline();
|
|
1802 if (line[current_col] == NUL && current_col != 0)
|
|
1803 {
|
|
1804 /*
|
|
1805 * If we found a match after the last column, use it.
|
|
1806 */
|
|
1807 if (next_match_idx >= 0 && next_match_col >= (int)current_col
|
|
1808 && next_match_col != MAXCOL)
|
|
1809 (void)push_next_match(NULL);
|
|
1810
|
|
1811 current_finished = TRUE;
|
|
1812 current_state_stored = FALSE;
|
|
1813 return 0;
|
|
1814 }
|
|
1815
|
|
1816 /* if the current or next character is NUL, we will finish the line now */
|
|
1817 if (line[current_col] == NUL || line[current_col + 1] == NUL)
|
|
1818 {
|
|
1819 current_finished = TRUE;
|
|
1820 current_state_stored = FALSE;
|
|
1821 }
|
|
1822
|
|
1823 /*
|
|
1824 * When in the previous column there was a match but it could not be used
|
|
1825 * (empty match or already matched in this column) need to try again in
|
|
1826 * the next column.
|
|
1827 */
|
|
1828 if (try_next_column)
|
|
1829 {
|
|
1830 next_match_idx = -1;
|
|
1831 try_next_column = FALSE;
|
|
1832 }
|
|
1833
|
|
1834 /* Only check for keywords when not syncing and there are some. */
|
|
1835 do_keywords = !syncing
|
134
|
1836 && (syn_buf->b_keywtab.ht_used > 0
|
|
1837 || syn_buf->b_keywtab_ic.ht_used > 0);
|
7
|
1838
|
|
1839 /* Init the list of zero-width matches with a nextlist. This is used to
|
|
1840 * avoid matching the same item in the same position twice. */
|
|
1841 ga_init2(&zero_width_next_ga, (int)sizeof(int), 10);
|
|
1842
|
|
1843 /*
|
|
1844 * Repeat matching keywords and patterns, to find contained items at the
|
|
1845 * same column. This stops when there are no extra matches at the current
|
|
1846 * column.
|
|
1847 */
|
|
1848 do
|
|
1849 {
|
|
1850 found_match = FALSE;
|
|
1851 keep_next_list = FALSE;
|
|
1852 syn_id = 0;
|
|
1853
|
|
1854 /*
|
|
1855 * 1. Check for a current state.
|
|
1856 * Only when there is no current state, or if the current state may
|
|
1857 * contain other things, we need to check for keywords and patterns.
|
|
1858 * Always need to check for contained items if some item has the
|
|
1859 * "containedin" argument (takes extra time!).
|
|
1860 */
|
|
1861 if (current_state.ga_len)
|
|
1862 cur_si = &CUR_STATE(current_state.ga_len - 1);
|
|
1863 else
|
|
1864 cur_si = NULL;
|
|
1865
|
|
1866 if (syn_buf->b_syn_containedin || cur_si == NULL
|
|
1867 || cur_si->si_cont_list != NULL)
|
|
1868 {
|
|
1869 /*
|
|
1870 * 2. Check for keywords, if on a keyword char after a non-keyword
|
|
1871 * char. Don't do this when syncing.
|
|
1872 */
|
|
1873 if (do_keywords)
|
|
1874 {
|
|
1875 line = syn_getcurline();
|
|
1876 if (vim_iswordc_buf(line + current_col, syn_buf)
|
|
1877 && (current_col == 0
|
|
1878 || !vim_iswordc_buf(line + current_col - 1
|
|
1879 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
|
|
1880 - (has_mbyte
|
|
1881 ? (*mb_head_off)(line, line + current_col - 1)
|
|
1882 : 0)
|
|
1883 #endif
|
|
1884 , syn_buf)))
|
|
1885 {
|
|
1886 syn_id = check_keyword_id(line, (int)current_col,
|
|
1887 &endcol, &flags, &next_list, cur_si);
|
205
|
1888 if (syn_id != 0)
|
7
|
1889 {
|
|
1890 if (push_current_state(KEYWORD_IDX) == OK)
|
|
1891 {
|
|
1892 cur_si = &CUR_STATE(current_state.ga_len - 1);
|
|
1893 cur_si->si_m_startcol = current_col;
|
|
1894 cur_si->si_h_startpos.lnum = current_lnum;
|
|
1895 cur_si->si_h_startpos.col = 0; /* starts right away */
|
|
1896 cur_si->si_m_endpos.lnum = current_lnum;
|
|
1897 cur_si->si_m_endpos.col = endcol;
|
|
1898 cur_si->si_h_endpos.lnum = current_lnum;
|
|
1899 cur_si->si_h_endpos.col = endcol;
|
|
1900 cur_si->si_ends = TRUE;
|
|
1901 cur_si->si_end_idx = 0;
|
|
1902 cur_si->si_flags = flags;
|
|
1903 cur_si->si_id = syn_id;
|
|
1904 cur_si->si_trans_id = syn_id;
|
|
1905 if (flags & HL_TRANSP)
|
|
1906 {
|
|
1907 if (current_state.ga_len < 2)
|
|
1908 {
|
|
1909 cur_si->si_attr = 0;
|
|
1910 cur_si->si_trans_id = 0;
|
|
1911 }
|
|
1912 else
|
|
1913 {
|
|
1914 cur_si->si_attr = CUR_STATE(
|
|
1915 current_state.ga_len - 2).si_attr;
|
|
1916 cur_si->si_trans_id = CUR_STATE(
|
|
1917 current_state.ga_len - 2).si_trans_id;
|
|
1918 }
|
|
1919 }
|
|
1920 else
|
|
1921 cur_si->si_attr = syn_id2attr(syn_id);
|
|
1922 cur_si->si_cont_list = NULL;
|
|
1923 cur_si->si_next_list = next_list;
|
|
1924 check_keepend();
|
|
1925 }
|
|
1926 else
|
|
1927 vim_free(next_list);
|
|
1928 }
|
|
1929 }
|
|
1930 }
|
|
1931
|
|
1932 /*
|
205
|
1933 * 3. Check for patterns (only if no keyword found).
|
7
|
1934 */
|
|
1935 if (syn_id == 0 && syn_buf->b_syn_patterns.ga_len)
|
|
1936 {
|
|
1937 /*
|
|
1938 * If we didn't check for a match yet, or we are past it, check
|
|
1939 * for any match with a pattern.
|
|
1940 */
|
|
1941 if (next_match_idx < 0 || next_match_col < (int)current_col)
|
|
1942 {
|
|
1943 /*
|
|
1944 * Check all relevant patterns for a match at this
|
|
1945 * position. This is complicated, because matching with a
|
|
1946 * pattern takes quite a bit of time, thus we want to
|
|
1947 * avoid doing it when it's not needed.
|
|
1948 */
|
|
1949 next_match_idx = 0; /* no match in this line yet */
|
|
1950 next_match_col = MAXCOL;
|
|
1951 for (idx = syn_buf->b_syn_patterns.ga_len; --idx >= 0; )
|
|
1952 {
|
|
1953 spp = &(SYN_ITEMS(syn_buf)[idx]);
|
|
1954 if ( spp->sp_syncing == syncing
|
|
1955 && (displaying || !(spp->sp_flags & HL_DISPLAY))
|
|
1956 && (spp->sp_type == SPTYPE_MATCH
|
|
1957 || spp->sp_type == SPTYPE_START)
|
|
1958 && (current_next_list != NULL
|
|
1959 ? in_id_list(NULL, current_next_list,
|
|
1960 &spp->sp_syn, 0)
|
|
1961 : (cur_si == NULL
|
|
1962 ? !(spp->sp_flags & HL_CONTAINED)
|
|
1963 : in_id_list(cur_si,
|
|
1964 cur_si->si_cont_list, &spp->sp_syn,
|
|
1965 spp->sp_flags & HL_CONTAINED))))
|
|
1966 {
|
|
1967 /* If we already tried matching in this line, and
|
|
1968 * there isn't a match before next_match_col, skip
|
|
1969 * this item. */
|
|
1970 if (spp->sp_line_id == current_line_id
|
|
1971 && spp->sp_startcol >= next_match_col)
|
|
1972 continue;
|
|
1973 spp->sp_line_id = current_line_id;
|
|
1974
|
|
1975 lc_col = current_col - spp->sp_offsets[SPO_LC_OFF];
|
|
1976 if (lc_col < 0)
|
|
1977 lc_col = 0;
|
|
1978
|
|
1979 regmatch.rmm_ic = spp->sp_ic;
|
|
1980 regmatch.regprog = spp->sp_prog;
|
|
1981 if (!syn_regexec(®match, current_lnum,
|
|
1982 (colnr_T)lc_col))
|
|
1983 {
|
|
1984 /* no match in this line, try another one */
|
|
1985 spp->sp_startcol = MAXCOL;
|
|
1986 continue;
|
|
1987 }
|
|
1988
|
|
1989 /*
|
|
1990 * Compute the first column of the match.
|
|
1991 */
|
|
1992 syn_add_start_off(&pos, ®match,
|
|
1993 spp, SPO_MS_OFF, -1);
|
|
1994 if (pos.lnum > current_lnum)
|
|
1995 {
|
|
1996 /* must have used end of match in a next line,
|
|
1997 * we can't handle that */
|
|
1998 spp->sp_startcol = MAXCOL;
|
|
1999 continue;
|
|
2000 }
|
|
2001 startcol = pos.col;
|
|
2002
|
|
2003 /* remember the next column where this pattern
|
|
2004 * matches in the current line */
|
|
2005 spp->sp_startcol = startcol;
|
|
2006
|
|
2007 /*
|
|
2008 * If a previously found match starts at a lower
|
|
2009 * column number, don't use this one.
|
|
2010 */
|
|
2011 if (startcol >= next_match_col)
|
|
2012 continue;
|
|
2013
|
|
2014 /*
|
|
2015 * If we matched this pattern at this position
|
|
2016 * before, skip it. Must retry in the next
|
|
2017 * column, because it may match from there.
|
|
2018 */
|
|
2019 if (did_match_already(idx, &zero_width_next_ga))
|
|
2020 {
|
|
2021 try_next_column = TRUE;
|
|
2022 continue;
|
|
2023 }
|
|
2024
|
|
2025 endpos.lnum = regmatch.endpos[0].lnum;
|
|
2026 endpos.col = regmatch.endpos[0].col;
|
|
2027
|
|
2028 /* Compute the highlight start. */
|
|
2029 syn_add_start_off(&hl_startpos, ®match,
|
|
2030 spp, SPO_HS_OFF, -1);
|
|
2031
|
|
2032 /* Compute the region start. */
|
|
2033 /* Default is to use the end of the match. */
|
|
2034 syn_add_end_off(&eos_pos, ®match,
|
|
2035 spp, SPO_RS_OFF, 0);
|
|
2036
|
|
2037 /*
|
|
2038 * Grab the external submatches before they get
|
|
2039 * overwritten. Reference count doesn't change.
|
|
2040 */
|
|
2041 unref_extmatch(cur_extmatch);
|
|
2042 cur_extmatch = re_extmatch_out;
|
|
2043 re_extmatch_out = NULL;
|
|
2044
|
|
2045 flags = 0;
|
|
2046 eoe_pos.lnum = 0; /* avoid warning */
|
|
2047 eoe_pos.col = 0;
|
|
2048 end_idx = 0;
|
|
2049 hl_endpos.lnum = 0;
|
|
2050
|
|
2051 /*
|
|
2052 * For a "oneline" the end must be found in the
|
|
2053 * same line too. Search for it after the end of
|
|
2054 * the match with the start pattern. Set the
|
|
2055 * resulting end positions at the same time.
|
|
2056 */
|
|
2057 if (spp->sp_type == SPTYPE_START
|
|
2058 && (spp->sp_flags & HL_ONELINE))
|
|
2059 {
|
|
2060 lpos_T startpos;
|
|
2061
|
|
2062 startpos = endpos;
|
|
2063 find_endpos(idx, &startpos, &endpos, &hl_endpos,
|
|
2064 &flags, &eoe_pos, &end_idx, cur_extmatch);
|
|
2065 if (endpos.lnum == 0)
|
|
2066 continue; /* not found */
|
|
2067 }
|
|
2068
|
|
2069 /*
|
|
2070 * For a "match" the size must be > 0 after the
|
|
2071 * end offset needs has been added. Except when
|
|
2072 * syncing.
|
|
2073 */
|
|
2074 else if (spp->sp_type == SPTYPE_MATCH)
|
|
2075 {
|
|
2076 syn_add_end_off(&hl_endpos, ®match, spp,
|
|
2077 SPO_HE_OFF, 0);
|
|
2078 syn_add_end_off(&endpos, ®match, spp,
|
|
2079 SPO_ME_OFF, 0);
|
|
2080 if (endpos.lnum == current_lnum
|
|
2081 && (int)endpos.col + syncing < startcol)
|
|
2082 {
|
|
2083 /*
|
|
2084 * If an empty string is matched, may need
|
|
2085 * to try matching again at next column.
|
|
2086 */
|
|
2087 if (regmatch.startpos[0].col
|
|
2088 == regmatch.endpos[0].col)
|
|
2089 try_next_column = TRUE;
|
|
2090 continue;
|
|
2091 }
|
|
2092 }
|
|
2093
|
|
2094 /*
|
|
2095 * keep the best match so far in next_match_*
|
|
2096 */
|
|
2097 /* Highlighting must start after startpos and end
|
|
2098 * before endpos. */
|
|
2099 if (hl_startpos.lnum == current_lnum
|
|
2100 && (int)hl_startpos.col < startcol)
|
|
2101 hl_startpos.col = startcol;
|
|
2102 limit_pos_zero(&hl_endpos, &endpos);
|
|
2103
|
|
2104 next_match_idx = idx;
|
|
2105 next_match_col = startcol;
|
|
2106 next_match_m_endpos = endpos;
|
|
2107 next_match_h_endpos = hl_endpos;
|
|
2108 next_match_h_startpos = hl_startpos;
|
|
2109 next_match_flags = flags;
|
|
2110 next_match_eos_pos = eos_pos;
|
|
2111 next_match_eoe_pos = eoe_pos;
|
|
2112 next_match_end_idx = end_idx;
|
|
2113 unref_extmatch(next_match_extmatch);
|
|
2114 next_match_extmatch = cur_extmatch;
|
|
2115 cur_extmatch = NULL;
|
|
2116 }
|
|
2117 }
|
|
2118 }
|
|
2119
|
|
2120 /*
|
|
2121 * If we found a match at the current column, use it.
|
|
2122 */
|
|
2123 if (next_match_idx >= 0 && next_match_col == (int)current_col)
|
|
2124 {
|
|
2125 synpat_T *lspp;
|
|
2126
|
|
2127 /* When a zero-width item matched which has a nextgroup,
|
|
2128 * don't push the item but set nextgroup. */
|
|
2129 lspp = &(SYN_ITEMS(syn_buf)[next_match_idx]);
|
|
2130 if (next_match_m_endpos.lnum == current_lnum
|
|
2131 && next_match_m_endpos.col == current_col
|
|
2132 && lspp->sp_next_list != NULL)
|
|
2133 {
|
|
2134 current_next_list = lspp->sp_next_list;
|
|
2135 current_next_flags = lspp->sp_flags;
|
|
2136 keep_next_list = TRUE;
|
|
2137 zero_width_next_list = TRUE;
|
|
2138
|
|
2139 /* Add the index to a list, so that we can check
|
|
2140 * later that we don't match it again (and cause an
|
|
2141 * endless loop). */
|
|
2142 if (ga_grow(&zero_width_next_ga, 1) == OK)
|
|
2143 {
|
|
2144 ((int *)(zero_width_next_ga.ga_data))
|
|
2145 [zero_width_next_ga.ga_len++] = next_match_idx;
|
|
2146 }
|
|
2147 next_match_idx = -1;
|
|
2148 }
|
|
2149 else
|
|
2150 cur_si = push_next_match(cur_si);
|
|
2151 found_match = TRUE;
|
|
2152 }
|
|
2153 }
|
|
2154 }
|
|
2155
|
|
2156 /*
|
|
2157 * Handle searching for nextgroup match.
|
|
2158 */
|
|
2159 if (current_next_list != NULL && !keep_next_list)
|
|
2160 {
|
|
2161 /*
|
|
2162 * If a nextgroup was not found, continue looking for one if:
|
|
2163 * - this is an empty line and the "skipempty" option was given
|
|
2164 * - we are on white space and the "skipwhite" option was given
|
|
2165 */
|
|
2166 if (!found_match)
|
|
2167 {
|
|
2168 line = syn_getcurline();
|
|
2169 if (((current_next_flags & HL_SKIPWHITE)
|
|
2170 && vim_iswhite(line[current_col]))
|
|
2171 || ((current_next_flags & HL_SKIPEMPTY)
|
|
2172 && *line == NUL))
|
|
2173 break;
|
|
2174 }
|
|
2175
|
|
2176 /*
|
|
2177 * If a nextgroup was found: Use it, and continue looking for
|
|
2178 * contained matches.
|
|
2179 * If a nextgroup was not found: Continue looking for a normal
|
|
2180 * match.
|
|
2181 * When did set current_next_list for a zero-width item and no
|
|
2182 * match was found don't loop (would get stuck).
|
|
2183 */
|
|
2184 current_next_list = NULL;
|
|
2185 next_match_idx = -1;
|
|
2186 if (!zero_width_next_list)
|
|
2187 found_match = TRUE;
|
|
2188 }
|
|
2189
|
|
2190 } while (found_match);
|
|
2191
|
|
2192 /*
|
|
2193 * Use attributes from the current state, if within its highlighting.
|
|
2194 * If not, use attributes from the current-but-one state, etc.
|
|
2195 */
|
|
2196 current_attr = 0;
|
|
2197 #ifdef FEAT_EVAL
|
|
2198 current_id = 0;
|
|
2199 current_trans_id = 0;
|
|
2200 #endif
|
|
2201 if (cur_si != NULL)
|
|
2202 {
|
221
|
2203 #ifndef FEAT_EVAL
|
|
2204 int current_trans_id = 0;
|
|
2205 #endif
|
7
|
2206 for (idx = current_state.ga_len - 1; idx >= 0; --idx)
|
|
2207 {
|
|
2208 sip = &CUR_STATE(idx);
|
|
2209 if ((current_lnum > sip->si_h_startpos.lnum
|
|
2210 || (current_lnum == sip->si_h_startpos.lnum
|
|
2211 && current_col >= sip->si_h_startpos.col))
|
|
2212 && (sip->si_h_endpos.lnum == 0
|
|
2213 || current_lnum < sip->si_h_endpos.lnum
|
|
2214 || (current_lnum == sip->si_h_endpos.lnum
|
|
2215 && current_col < sip->si_h_endpos.col)))
|
|
2216 {
|
|
2217 current_attr = sip->si_attr;
|
|
2218 #ifdef FEAT_EVAL
|
|
2219 current_id = sip->si_id;
|
221
|
2220 #endif
|
7
|
2221 current_trans_id = sip->si_trans_id;
|
|
2222 break;
|
|
2223 }
|
|
2224 }
|
|
2225
|
221
|
2226 if (can_spell != NULL)
|
|
2227 {
|
|
2228 struct sp_syn sps;
|
|
2229
|
|
2230 /*
|
|
2231 * set "can_spell" to TRUE if spell checking is supposed to be
|
|
2232 * done in the current item.
|
|
2233 */
|
|
2234 if (syn_buf->b_spell_cluster_id == 0)
|
227
|
2235 {
|
320
|
2236 /* There is no @Spell cluster: Do spelling for items without
|
|
2237 * @NoSpell cluster. */
|
227
|
2238 if (syn_buf->b_nospell_cluster_id == 0 || current_trans_id == 0)
|
419
|
2239 *can_spell = (syn_buf->b_syn_spell != SYNSPL_NOTOP);
|
227
|
2240 else
|
|
2241 {
|
|
2242 sps.inc_tag = 0;
|
|
2243 sps.id = syn_buf->b_nospell_cluster_id;
|
|
2244 sps.cont_in_list = NULL;
|
|
2245 *can_spell = !in_id_list(sip, sip->si_cont_list, &sps, 0);
|
|
2246 }
|
|
2247 }
|
221
|
2248 else
|
|
2249 {
|
320
|
2250 /* The @Spell cluster is defined: Do spelling in items with
|
419
|
2251 * the @Spell cluster. But not when @NoSpell is also there.
|
|
2252 * At the toplevel only spell check when ":syn spell toplevel"
|
|
2253 * was used. */
|
320
|
2254 if (current_trans_id == 0)
|
419
|
2255 *can_spell = (syn_buf->b_syn_spell == SYNSPL_TOP);
|
320
|
2256 else
|
|
2257 {
|
|
2258 sps.inc_tag = 0;
|
|
2259 sps.id = syn_buf->b_spell_cluster_id;
|
|
2260 sps.cont_in_list = NULL;
|
|
2261 *can_spell = in_id_list(sip, sip->si_cont_list, &sps, 0);
|
|
2262
|
|
2263 if (syn_buf->b_nospell_cluster_id != 0)
|
|
2264 {
|
|
2265 sps.id = syn_buf->b_nospell_cluster_id;
|
|
2266 if (in_id_list(sip, sip->si_cont_list, &sps, 0))
|
|
2267 *can_spell = FALSE;
|
|
2268 }
|
|
2269 }
|
221
|
2270 }
|
|
2271 }
|
|
2272
|
|
2273
|
7
|
2274 /*
|
|
2275 * Check for end of current state (and the states before it) at the
|
|
2276 * next column. Don't do this for syncing, because we would miss a
|
|
2277 * single character match.
|
|
2278 * First check if the current state ends at the current column. It
|
|
2279 * may be for an empty match and a containing item might end in the
|
|
2280 * current column.
|
|
2281 */
|
|
2282 if (!syncing)
|
|
2283 {
|
|
2284 check_state_ends();
|
442
|
2285 if (current_state.ga_len > 0
|
|
2286 && syn_getcurline()[current_col] != NUL)
|
7
|
2287 {
|
|
2288 ++current_col;
|
|
2289 check_state_ends();
|
|
2290 --current_col;
|
|
2291 }
|
|
2292 }
|
|
2293 }
|
221
|
2294 else if (can_spell != NULL)
|
419
|
2295 /* Default: Only do spelling when there is no @Spell cluster or when
|
|
2296 * ":syn spell toplevel" was used. */
|
|
2297 *can_spell = syn_buf->b_syn_spell == SYNSPL_DEFAULT
|
|
2298 ? (syn_buf->b_spell_cluster_id == 0)
|
|
2299 : (syn_buf->b_syn_spell == SYNSPL_TOP);
|
7
|
2300
|
|
2301 /* nextgroup ends at end of line, unless "skipnl" or "skipemtpy" present */
|
|
2302 if (current_next_list != NULL
|
|
2303 && syn_getcurline()[current_col + 1] == NUL
|
|
2304 && !(current_next_flags & (HL_SKIPNL | HL_SKIPEMPTY)))
|
|
2305 current_next_list = NULL;
|
|
2306
|
|
2307 if (zero_width_next_ga.ga_len > 0)
|
|
2308 ga_clear(&zero_width_next_ga);
|
|
2309
|
|
2310 /* No longer need external matches. But keep next_match_extmatch. */
|
|
2311 unref_extmatch(re_extmatch_out);
|
|
2312 re_extmatch_out = NULL;
|
|
2313 unref_extmatch(cur_extmatch);
|
|
2314
|
|
2315 return current_attr;
|
|
2316 }
|
|
2317
|
|
2318
|
|
2319 /*
|
|
2320 * Check if we already matched pattern "idx" at the current column.
|
|
2321 */
|
|
2322 static int
|
|
2323 did_match_already(idx, gap)
|
|
2324 int idx;
|
|
2325 garray_T *gap;
|
|
2326 {
|
|
2327 int i;
|
|
2328
|
|
2329 for (i = current_state.ga_len; --i >= 0; )
|
|
2330 if (CUR_STATE(i).si_m_startcol == (int)current_col
|
|
2331 && CUR_STATE(i).si_m_lnum == (int)current_lnum
|
|
2332 && CUR_STATE(i).si_idx == idx)
|
|
2333 return TRUE;
|
|
2334
|
|
2335 /* Zero-width matches with a nextgroup argument are not put on the syntax
|
|
2336 * stack, and can only be matched once anyway. */
|
|
2337 for (i = gap->ga_len; --i >= 0; )
|
|
2338 if (((int *)(gap->ga_data))[i] == idx)
|
|
2339 return TRUE;
|
|
2340
|
|
2341 return FALSE;
|
|
2342 }
|
|
2343
|
|
2344 /*
|
|
2345 * Push the next match onto the stack.
|
|
2346 */
|
|
2347 static stateitem_T *
|
|
2348 push_next_match(cur_si)
|
|
2349 stateitem_T *cur_si;
|
|
2350 {
|
|
2351 synpat_T *spp;
|
|
2352
|
|
2353 spp = &(SYN_ITEMS(syn_buf)[next_match_idx]);
|
|
2354
|
|
2355 /*
|
|
2356 * Push the item in current_state stack;
|
|
2357 */
|
|
2358 if (push_current_state(next_match_idx) == OK)
|
|
2359 {
|
|
2360 /*
|
|
2361 * If it's a start-skip-end type that crosses lines, figure out how
|
|
2362 * much it continues in this line. Otherwise just fill in the length.
|
|
2363 */
|
|
2364 cur_si = &CUR_STATE(current_state.ga_len - 1);
|
|
2365 cur_si->si_h_startpos = next_match_h_startpos;
|
|
2366 cur_si->si_m_startcol = current_col;
|
|
2367 cur_si->si_m_lnum = current_lnum;
|
|
2368 cur_si->si_flags = spp->sp_flags;
|
|
2369 cur_si->si_next_list = spp->sp_next_list;
|
|
2370 cur_si->si_extmatch = ref_extmatch(next_match_extmatch);
|
|
2371 if (spp->sp_type == SPTYPE_START && !(spp->sp_flags & HL_ONELINE))
|
|
2372 {
|
|
2373 /* Try to find the end pattern in the current line */
|
|
2374 update_si_end(cur_si, (int)(next_match_m_endpos.col), TRUE);
|
|
2375 check_keepend();
|
|
2376 }
|
|
2377 else
|
|
2378 {
|
|
2379 cur_si->si_m_endpos = next_match_m_endpos;
|
|
2380 cur_si->si_h_endpos = next_match_h_endpos;
|
|
2381 cur_si->si_ends = TRUE;
|
|
2382 cur_si->si_flags |= next_match_flags;
|
|
2383 cur_si->si_eoe_pos = next_match_eoe_pos;
|
|
2384 cur_si->si_end_idx = next_match_end_idx;
|
|
2385 }
|
|
2386 if (keepend_level < 0 && (cur_si->si_flags & HL_KEEPEND))
|
|
2387 keepend_level = current_state.ga_len - 1;
|
|
2388 check_keepend();
|
|
2389 update_si_attr(current_state.ga_len - 1);
|
|
2390
|
|
2391 /*
|
|
2392 * If the start pattern has another highlight group, push another item
|
|
2393 * on the stack for the start pattern.
|
|
2394 */
|
|
2395 if ( spp->sp_type == SPTYPE_START
|
|
2396 && spp->sp_syn_match_id != 0
|
|
2397 && push_current_state(next_match_idx) == OK)
|
|
2398 {
|
|
2399 cur_si = &CUR_STATE(current_state.ga_len - 1);
|
|
2400 cur_si->si_h_startpos = next_match_h_startpos;
|
|
2401 cur_si->si_m_startcol = current_col;
|
|
2402 cur_si->si_m_lnum = current_lnum;
|
|
2403 cur_si->si_m_endpos = next_match_eos_pos;
|
|
2404 cur_si->si_h_endpos = next_match_eos_pos;
|
|
2405 cur_si->si_ends = TRUE;
|
|
2406 cur_si->si_end_idx = 0;
|
|
2407 cur_si->si_flags = HL_MATCH;
|
|
2408 cur_si->si_next_list = NULL;
|
|
2409 check_keepend();
|
|
2410 update_si_attr(current_state.ga_len - 1);
|
|
2411 }
|
|
2412 }
|
|
2413
|
|
2414 next_match_idx = -1; /* try other match next time */
|
|
2415
|
|
2416 return cur_si;
|
|
2417 }
|
|
2418
|
|
2419 /*
|
|
2420 * Check for end of current state (and the states before it).
|
|
2421 */
|
|
2422 static void
|
|
2423 check_state_ends()
|
|
2424 {
|
|
2425 stateitem_T *cur_si;
|
|
2426 int had_extend = FALSE;
|
|
2427
|
|
2428 cur_si = &CUR_STATE(current_state.ga_len - 1);
|
|
2429 for (;;)
|
|
2430 {
|
|
2431 if (cur_si->si_ends
|
|
2432 && (cur_si->si_m_endpos.lnum < current_lnum
|
|
2433 || (cur_si->si_m_endpos.lnum == current_lnum
|
|
2434 && cur_si->si_m_endpos.col <= current_col)))
|
|
2435 {
|
|
2436 /*
|
|
2437 * If there is an end pattern group ID, highlight the end pattern
|
|
2438 * now. No need to pop the current item from the stack.
|
|
2439 * Only do this if the end pattern continues beyond the current
|
|
2440 * position.
|
|
2441 */
|
|
2442 if (cur_si->si_end_idx
|
|
2443 && (cur_si->si_eoe_pos.lnum > current_lnum
|
|
2444 || (cur_si->si_eoe_pos.lnum == current_lnum
|
|
2445 && cur_si->si_eoe_pos.col > current_col)))
|
|
2446 {
|
|
2447 cur_si->si_idx = cur_si->si_end_idx;
|
|
2448 cur_si->si_end_idx = 0;
|
|
2449 cur_si->si_m_endpos = cur_si->si_eoe_pos;
|
|
2450 cur_si->si_h_endpos = cur_si->si_eoe_pos;
|
|
2451 cur_si->si_flags |= HL_MATCH;
|
|
2452 update_si_attr(current_state.ga_len - 1);
|
36
|
2453
|
|
2454 /* what matches next may be different now, clear it */
|
|
2455 next_match_idx = 0;
|
|
2456 next_match_col = MAXCOL;
|
7
|
2457 break;
|
|
2458 }
|
|
2459 else
|
|
2460 {
|
|
2461 /* handle next_list, unless at end of line and no "skipnl" or
|
|
2462 * "skipempty" */
|
|
2463 current_next_list = cur_si->si_next_list;
|
|
2464 current_next_flags = cur_si->si_flags;
|
|
2465 if (!(current_next_flags & (HL_SKIPNL | HL_SKIPEMPTY))
|
|
2466 && syn_getcurline()[current_col] == NUL)
|
|
2467 current_next_list = NULL;
|
|
2468
|
|
2469 /* When the ended item has "extend", another item with
|
|
2470 * "keepend" now needs to check for its end. */
|
|
2471 if (cur_si->si_flags & HL_EXTEND)
|
|
2472 had_extend = TRUE;
|
|
2473
|
|
2474 pop_current_state();
|
|
2475
|
|
2476 if (current_state.ga_len == 0)
|
|
2477 break;
|
|
2478
|
|
2479 if (had_extend)
|
|
2480 {
|
|
2481 syn_update_ends(FALSE);
|
|
2482 if (current_state.ga_len == 0)
|
|
2483 break;
|
|
2484 }
|
|
2485
|
|
2486 cur_si = &CUR_STATE(current_state.ga_len - 1);
|
|
2487
|
|
2488 /*
|
|
2489 * Only for a region the search for the end continues after
|
|
2490 * the end of the contained item. If the contained match
|
|
2491 * included the end-of-line, break here, the region continues.
|
|
2492 * Don't do this when:
|
|
2493 * - "keepend" is used for the contained item
|
|
2494 * - not at the end of the line (could be end="x$"me=e-1).
|
|
2495 * - "excludenl" is used (HL_HAS_EOL won't be set)
|
|
2496 */
|
|
2497 if (cur_si->si_idx >= 0
|
|
2498 && SYN_ITEMS(syn_buf)[cur_si->si_idx].sp_type
|
|
2499 == SPTYPE_START
|
|
2500 && !(cur_si->si_flags & (HL_MATCH | HL_KEEPEND)))
|
|
2501 {
|
|
2502 update_si_end(cur_si, (int)current_col, TRUE);
|
|
2503 check_keepend();
|
|
2504 if ((current_next_flags & HL_HAS_EOL)
|
|
2505 && keepend_level < 0
|
|
2506 && syn_getcurline()[current_col] == NUL)
|
|
2507 break;
|
|
2508 }
|
|
2509 }
|
|
2510 }
|
|
2511 else
|
|
2512 break;
|
|
2513 }
|
|
2514 }
|
|
2515
|
|
2516 /*
|
|
2517 * Update an entry in the current_state stack for a match or region. This
|
|
2518 * fills in si_attr, si_next_list and si_cont_list.
|
|
2519 */
|
|
2520 static void
|
|
2521 update_si_attr(idx)
|
|
2522 int idx;
|
|
2523 {
|
|
2524 stateitem_T *sip = &CUR_STATE(idx);
|
|
2525 synpat_T *spp;
|
|
2526
|
|
2527 spp = &(SYN_ITEMS(syn_buf)[sip->si_idx]);
|
|
2528 if (sip->si_flags & HL_MATCH)
|
|
2529 sip->si_id = spp->sp_syn_match_id;
|
|
2530 else
|
|
2531 sip->si_id = spp->sp_syn.id;
|
|
2532 sip->si_attr = syn_id2attr(sip->si_id);
|
|
2533 sip->si_trans_id = sip->si_id;
|
|
2534 if (sip->si_flags & HL_MATCH)
|
|
2535 sip->si_cont_list = NULL;
|
|
2536 else
|
|
2537 sip->si_cont_list = spp->sp_cont_list;
|
|
2538
|
|
2539 /*
|
|
2540 * For transparent items, take attr from outer item.
|
|
2541 * Also take cont_list, if there is none.
|
|
2542 * Don't do this for the matchgroup of a start or end pattern.
|
|
2543 */
|
|
2544 if ((spp->sp_flags & HL_TRANSP) && !(sip->si_flags & HL_MATCH))
|
|
2545 {
|
|
2546 if (idx == 0)
|
|
2547 {
|
|
2548 sip->si_attr = 0;
|
|
2549 sip->si_trans_id = 0;
|
|
2550 if (sip->si_cont_list == NULL)
|
|
2551 sip->si_cont_list = ID_LIST_ALL;
|
|
2552 }
|
|
2553 else
|
|
2554 {
|
|
2555 sip->si_attr = CUR_STATE(idx - 1).si_attr;
|
|
2556 sip->si_trans_id = CUR_STATE(idx - 1).si_trans_id;
|
36
|
2557 sip->si_h_startpos = CUR_STATE(idx - 1).si_h_startpos;
|
|
2558 sip->si_h_endpos = CUR_STATE(idx - 1).si_h_endpos;
|
7
|
2559 if (sip->si_cont_list == NULL)
|
|
2560 {
|
|
2561 sip->si_flags |= HL_TRANS_CONT;
|
|
2562 sip->si_cont_list = CUR_STATE(idx - 1).si_cont_list;
|
|
2563 }
|
|
2564 }
|
|
2565 }
|
|
2566 }
|
|
2567
|
|
2568 /*
|
|
2569 * Check the current stack for patterns with "keepend" flag.
|
|
2570 * Propagate the match-end to contained items, until a "skipend" item is found.
|
|
2571 */
|
|
2572 static void
|
|
2573 check_keepend()
|
|
2574 {
|
|
2575 int i;
|
|
2576 lpos_T maxpos;
|
991
|
2577 lpos_T maxpos_h;
|
7
|
2578 stateitem_T *sip;
|
|
2579
|
|
2580 /*
|
|
2581 * This check can consume a lot of time; only do it from the level where
|
|
2582 * there really is a keepend.
|
|
2583 */
|
|
2584 if (keepend_level < 0)
|
|
2585 return;
|
|
2586
|
|
2587 /*
|
|
2588 * Find the last index of an "extend" item. "keepend" items before that
|
|
2589 * won't do anything. If there is no "extend" item "i" will be
|
|
2590 * "keepend_level" and all "keepend" items will work normally.
|
|
2591 */
|
|
2592 for (i = current_state.ga_len - 1; i > keepend_level; --i)
|
|
2593 if (CUR_STATE(i).si_flags & HL_EXTEND)
|
|
2594 break;
|
|
2595
|
|
2596 maxpos.lnum = 0;
|
991
|
2597 maxpos_h.lnum = 0;
|
7
|
2598 for ( ; i < current_state.ga_len; ++i)
|
|
2599 {
|
|
2600 sip = &CUR_STATE(i);
|
|
2601 if (maxpos.lnum != 0)
|
|
2602 {
|
|
2603 limit_pos_zero(&sip->si_m_endpos, &maxpos);
|
991
|
2604 limit_pos_zero(&sip->si_h_endpos, &maxpos_h);
|
7
|
2605 limit_pos_zero(&sip->si_eoe_pos, &maxpos);
|
|
2606 sip->si_ends = TRUE;
|
|
2607 }
|
991
|
2608 if (sip->si_ends && (sip->si_flags & HL_KEEPEND))
|
|
2609 {
|
|
2610 if (maxpos.lnum == 0
|
7
|
2611 || maxpos.lnum > sip->si_m_endpos.lnum
|
|
2612 || (maxpos.lnum == sip->si_m_endpos.lnum
|
991
|
2613 && maxpos.col > sip->si_m_endpos.col))
|
|
2614 maxpos = sip->si_m_endpos;
|
|
2615 if (maxpos_h.lnum == 0
|
|
2616 || maxpos_h.lnum > sip->si_h_endpos.lnum
|
|
2617 || (maxpos_h.lnum == sip->si_h_endpos.lnum
|
|
2618 && maxpos_h.col > sip->si_h_endpos.col))
|
|
2619 maxpos_h = sip->si_h_endpos;
|
|
2620 }
|
7
|
2621 }
|
|
2622 }
|
|
2623
|
|
2624 /*
|
|
2625 * Update an entry in the current_state stack for a start-skip-end pattern.
|
|
2626 * This finds the end of the current item, if it's in the current line.
|
|
2627 *
|
|
2628 * Return the flags for the matched END.
|
|
2629 */
|
|
2630 static void
|
|
2631 update_si_end(sip, startcol, force)
|
|
2632 stateitem_T *sip;
|
|
2633 int startcol; /* where to start searching for the end */
|
|
2634 int force; /* when TRUE overrule a previous end */
|
|
2635 {
|
|
2636 lpos_T startpos;
|
|
2637 lpos_T endpos;
|
|
2638 lpos_T hl_endpos;
|
|
2639 lpos_T end_endpos;
|
|
2640 int end_idx;
|
|
2641
|
|
2642 /* Don't update when it's already done. Can be a match of an end pattern
|
|
2643 * that started in a previous line. Watch out: can also be a "keepend"
|
|
2644 * from a containing item. */
|
|
2645 if (!force && sip->si_m_endpos.lnum >= current_lnum)
|
|
2646 return;
|
|
2647
|
|
2648 /*
|
|
2649 * We need to find the end of the region. It may continue in the next
|
|
2650 * line.
|
|
2651 */
|
|
2652 end_idx = 0;
|
|
2653 startpos.lnum = current_lnum;
|
|
2654 startpos.col = startcol;
|
|
2655 find_endpos(sip->si_idx, &startpos, &endpos, &hl_endpos,
|
|
2656 &(sip->si_flags), &end_endpos, &end_idx, sip->si_extmatch);
|
|
2657
|
|
2658 if (endpos.lnum == 0)
|
|
2659 {
|
|
2660 /* No end pattern matched. */
|
|
2661 if (SYN_ITEMS(syn_buf)[sip->si_idx].sp_flags & HL_ONELINE)
|
|
2662 {
|
|
2663 /* a "oneline" never continues in the next line */
|
|
2664 sip->si_ends = TRUE;
|
|
2665 sip->si_m_endpos.lnum = current_lnum;
|
|
2666 sip->si_m_endpos.col = (colnr_T)STRLEN(syn_getcurline());
|
|
2667 }
|
|
2668 else
|
|
2669 {
|
|
2670 /* continues in the next line */
|
|
2671 sip->si_ends = FALSE;
|
|
2672 sip->si_m_endpos.lnum = 0;
|
|
2673 }
|
|
2674 sip->si_h_endpos = sip->si_m_endpos;
|
|
2675 }
|
|
2676 else
|
|
2677 {
|
|
2678 /* match within this line */
|
|
2679 sip->si_m_endpos = endpos;
|
|
2680 sip->si_h_endpos = hl_endpos;
|
|
2681 sip->si_eoe_pos = end_endpos;
|
|
2682 sip->si_ends = TRUE;
|
|
2683 sip->si_end_idx = end_idx;
|
|
2684 }
|
|
2685 }
|
|
2686
|
|
2687 /*
|
|
2688 * Add a new state to the current state stack.
|
|
2689 * It is cleared and the index set to "idx".
|
|
2690 * Return FAIL if it's not possible (out of memory).
|
|
2691 */
|
|
2692 static int
|
|
2693 push_current_state(idx)
|
|
2694 int idx;
|
|
2695 {
|
|
2696 if (ga_grow(¤t_state, 1) == FAIL)
|
|
2697 return FAIL;
|
|
2698 vim_memset(&CUR_STATE(current_state.ga_len), 0, sizeof(stateitem_T));
|
|
2699 CUR_STATE(current_state.ga_len).si_idx = idx;
|
|
2700 ++current_state.ga_len;
|
|
2701 return OK;
|
|
2702 }
|
|
2703
|
|
2704 /*
|
|
2705 * Remove a state from the current_state stack.
|
|
2706 */
|
|
2707 static void
|
|
2708 pop_current_state()
|
|
2709 {
|
|
2710 if (current_state.ga_len)
|
|
2711 {
|
|
2712 unref_extmatch(CUR_STATE(current_state.ga_len - 1).si_extmatch);
|
|
2713 --current_state.ga_len;
|
|
2714 }
|
|
2715 /* after the end of a pattern, try matching a keyword or pattern */
|
|
2716 next_match_idx = -1;
|
|
2717
|
|
2718 /* if first state with "keepend" is popped, reset keepend_level */
|
|
2719 if (keepend_level >= current_state.ga_len)
|
|
2720 keepend_level = -1;
|
|
2721 }
|
|
2722
|
|
2723 /*
|
|
2724 * Find the end of a start/skip/end syntax region after "startpos".
|
|
2725 * Only checks one line.
|
|
2726 * Also handles a match item that continued from a previous line.
|
|
2727 * If not found, the syntax item continues in the next line. m_endpos->lnum
|
|
2728 * will be 0.
|
|
2729 * If found, the end of the region and the end of the highlighting is
|
|
2730 * computed.
|
|
2731 */
|
|
2732 static void
|
|
2733 find_endpos(idx, startpos, m_endpos, hl_endpos, flagsp, end_endpos,
|
|
2734 end_idx, start_ext)
|
|
2735 int idx; /* index of the pattern */
|
|
2736 lpos_T *startpos; /* where to start looking for an END match */
|
|
2737 lpos_T *m_endpos; /* return: end of match */
|
|
2738 lpos_T *hl_endpos; /* return: end of highlighting */
|
|
2739 long *flagsp; /* return: flags of matching END */
|
|
2740 lpos_T *end_endpos; /* return: end of end pattern match */
|
|
2741 int *end_idx; /* return: group ID for end pat. match, or 0 */
|
|
2742 reg_extmatch_T *start_ext; /* submatches from the start pattern */
|
|
2743 {
|
|
2744 colnr_T matchcol;
|
|
2745 synpat_T *spp, *spp_skip;
|
|
2746 int start_idx;
|
|
2747 int best_idx;
|
|
2748 regmmatch_T regmatch;
|
|
2749 regmmatch_T best_regmatch; /* startpos/endpos of best match */
|
|
2750 lpos_T pos;
|
|
2751 char_u *line;
|
|
2752 int had_match = FALSE;
|
|
2753
|
|
2754 /*
|
|
2755 * Check for being called with a START pattern.
|
|
2756 * Can happen with a match that continues to the next line, because it
|
|
2757 * contained a region.
|
|
2758 */
|
|
2759 spp = &(SYN_ITEMS(syn_buf)[idx]);
|
|
2760 if (spp->sp_type != SPTYPE_START)
|
|
2761 {
|
|
2762 *hl_endpos = *startpos;
|
|
2763 return;
|
|
2764 }
|
|
2765
|
|
2766 /*
|
|
2767 * Find the SKIP or first END pattern after the last START pattern.
|
|
2768 */
|
|
2769 for (;;)
|
|
2770 {
|
|
2771 spp = &(SYN_ITEMS(syn_buf)[idx]);
|
|
2772 if (spp->sp_type != SPTYPE_START)
|
|
2773 break;
|
|
2774 ++idx;
|
|
2775 }
|
|
2776
|
|
2777 /*
|
|
2778 * Lookup the SKIP pattern (if present)
|
|
2779 */
|
|
2780 if (spp->sp_type == SPTYPE_SKIP)
|
|
2781 {
|
|
2782 spp_skip = spp;
|
|
2783 ++idx;
|
|
2784 }
|
|
2785 else
|
|
2786 spp_skip = NULL;
|
|
2787
|
|
2788 /* Setup external matches for syn_regexec(). */
|
|
2789 unref_extmatch(re_extmatch_in);
|
|
2790 re_extmatch_in = ref_extmatch(start_ext);
|
|
2791
|
|
2792 matchcol = startpos->col; /* start looking for a match at sstart */
|
|
2793 start_idx = idx; /* remember the first END pattern. */
|
|
2794 best_regmatch.startpos[0].col = 0; /* avoid compiler warning */
|
|
2795 for (;;)
|
|
2796 {
|
|
2797 /*
|
|
2798 * Find end pattern that matches first after "matchcol".
|
|
2799 */
|
|
2800 best_idx = -1;
|
|
2801 for (idx = start_idx; idx < syn_buf->b_syn_patterns.ga_len; ++idx)
|
|
2802 {
|
|
2803 int lc_col = matchcol;
|
|
2804
|
|
2805 spp = &(SYN_ITEMS(syn_buf)[idx]);
|
|
2806 if (spp->sp_type != SPTYPE_END) /* past last END pattern */
|
|
2807 break;
|
|
2808 lc_col -= spp->sp_offsets[SPO_LC_OFF];
|
|
2809 if (lc_col < 0)
|
|
2810 lc_col = 0;
|
|
2811
|
|
2812 regmatch.rmm_ic = spp->sp_ic;
|
|
2813 regmatch.regprog = spp->sp_prog;
|
|
2814 if (syn_regexec(®match, startpos->lnum, lc_col))
|
|
2815 {
|
|
2816 if (best_idx == -1 || regmatch.startpos[0].col
|
|
2817 < best_regmatch.startpos[0].col)
|
|
2818 {
|
|
2819 best_idx = idx;
|
|
2820 best_regmatch.startpos[0] = regmatch.startpos[0];
|
|
2821 best_regmatch.endpos[0] = regmatch.endpos[0];
|
|
2822 }
|
|
2823 }
|
|
2824 }
|
|
2825
|
|
2826 /*
|
|
2827 * If all end patterns have been tried, and there is no match, the
|
|
2828 * item continues until end-of-line.
|
|
2829 */
|
|
2830 if (best_idx == -1)
|
|
2831 break;
|
|
2832
|
|
2833 /*
|
|
2834 * If the skip pattern matches before the end pattern,
|
|
2835 * continue searching after the skip pattern.
|
|
2836 */
|
|
2837 if (spp_skip != NULL)
|
|
2838 {
|
|
2839 int lc_col = matchcol - spp_skip->sp_offsets[SPO_LC_OFF];
|
|
2840
|
|
2841 if (lc_col < 0)
|
|
2842 lc_col = 0;
|
|
2843 regmatch.rmm_ic = spp_skip->sp_ic;
|
|
2844 regmatch.regprog = spp_skip->sp_prog;
|
|
2845 if (syn_regexec(®match, startpos->lnum, lc_col)
|
|
2846 && regmatch.startpos[0].col
|
|
2847 <= best_regmatch.startpos[0].col)
|
|
2848 {
|
|
2849 /* Add offset to skip pattern match */
|
|
2850 syn_add_end_off(&pos, ®match, spp_skip, SPO_ME_OFF, 1);
|
|
2851
|
|
2852 /* If the skip pattern goes on to the next line, there is no
|
|
2853 * match with an end pattern in this line. */
|
|
2854 if (pos.lnum > startpos->lnum)
|
|
2855 break;
|
|
2856
|
|
2857 line = ml_get_buf(syn_buf, startpos->lnum, FALSE);
|
|
2858
|
|
2859 /* take care of an empty match or negative offset */
|
|
2860 if (pos.col <= matchcol)
|
|
2861 ++matchcol;
|
|
2862 else if (pos.col <= regmatch.endpos[0].col)
|
|
2863 matchcol = pos.col;
|
|
2864 else
|
|
2865 /* Be careful not to jump over the NUL at the end-of-line */
|
|
2866 for (matchcol = regmatch.endpos[0].col;
|
|
2867 line[matchcol] != NUL && matchcol < pos.col;
|
|
2868 ++matchcol)
|
|
2869 ;
|
|
2870
|
|
2871 /* if the skip pattern includes end-of-line, break here */
|
|
2872 if (line[matchcol] == NUL)
|
|
2873 break;
|
|
2874
|
|
2875 continue; /* start with first end pattern again */
|
|
2876 }
|
|
2877 }
|
|
2878
|
|
2879 /*
|
|
2880 * Match from start pattern to end pattern.
|
|
2881 * Correct for match and highlight offset of end pattern.
|
|
2882 */
|
|
2883 spp = &(SYN_ITEMS(syn_buf)[best_idx]);
|
|
2884 syn_add_end_off(m_endpos, &best_regmatch, spp, SPO_ME_OFF, 1);
|
|
2885 /* can't end before the start */
|
|
2886 if (m_endpos->lnum == startpos->lnum && m_endpos->col < startpos->col)
|
|
2887 m_endpos->col = startpos->col;
|
|
2888
|
|
2889 syn_add_end_off(end_endpos, &best_regmatch, spp, SPO_HE_OFF, 1);
|
|
2890 /* can't end before the start */
|
|
2891 if (end_endpos->lnum == startpos->lnum
|
|
2892 && end_endpos->col < startpos->col)
|
|
2893 end_endpos->col = startpos->col;
|
|
2894 /* can't end after the match */
|
|
2895 limit_pos(end_endpos, m_endpos);
|
|
2896
|
|
2897 /*
|
|
2898 * If the end group is highlighted differently, adjust the pointers.
|
|
2899 */
|
|
2900 if (spp->sp_syn_match_id != spp->sp_syn.id && spp->sp_syn_match_id != 0)
|
|
2901 {
|
|
2902 *end_idx = best_idx;
|
|
2903 if (spp->sp_off_flags & (1 << (SPO_RE_OFF + SPO_COUNT)))
|
|
2904 {
|
|
2905 hl_endpos->lnum = best_regmatch.endpos[0].lnum;
|
|
2906 hl_endpos->col = best_regmatch.endpos[0].col;
|
|
2907 }
|
|
2908 else
|
|
2909 {
|
|
2910 hl_endpos->lnum = best_regmatch.startpos[0].lnum;
|
|
2911 hl_endpos->col = best_regmatch.startpos[0].col;
|
|
2912 }
|
|
2913 hl_endpos->col += spp->sp_offsets[SPO_RE_OFF];
|
|
2914
|
|
2915 /* can't end before the start */
|
|
2916 if (hl_endpos->lnum == startpos->lnum
|
|
2917 && hl_endpos->col < startpos->col)
|
|
2918 hl_endpos->col = startpos->col;
|
|
2919 limit_pos(hl_endpos, m_endpos);
|
|
2920
|
|
2921 /* now the match ends where the highlighting ends, it is turned
|
|
2922 * into the matchgroup for the end */
|
|
2923 *m_endpos = *hl_endpos;
|
|
2924 }
|
|
2925 else
|
|
2926 {
|
|
2927 *end_idx = 0;
|
|
2928 *hl_endpos = *end_endpos;
|
|
2929 }
|
|
2930
|
|
2931 *flagsp = spp->sp_flags;
|
|
2932
|
|
2933 had_match = TRUE;
|
|
2934 break;
|
|
2935 }
|
|
2936
|
|
2937 /* no match for an END pattern in this line */
|
|
2938 if (!had_match)
|
|
2939 m_endpos->lnum = 0;
|
|
2940
|
|
2941 /* Remove external matches. */
|
|
2942 unref_extmatch(re_extmatch_in);
|
|
2943 re_extmatch_in = NULL;
|
|
2944 }
|
|
2945
|
|
2946 /*
|
|
2947 * Limit "pos" not to be after "limit".
|
|
2948 */
|
|
2949 static void
|
|
2950 limit_pos(pos, limit)
|
|
2951 lpos_T *pos;
|
|
2952 lpos_T *limit;
|
|
2953 {
|
|
2954 if (pos->lnum > limit->lnum)
|
|
2955 *pos = *limit;
|
|
2956 else if (pos->lnum == limit->lnum && pos->col > limit->col)
|
|
2957 pos->col = limit->col;
|
|
2958 }
|
|
2959
|
|
2960 /*
|
|
2961 * Limit "pos" not to be after "limit", unless pos->lnum is zero.
|
|
2962 */
|
|
2963 static void
|
|
2964 limit_pos_zero(pos, limit)
|
|
2965 lpos_T *pos;
|
|
2966 lpos_T *limit;
|
|
2967 {
|
|
2968 if (pos->lnum == 0)
|
|
2969 *pos = *limit;
|
|
2970 else
|
|
2971 limit_pos(pos, limit);
|
|
2972 }
|
|
2973
|
|
2974 /*
|
|
2975 * Add offset to matched text for end of match or highlight.
|
|
2976 */
|
|
2977 static void
|
|
2978 syn_add_end_off(result, regmatch, spp, idx, extra)
|
|
2979 lpos_T *result; /* returned position */
|
|
2980 regmmatch_T *regmatch; /* start/end of match */
|
|
2981 synpat_T *spp; /* matched pattern */
|
|
2982 int idx; /* index of offset */
|
|
2983 int extra; /* extra chars for offset to start */
|
|
2984 {
|
|
2985 int col;
|
626
|
2986 int len;
|
7
|
2987
|
|
2988 if (spp->sp_off_flags & (1 << idx))
|
|
2989 {
|
|
2990 result->lnum = regmatch->startpos[0].lnum;
|
|
2991 col = regmatch->startpos[0].col + extra;
|
|
2992 }
|
|
2993 else
|
|
2994 {
|
|
2995 result->lnum = regmatch->endpos[0].lnum;
|
|
2996 col = regmatch->endpos[0].col;
|
|
2997 }
|
|
2998 col += spp->sp_offsets[idx];
|
|
2999 if (col < 0)
|
|
3000 result->col = 0;
|
|
3001 else
|
626
|
3002 {
|
|
3003 /* Don't go past the end of the line. Matters for "rs=e+2" when there
|
640
|
3004 * is a matchgroup. Watch out for match with last NL in the buffer. */
|
|
3005 if (result->lnum > syn_buf->b_ml.ml_line_count)
|
|
3006 len = 0;
|
|
3007 else
|
835
|
3008 len = (int)STRLEN(ml_get_buf(syn_buf, result->lnum, FALSE));
|
626
|
3009 if (col > len)
|
|
3010 result->col = len;
|
|
3011 else
|
|
3012 result->col = col;
|
|
3013 }
|
7
|
3014 }
|
|
3015
|
|
3016 /*
|
|
3017 * Add offset to matched text for start of match or highlight.
|
|
3018 * Avoid resulting column to become negative.
|
|
3019 */
|
|
3020 static void
|
|
3021 syn_add_start_off(result, regmatch, spp, idx, extra)
|
|
3022 lpos_T *result; /* returned position */
|
|
3023 regmmatch_T *regmatch; /* start/end of match */
|
|
3024 synpat_T *spp;
|
|
3025 int idx;
|
|
3026 int extra; /* extra chars for offset to end */
|
|
3027 {
|
|
3028 int col;
|
|
3029
|
|
3030 if (spp->sp_off_flags & (1 << (idx + SPO_COUNT)))
|
|
3031 {
|
|
3032 result->lnum = regmatch->endpos[0].lnum;
|
|
3033 col = regmatch->endpos[0].col + extra;
|
|
3034 }
|
|
3035 else
|
|
3036 {
|
|
3037 result->lnum = regmatch->startpos[0].lnum;
|
|
3038 col = regmatch->startpos[0].col;
|
|
3039 }
|
|
3040 col += spp->sp_offsets[idx];
|
|
3041 if (col < 0)
|
|
3042 result->col = 0;
|
|
3043 else
|
|
3044 result->col = col;
|
|
3045 }
|
|
3046
|
|
3047 /*
|
|
3048 * Get current line in syntax buffer.
|
|
3049 */
|
|
3050 static char_u *
|
|
3051 syn_getcurline()
|
|
3052 {
|
|
3053 return ml_get_buf(syn_buf, current_lnum, FALSE);
|
|
3054 }
|
|
3055
|
|
3056 /*
|
410
|
3057 * Call vim_regexec() to find a match with "rmp" in "syn_buf".
|
7
|
3058 * Returns TRUE when there is a match.
|
|
3059 */
|
|
3060 static int
|
|
3061 syn_regexec(rmp, lnum, col)
|
|
3062 regmmatch_T *rmp;
|
|
3063 linenr_T lnum;
|
|
3064 colnr_T col;
|
|
3065 {
|
410
|
3066 rmp->rmm_maxcol = syn_buf->b_p_smc;
|
7
|
3067 if (vim_regexec_multi(rmp, syn_win, syn_buf, lnum, col) > 0)
|
|
3068 {
|
|
3069 rmp->startpos[0].lnum += lnum;
|
|
3070 rmp->endpos[0].lnum += lnum;
|
|
3071 return TRUE;
|
|
3072 }
|
|
3073 return FALSE;
|
|
3074 }
|
|
3075
|
|
3076 /*
|
|
3077 * Check one position in a line for a matching keyword.
|
|
3078 * The caller must check if a keyword can start at startcol.
|
|
3079 * Return it's ID if found, 0 otherwise.
|
|
3080 */
|
|
3081 static int
|
|
3082 check_keyword_id(line, startcol, endcolp, flagsp, next_listp, cur_si)
|
|
3083 char_u *line;
|
|
3084 int startcol; /* position in line to check for keyword */
|
|
3085 int *endcolp; /* return: character after found keyword */
|
|
3086 long *flagsp; /* return: flags of matching keyword */
|
|
3087 short **next_listp; /* return: next_list of matching keyword */
|
|
3088 stateitem_T *cur_si; /* item at the top of the stack */
|
|
3089 {
|
134
|
3090 keyentry_T *kp;
|
|
3091 char_u *kwp;
|
7
|
3092 int round;
|
134
|
3093 int kwlen;
|
7
|
3094 char_u keyword[MAXKEYWLEN + 1]; /* assume max. keyword len is 80 */
|
134
|
3095 hashtab_T *ht;
|
|
3096 hashitem_T *hi;
|
7
|
3097
|
|
3098 /* Find first character after the keyword. First character was already
|
|
3099 * checked. */
|
134
|
3100 kwp = line + startcol;
|
|
3101 kwlen = 0;
|
7
|
3102 do
|
|
3103 {
|
|
3104 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
|
|
3105 if (has_mbyte)
|
474
|
3106 kwlen += (*mb_ptr2len)(kwp + kwlen);
|
7
|
3107 else
|
|
3108 #endif
|
134
|
3109 ++kwlen;
|
|
3110 }
|
|
3111 while (vim_iswordc_buf(kwp + kwlen, syn_buf));
|
|
3112
|
|
3113 if (kwlen > MAXKEYWLEN)
|
7
|
3114 return 0;
|
|
3115
|
|
3116 /*
|
|
3117 * Must make a copy of the keyword, so we can add a NUL and make it
|
|
3118 * lowercase.
|
|
3119 */
|
419
|
3120 vim_strncpy(keyword, kwp, kwlen);
|
7
|
3121
|
|
3122 /*
|
|
3123 * Try twice:
|
|
3124 * 1. matching case
|
|
3125 * 2. ignoring case
|
|
3126 */
|
|
3127 for (round = 1; round <= 2; ++round)
|
|
3128 {
|
134
|
3129 ht = round == 1 ? &syn_buf->b_keywtab : &syn_buf->b_keywtab_ic;
|
|
3130 if (ht->ht_used == 0)
|
7
|
3131 continue;
|
134
|
3132 if (round == 2) /* ignore case */
|
|
3133 (void)str_foldcase(kwp, kwlen, keyword, MAXKEYWLEN + 1);
|
7
|
3134
|
|
3135 /*
|
134
|
3136 * Find keywords that match. There can be several with different
|
|
3137 * attributes.
|
7
|
3138 * When current_next_list is non-zero accept only that group, otherwise:
|
|
3139 * Accept a not-contained keyword at toplevel.
|
|
3140 * Accept a keyword at other levels only if it is in the contains list.
|
|
3141 */
|
134
|
3142 hi = hash_find(ht, keyword);
|
|
3143 if (!HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi))
|
|
3144 for (kp = HI2KE(hi); kp != NULL; kp = kp->ke_next)
|
7
|
3145 {
|
134
|
3146 if (current_next_list != 0
|
|
3147 ? in_id_list(NULL, current_next_list, &kp->k_syn, 0)
|
|
3148 : (cur_si == NULL
|
|
3149 ? !(kp->flags & HL_CONTAINED)
|
|
3150 : in_id_list(cur_si, cur_si->si_cont_list,
|
|
3151 &kp->k_syn, kp->flags & HL_CONTAINED)))
|
|
3152 {
|
|
3153 *endcolp = startcol + kwlen;
|
|
3154 *flagsp = kp->flags;
|
|
3155 *next_listp = kp->next_list;
|
|
3156 return kp->k_syn.id;
|
|
3157 }
|
7
|
3158 }
|
|
3159 }
|
|
3160 return 0;
|
|
3161 }
|
|
3162
|
|
3163 /*
|
|
3164 * Handle ":syntax case" command.
|
|
3165 */
|
|
3166 /* ARGSUSED */
|
|
3167 static void
|
|
3168 syn_cmd_case(eap, syncing)
|
|
3169 exarg_T *eap;
|
|
3170 int syncing; /* not used */
|
|
3171 {
|
|
3172 char_u *arg = eap->arg;
|
|
3173 char_u *next;
|
|
3174
|
|
3175 eap->nextcmd = find_nextcmd(arg);
|
|
3176 if (eap->skip)
|
|
3177 return;
|
|
3178
|
|
3179 next = skiptowhite(arg);
|
|
3180 if (STRNICMP(arg, "match", 5) == 0 && next - arg == 5)
|
|
3181 curbuf->b_syn_ic = FALSE;
|
|
3182 else if (STRNICMP(arg, "ignore", 6) == 0 && next - arg == 6)
|
|
3183 curbuf->b_syn_ic = TRUE;
|
|
3184 else
|
|
3185 EMSG2(_("E390: Illegal argument: %s"), arg);
|
|
3186 }
|
|
3187
|
|
3188 /*
|
419
|
3189 * Handle ":syntax spell" command.
|
|
3190 */
|
|
3191 /* ARGSUSED */
|
|
3192 static void
|
|
3193 syn_cmd_spell(eap, syncing)
|
|
3194 exarg_T *eap;
|
|
3195 int syncing; /* not used */
|
|
3196 {
|
|
3197 char_u *arg = eap->arg;
|
|
3198 char_u *next;
|
|
3199
|
|
3200 eap->nextcmd = find_nextcmd(arg);
|
|
3201 if (eap->skip)
|
|
3202 return;
|
|
3203
|
|
3204 next = skiptowhite(arg);
|
|
3205 if (STRNICMP(arg, "toplevel", 8) == 0 && next - arg == 8)
|
|
3206 curbuf->b_syn_spell = SYNSPL_TOP;
|
|
3207 else if (STRNICMP(arg, "notoplevel", 10) == 0 && next - arg == 10)
|
|
3208 curbuf->b_syn_spell = SYNSPL_NOTOP;
|
1064
|
3209 else if (STRNICMP(arg, "default", 7) == 0 && next - arg == 7)
|
419
|
3210 curbuf->b_syn_spell = SYNSPL_DEFAULT;
|
|
3211 else
|
|
3212 EMSG2(_("E390: Illegal argument: %s"), arg);
|
|
3213 }
|
|
3214
|
|
3215 /*
|
7
|
3216 * Clear all syntax info for one buffer.
|
|
3217 */
|
|
3218 void
|
|
3219 syntax_clear(buf)
|
|
3220 buf_T *buf;
|
|
3221 {
|
|
3222 int i;
|
|
3223
|
482
|
3224 buf->b_syn_error = FALSE; /* clear previous error */
|
294
|
3225 buf->b_syn_ic = FALSE; /* Use case, by default */
|
419
|
3226 buf->b_syn_spell = SYNSPL_DEFAULT; /* default spell checking */
|
294
|
3227 buf->b_syn_containedin = FALSE;
|
7
|
3228
|
|
3229 /* free the keywords */
|
134
|
3230 clear_keywtab(&buf->b_keywtab);
|
|
3231 clear_keywtab(&buf->b_keywtab_ic);
|
7
|
3232
|
|
3233 /* free the syntax patterns */
|
|
3234 for (i = buf->b_syn_patterns.ga_len; --i >= 0; )
|
|
3235 syn_clear_pattern(buf, i);
|
|
3236 ga_clear(&buf->b_syn_patterns);
|
|
3237
|
|
3238 /* free the syntax clusters */
|
|
3239 for (i = buf->b_syn_clusters.ga_len; --i >= 0; )
|
|
3240 syn_clear_cluster(buf, i);
|
|
3241 ga_clear(&buf->b_syn_clusters);
|
301
|
3242 buf->b_spell_cluster_id = 0;
|
|
3243 buf->b_nospell_cluster_id = 0;
|
7
|
3244
|
|
3245 buf->b_syn_sync_flags = 0;
|
|
3246 buf->b_syn_sync_minlines = 0;
|
|
3247 buf->b_syn_sync_maxlines = 0;
|
|
3248 buf->b_syn_sync_linebreaks = 0;
|
|
3249
|
|
3250 vim_free(buf->b_syn_linecont_prog);
|
|
3251 buf->b_syn_linecont_prog = NULL;
|
|
3252 vim_free(buf->b_syn_linecont_pat);
|
|
3253 buf->b_syn_linecont_pat = NULL;
|
|
3254 #ifdef FEAT_FOLDING
|
|
3255 buf->b_syn_folditems = 0;
|
|
3256 #endif
|
|
3257
|
|
3258 /* free the stored states */
|
|
3259 syn_stack_free_all(buf);
|
|
3260 invalidate_current_state();
|
|
3261 }
|
|
3262
|
|
3263 /*
|
|
3264 * Clear syncing info for one buffer.
|
|
3265 */
|
|
3266 static void
|
|
3267 syntax_sync_clear()
|
|
3268 {
|
|
3269 int i;
|
|
3270
|
|
3271 /* free the syntax patterns */
|
|
3272 for (i = curbuf->b_syn_patterns.ga_len; --i >= 0; )
|
|
3273 if (SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[i].sp_syncing)
|
|
3274 syn_remove_pattern(curbuf, i);
|
|
3275
|
|
3276 curbuf->b_syn_sync_flags = 0;
|
|
3277 curbuf->b_syn_sync_minlines = 0;
|
|
3278 curbuf->b_syn_sync_maxlines = 0;
|
|
3279 curbuf->b_syn_sync_linebreaks = 0;
|
|
3280
|
|
3281 vim_free(curbuf->b_syn_linecont_prog);
|
|
3282 curbuf->b_syn_linecont_prog = NULL;
|
|
3283 vim_free(curbuf->b_syn_linecont_pat);
|
|
3284 curbuf->b_syn_linecont_pat = NULL;
|
|
3285
|
|
3286 syn_stack_free_all(curbuf); /* Need to recompute all syntax. */
|
|
3287 }
|
|
3288
|
|
3289 /*
|
|
3290 * Remove one pattern from the buffer's pattern list.
|
|
3291 */
|
|
3292 static void
|
|
3293 syn_remove_pattern(buf, idx)
|
|
3294 buf_T *buf;
|
|
3295 int idx;
|
|
3296 {
|
|
3297 synpat_T *spp;
|
|
3298
|
|
3299 spp = &(SYN_ITEMS(buf)[idx]);
|
|
3300 #ifdef FEAT_FOLDING
|
|
3301 if (spp->sp_flags & HL_FOLD)
|
|
3302 --buf->b_syn_folditems;
|
|
3303 #endif
|
|
3304 syn_clear_pattern(buf, idx);
|
|
3305 mch_memmove(spp, spp + 1,
|
|
3306 sizeof(synpat_T) * (buf->b_syn_patterns.ga_len - idx - 1));
|
|
3307 --buf->b_syn_patterns.ga_len;
|
|
3308 }
|
|
3309
|
|
3310 /*
|
|
3311 * Clear and free one syntax pattern. When clearing all, must be called from
|
|
3312 * last to first!
|
|
3313 */
|
|
3314 static void
|
|
3315 syn_clear_pattern(buf, i)
|
|
3316 buf_T *buf;
|
|
3317 int i;
|
|
3318 {
|
|
3319 vim_free(SYN_ITEMS(buf)[i].sp_pattern);
|
|
3320 vim_free(SYN_ITEMS(buf)[i].sp_prog);
|
|
3321 /* Only free sp_cont_list and sp_next_list of first start pattern */
|
|
3322 if (i == 0 || SYN_ITEMS(buf)[i - 1].sp_type != SPTYPE_START)
|
|
3323 {
|
|
3324 vim_free(SYN_ITEMS(buf)[i].sp_cont_list);
|
|
3325 vim_free(SYN_ITEMS(buf)[i].sp_next_list);
|
|
3326 }
|
|
3327 }
|
|
3328
|
|
3329 /*
|
|
3330 * Clear and free one syntax cluster.
|
|
3331 */
|
|
3332 static void
|
|
3333 syn_clear_cluster(buf, i)
|
|
3334 buf_T *buf;
|
|
3335 int i;
|
|
3336 {
|
|
3337 vim_free(SYN_CLSTR(buf)[i].scl_name);
|
|
3338 vim_free(SYN_CLSTR(buf)[i].scl_name_u);
|
|
3339 vim_free(SYN_CLSTR(buf)[i].scl_list);
|
|
3340 }
|
|
3341
|
|
3342 /*
|
|
3343 * Handle ":syntax clear" command.
|
|
3344 */
|
|
3345 static void
|
|
3346 syn_cmd_clear(eap, syncing)
|
|
3347 exarg_T *eap;
|
|
3348 int syncing;
|
|
3349 {
|
|
3350 char_u *arg = eap->arg;
|
|
3351 char_u *arg_end;
|
|
3352 int id;
|
|
3353
|
|
3354 eap->nextcmd = find_nextcmd(arg);
|
|
3355 if (eap->skip)
|
|
3356 return;
|
|
3357
|
|
3358 /*
|
|
3359 * We have to disable this within ":syn include @group filename",
|
|
3360 * because otherwise @group would get deleted.
|
|
3361 * Only required for Vim 5.x syntax files, 6.0 ones don't contain ":syn
|
|
3362 * clear".
|
|
3363 */
|
|
3364 if (curbuf->b_syn_topgrp != 0)
|
|
3365 return;
|
|
3366
|
|
3367 if (ends_excmd(*arg))
|
|
3368 {
|
|
3369 /*
|
|
3370 * No argument: Clear all syntax items.
|
|
3371 */
|
|
3372 if (syncing)
|
|
3373 syntax_sync_clear();
|
|
3374 else
|
|
3375 {
|
|
3376 syntax_clear(curbuf);
|
148
|
3377 do_unlet((char_u *)"b:current_syntax", TRUE);
|
7
|
3378 }
|
|
3379 }
|
|
3380 else
|
|
3381 {
|
|
3382 /*
|
|
3383 * Clear the group IDs that are in the argument.
|
|
3384 */
|
|
3385 while (!ends_excmd(*arg))
|
|
3386 {
|
|
3387 arg_end = skiptowhite(arg);
|
|
3388 if (*arg == '@')
|
|
3389 {
|
|
3390 id = syn_scl_namen2id(arg + 1, (int)(arg_end - arg - 1));
|
|
3391 if (id == 0)
|
|
3392 {
|
|
3393 EMSG2(_("E391: No such syntax cluster: %s"), arg);
|
|
3394 break;
|
|
3395 }
|
|
3396 else
|
|
3397 {
|
|
3398 /*
|
|
3399 * We can't physically delete a cluster without changing
|
|
3400 * the IDs of other clusters, so we do the next best thing
|
|
3401 * and make it empty.
|
|
3402 */
|
|
3403 short scl_id = id - SYNID_CLUSTER;
|
|
3404
|
|
3405 vim_free(SYN_CLSTR(curbuf)[scl_id].scl_list);
|
|
3406 SYN_CLSTR(curbuf)[scl_id].scl_list = NULL;
|
|
3407 }
|
|
3408 }
|
|
3409 else
|
|
3410 {
|
|
3411 id = syn_namen2id(arg, (int)(arg_end - arg));
|
|
3412 if (id == 0)
|
|
3413 {
|
|
3414 EMSG2(_(e_nogroup), arg);
|
|
3415 break;
|
|
3416 }
|
|
3417 else
|
|
3418 syn_clear_one(id, syncing);
|
|
3419 }
|
|
3420 arg = skipwhite(arg_end);
|
|
3421 }
|
|
3422 }
|
745
|
3423 redraw_curbuf_later(SOME_VALID);
|
7
|
3424 syn_stack_free_all(curbuf); /* Need to recompute all syntax. */
|
|
3425 }
|
|
3426
|
|
3427 /*
|
|
3428 * Clear one syntax group for the current buffer.
|
|
3429 */
|
|
3430 static void
|
|
3431 syn_clear_one(id, syncing)
|
|
3432 int id;
|
|
3433 int syncing;
|
|
3434 {
|
|
3435 synpat_T *spp;
|
|
3436 int idx;
|
|
3437
|
|
3438 /* Clear keywords only when not ":syn sync clear group-name" */
|
|
3439 if (!syncing)
|
|
3440 {
|
134
|
3441 (void)syn_clear_keyword(id, &curbuf->b_keywtab);
|
|
3442 (void)syn_clear_keyword(id, &curbuf->b_keywtab_ic);
|
7
|
3443 }
|
|
3444
|
|
3445 /* clear the patterns for "id" */
|
|
3446 for (idx = curbuf->b_syn_patterns.ga_len; --idx >= 0; )
|
|
3447 {
|
|
3448 spp = &(SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[idx]);
|
|
3449 if (spp->sp_syn.id != id || spp->sp_syncing != syncing)
|
|
3450 continue;
|
|
3451 syn_remove_pattern(curbuf, idx);
|
|
3452 }
|
|
3453 }
|
|
3454
|
|
3455 /*
|
|
3456 * Handle ":syntax on" command.
|
|
3457 */
|
|
3458 /* ARGSUSED */
|
|
3459 static void
|
|
3460 syn_cmd_on(eap, syncing)
|
|
3461 exarg_T *eap;
|
|
3462 int syncing; /* not used */
|
|
3463 {
|
|
3464 syn_cmd_onoff(eap, "syntax");
|
|
3465 }
|
|
3466
|
|
3467 /*
|
|
3468 * Handle ":syntax enable" command.
|
|
3469 */
|
|
3470 /* ARGSUSED */
|
|
3471 static void
|
|
3472 syn_cmd_enable(eap, syncing)
|
|
3473 exarg_T *eap;
|
|
3474 int syncing; /* not used */
|
|
3475 {
|
|
3476 set_internal_string_var((char_u *)"syntax_cmd", (char_u *)"enable");
|
|
3477 syn_cmd_onoff(eap, "syntax");
|
148
|
3478 do_unlet((char_u *)"g:syntax_cmd", TRUE);
|
7
|
3479 }
|
|
3480
|
|
3481 /*
|
|
3482 * Handle ":syntax reset" command.
|
|
3483 */
|
|
3484 /* ARGSUSED */
|
|
3485 static void
|
|
3486 syn_cmd_reset(eap, syncing)
|
|
3487 exarg_T *eap;
|
|
3488 int syncing; /* not used */
|
|
3489 {
|
|
3490 eap->nextcmd = check_nextcmd(eap->arg);
|
|
3491 if (!eap->skip)
|
|
3492 {
|
|
3493 set_internal_string_var((char_u *)"syntax_cmd", (char_u *)"reset");
|
|
3494 do_cmdline_cmd((char_u *)"runtime! syntax/syncolor.vim");
|
148
|
3495 do_unlet((char_u *)"g:syntax_cmd", TRUE);
|
7
|
3496 }
|
|
3497 }
|
|
3498
|
|
3499 /*
|
|
3500 * Handle ":syntax manual" command.
|
|
3501 */
|
|
3502 /* ARGSUSED */
|
|
3503 static void
|
|
3504 syn_cmd_manual(eap, syncing)
|
|
3505 exarg_T *eap;
|
|
3506 int syncing; /* not used */
|
|
3507 {
|
|
3508 syn_cmd_onoff(eap, "manual");
|
|
3509 }
|
|
3510
|
|
3511 /*
|
|
3512 * Handle ":syntax off" command.
|
|
3513 */
|
|
3514 /* ARGSUSED */
|
|
3515 static void
|
|
3516 syn_cmd_off(eap, syncing)
|
|
3517 exarg_T *eap;
|
|
3518 int syncing; /* not used */
|
|
3519 {
|
|
3520 syn_cmd_onoff(eap, "nosyntax");
|
|
3521 }
|
|
3522
|
|
3523 static void
|
|
3524 syn_cmd_onoff(eap, name)
|
|
3525 exarg_T *eap;
|
|
3526 char *name;
|
|
3527 {
|
|
3528 char_u buf[100];
|
|
3529
|
|
3530 eap->nextcmd = check_nextcmd(eap->arg);
|
|
3531 if (!eap->skip)
|
|
3532 {
|
|
3533 STRCPY(buf, "so ");
|
274
|
3534 vim_snprintf((char *)buf + 3, sizeof(buf) - 3, SYNTAX_FNAME, name);
|
7
|
3535 do_cmdline_cmd(buf);
|
|
3536 }
|
|
3537 }
|
|
3538
|
|
3539 /*
|
|
3540 * Handle ":syntax [list]" command: list current syntax words.
|
|
3541 */
|
|
3542 static void
|
|
3543 syn_cmd_list(eap, syncing)
|
|
3544 exarg_T *eap;
|
|
3545 int syncing; /* when TRUE: list syncing items */
|
|
3546 {
|
|
3547 char_u *arg = eap->arg;
|
|
3548 int id;
|
|
3549 char_u *arg_end;
|
|
3550
|
|
3551 eap->nextcmd = find_nextcmd(arg);
|
|
3552 if (eap->skip)
|
|
3553 return;
|
|
3554
|
|
3555 if (!syntax_present(curbuf))
|
|
3556 {
|
|
3557 MSG(_("No Syntax items defined for this buffer"));
|
|
3558 return;
|
|
3559 }
|
|
3560
|
|
3561 if (syncing)
|
|
3562 {
|
|
3563 if (curbuf->b_syn_sync_flags & SF_CCOMMENT)
|
|
3564 {
|
|
3565 MSG_PUTS(_("syncing on C-style comments"));
|
|
3566 syn_lines_msg();
|
|
3567 syn_match_msg();
|
|
3568 return;
|
|
3569 }
|
|
3570 else if (!(curbuf->b_syn_sync_flags & SF_MATCH))
|
|
3571 {
|
|
3572 if (curbuf->b_syn_sync_minlines == 0)
|
|
3573 MSG_PUTS(_("no syncing"));
|
|
3574 else
|
|
3575 {
|
|
3576 MSG_PUTS(_("syncing starts "));
|
|
3577 msg_outnum(curbuf->b_syn_sync_minlines);
|
|
3578 MSG_PUTS(_(" lines before top line"));
|
|
3579 syn_match_msg();
|
|
3580 }
|
|
3581 return;
|
|
3582 }
|
|
3583 MSG_PUTS_TITLE(_("\n--- Syntax sync items ---"));
|
|
3584 if (curbuf->b_syn_sync_minlines > 0
|
|
3585 || curbuf->b_syn_sync_maxlines > 0
|
|
3586 || curbuf->b_syn_sync_linebreaks > 0)
|
|
3587 {
|
|
3588 MSG_PUTS(_("\nsyncing on items"));
|
|
3589 syn_lines_msg();
|
|
3590 syn_match_msg();
|
|
3591 }
|
|
3592 }
|
|
3593 else
|
|
3594 MSG_PUTS_TITLE(_("\n--- Syntax items ---"));
|
|
3595 if (ends_excmd(*arg))
|
|
3596 {
|
|
3597 /*
|
|
3598 * No argument: List all group IDs and all syntax clusters.
|
|
3599 */
|
|
3600 for (id = 1; id <= highlight_ga.ga_len && !got_int; ++id)
|
|
3601 syn_list_one(id, syncing, FALSE);
|
|
3602 for (id = 0; id < curbuf->b_syn_clusters.ga_len && !got_int; ++id)
|
|
3603 syn_list_cluster(id);
|
|
3604 }
|
|
3605 else
|
|
3606 {
|
|
3607 /*
|
|
3608 * List the group IDs and syntax clusters that are in the argument.
|
|
3609 */
|
|
3610 while (!ends_excmd(*arg) && !got_int)
|
|
3611 {
|
|
3612 arg_end = skiptowhite(arg);
|
|
3613 if (*arg == '@')
|
|
3614 {
|
|
3615 id = syn_scl_namen2id(arg + 1, (int)(arg_end - arg - 1));
|
|
3616 if (id == 0)
|
|
3617 EMSG2(_("E392: No such syntax cluster: %s"), arg);
|
|
3618 else
|
|
3619 syn_list_cluster(id - SYNID_CLUSTER);
|
|
3620 }
|
|
3621 else
|
|
3622 {
|
|
3623 id = syn_namen2id(arg, (int)(arg_end - arg));
|
|
3624 if (id == 0)
|
|
3625 EMSG2(_(e_nogroup), arg);
|
|
3626 else
|
|
3627 syn_list_one(id, syncing, TRUE);
|
|
3628 }
|
|
3629 arg = skipwhite(arg_end);
|
|
3630 }
|
|
3631 }
|
|
3632 eap->nextcmd = check_nextcmd(arg);
|
|
3633 }
|
|
3634
|
|
3635 static void
|
|
3636 syn_lines_msg()
|
|
3637 {
|
|
3638 if (curbuf->b_syn_sync_maxlines > 0 || curbuf->b_syn_sync_minlines > 0)
|
|
3639 {
|
|
3640 MSG_PUTS("; ");
|
|
3641 if (curbuf->b_syn_sync_minlines > 0)
|
|
3642 {
|
|
3643 MSG_PUTS(_("minimal "));
|
|
3644 msg_outnum(curbuf->b_syn_sync_minlines);
|
|
3645 if (curbuf->b_syn_sync_maxlines)
|
|
3646 MSG_PUTS(", ");
|
|
3647 }
|
|
3648 if (curbuf->b_syn_sync_maxlines > 0)
|
|
3649 {
|
|
3650 MSG_PUTS(_("maximal "));
|
|
3651 msg_outnum(curbuf->b_syn_sync_maxlines);
|
|
3652 }
|
|
3653 MSG_PUTS(_(" lines before top line"));
|
|
3654 }
|
|
3655 }
|
|
3656
|
|
3657 static void
|
|
3658 syn_match_msg()
|
|
3659 {
|
|
3660 if (curbuf->b_syn_sync_linebreaks > 0)
|
|
3661 {
|
|
3662 MSG_PUTS(_("; match "));
|
|
3663 msg_outnum(curbuf->b_syn_sync_linebreaks);
|
|
3664 MSG_PUTS(_(" line breaks"));
|
|
3665 }
|
|
3666 }
|
|
3667
|
|
3668 static int last_matchgroup;
|
|
3669
|
|
3670 struct name_list
|
|
3671 {
|
|
3672 int flag;
|
|
3673 char *name;
|
|
3674 };
|
|
3675
|
|
3676 static void syn_list_flags __ARGS((struct name_list *nl, int flags, int attr));
|
|
3677
|
|
3678 /*
|
|
3679 * List one syntax item, for ":syntax" or "syntax list syntax_name".
|
|
3680 */
|
|
3681 static void
|
|
3682 syn_list_one(id, syncing, link_only)
|
|
3683 int id;
|
|
3684 int syncing; /* when TRUE: list syncing items */
|
|
3685 int link_only; /* when TRUE; list link-only too */
|
|
3686 {
|
|
3687 int attr;
|
|
3688 int idx;
|
|
3689 int did_header = FALSE;
|
|
3690 synpat_T *spp;
|
|
3691 static struct name_list namelist1[] =
|
|
3692 {
|
|
3693 {HL_DISPLAY, "display"},
|
|
3694 {HL_CONTAINED, "contained"},
|
|
3695 {HL_ONELINE, "oneline"},
|
|
3696 {HL_KEEPEND, "keepend"},
|
|
3697 {HL_EXTEND, "extend"},
|
|
3698 {HL_EXCLUDENL, "excludenl"},
|
|
3699 {HL_TRANSP, "transparent"},
|
|
3700 {HL_FOLD, "fold"},
|
|
3701 {0, NULL}
|
|
3702 };
|
|
3703 static struct name_list namelist2[] =
|
|
3704 {
|
|
3705 {HL_SKIPWHITE, "skipwhite"},
|
|
3706 {HL_SKIPNL, "skipnl"},
|
|
3707 {HL_SKIPEMPTY, "skipempty"},
|
|
3708 {0, NULL}
|
|
3709 };
|
|
3710
|
|
3711 attr = hl_attr(HLF_D); /* highlight like directories */
|
|
3712
|
|
3713 /* list the keywords for "id" */
|
|
3714 if (!syncing)
|
|
3715 {
|
134
|
3716 did_header = syn_list_keywords(id, &curbuf->b_keywtab, FALSE, attr);
|
|
3717 did_header = syn_list_keywords(id, &curbuf->b_keywtab_ic,
|
7
|
3718 did_header, attr);
|
|
3719 }
|
|
3720
|
|
3721 /* list the patterns for "id" */
|
|
3722 for (idx = 0; idx < curbuf->b_syn_patterns.ga_len && !got_int; ++idx)
|
|
3723 {
|
|
3724 spp = &(SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[idx]);
|
|
3725 if (spp->sp_syn.id != id || spp->sp_syncing != syncing)
|
|
3726 continue;
|
|
3727
|
|
3728 (void)syn_list_header(did_header, 999, id);
|
|
3729 did_header = TRUE;
|
|
3730 last_matchgroup = 0;
|
|
3731 if (spp->sp_type == SPTYPE_MATCH)
|
|
3732 {
|
|
3733 put_pattern("match", ' ', spp, attr);
|
|
3734 msg_putchar(' ');
|
|
3735 }
|
|
3736 else if (spp->sp_type == SPTYPE_START)
|
|
3737 {
|
|
3738 while (SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[idx].sp_type == SPTYPE_START)
|
|
3739 put_pattern("start", '=', &SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[idx++], attr);
|
|
3740 if (SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[idx].sp_type == SPTYPE_SKIP)
|
|
3741 put_pattern("skip", '=', &SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[idx++], attr);
|
|
3742 while (idx < curbuf->b_syn_patterns.ga_len
|
|
3743 && SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[idx].sp_type == SPTYPE_END)
|
|
3744 put_pattern("end", '=', &SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[idx++], attr);
|
|
3745 --idx;
|
|
3746 msg_putchar(' ');
|
|
3747 }
|
|
3748 syn_list_flags(namelist1, spp->sp_flags, attr);
|
|
3749
|
|
3750 if (spp->sp_cont_list != NULL)
|
|
3751 put_id_list((char_u *)"contains", spp->sp_cont_list, attr);
|
|
3752
|
|
3753 if (spp->sp_syn.cont_in_list != NULL)
|
|
3754 put_id_list((char_u *)"containedin",
|
|
3755 spp->sp_syn.cont_in_list, attr);
|
|
3756
|
|
3757 if (spp->sp_next_list != NULL)
|
|
3758 {
|
|
3759 put_id_list((char_u *)"nextgroup", spp->sp_next_list, attr);
|
|
3760 syn_list_flags(namelist2, spp->sp_flags, attr);
|
|
3761 }
|
|
3762 if (spp->sp_flags & (HL_SYNC_HERE|HL_SYNC_THERE))
|
|
3763 {
|
|
3764 if (spp->sp_flags & HL_SYNC_HERE)
|
|
3765 msg_puts_attr((char_u *)"grouphere", attr);
|
|
3766 else
|
|
3767 msg_puts_attr((char_u *)"groupthere", attr);
|
|
3768 msg_putchar(' ');
|
|
3769 if (spp->sp_sync_idx >= 0)
|
|
3770 msg_outtrans(HL_TABLE()[SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)
|
|
3771 [spp->sp_sync_idx].sp_syn.id - 1].sg_name);
|
|
3772 else
|
|
3773 MSG_PUTS("NONE");
|
|
3774 msg_putchar(' ');
|
|
3775 }
|
|
3776 }
|
|
3777
|
|
3778 /* list the link, if there is one */
|
|
3779 if (HL_TABLE()[id - 1].sg_link && (did_header || link_only) && !got_int)
|
|
3780 {
|
|
3781 (void)syn_list_header(did_header, 999, id);
|
|
3782 msg_puts_attr((char_u *)"links to", attr);
|
|
3783 msg_putchar(' ');
|
|
3784 msg_outtrans(HL_TABLE()[HL_TABLE()[id - 1].sg_link - 1].sg_name);
|
|
3785 }
|
|
3786 }
|
|
3787
|
|
3788 static void
|
|
3789 syn_list_flags(nl, flags, attr)
|
|
3790 struct name_list *nl;
|
|
3791 int flags;
|
|
3792 int attr;
|
|
3793 {
|
|
3794 int i;
|
|
3795
|
|
3796 for (i = 0; nl[i].flag != 0; ++i)
|
|
3797 if (flags & nl[i].flag)
|
|
3798 {
|
|
3799 msg_puts_attr((char_u *)nl[i].name, attr);
|
|
3800 msg_putchar(' ');
|
|
3801 }
|
|
3802 }
|
|
3803
|
|
3804 /*
|
|
3805 * List one syntax cluster, for ":syntax" or "syntax list syntax_name".
|
|
3806 */
|
|
3807 static void
|
|
3808 syn_list_cluster(id)
|
|
3809 int id;
|
|
3810 {
|
|
3811 int endcol = 15;
|
|
3812
|
|
3813 /* slight hack: roughly duplicate the guts of syn_list_header() */
|
|
3814 msg_putchar('\n');
|
|
3815 msg_outtrans(SYN_CLSTR(curbuf)[id].scl_name);
|
|
3816
|
|
3817 if (msg_col >= endcol) /* output at least one space */
|
|
3818 endcol = msg_col + 1;
|
|
3819 if (Columns <= endcol) /* avoid hang for tiny window */
|
|
3820 endcol = Columns - 1;
|
|
3821
|
|
3822 msg_advance(endcol);
|
|
3823 if (SYN_CLSTR(curbuf)[id].scl_list != NULL)
|
|
3824 {
|
|
3825 put_id_list((char_u *)"cluster", SYN_CLSTR(curbuf)[id].scl_list,
|
|
3826 hl_attr(HLF_D));
|
|
3827 }
|
|
3828 else
|
|
3829 {
|
|
3830 msg_puts_attr((char_u *)"cluster", hl_attr(HLF_D));
|
|
3831 msg_puts((char_u *)"=NONE");
|
|
3832 }
|
|
3833 }
|
|
3834
|
|
3835 static void
|
|
3836 put_id_list(name, list, attr)
|
|
3837 char_u *name;
|
|
3838 short *list;
|
|
3839 int attr;
|
|
3840 {
|
|
3841 short *p;
|
|
3842
|
|
3843 msg_puts_attr(name, attr);
|
|
3844 msg_putchar('=');
|
|
3845 for (p = list; *p; ++p)
|
|
3846 {
|
|
3847 if (*p >= SYNID_ALLBUT && *p < SYNID_TOP)
|
|
3848 {
|
|
3849 if (p[1])
|
|
3850 MSG_PUTS("ALLBUT");
|
|
3851 else
|
|
3852 MSG_PUTS("ALL");
|
|
3853 }
|
|
3854 else if (*p >= SYNID_TOP && *p < SYNID_CONTAINED)
|
|
3855 {
|
|
3856 MSG_PUTS("TOP");
|
|
3857 }
|
|
3858 else if (*p >= SYNID_CONTAINED && *p < SYNID_CLUSTER)
|
|
3859 {
|
|
3860 MSG_PUTS("CONTAINED");
|
|
3861 }
|
|
3862 else if (*p >= SYNID_CLUSTER)
|
|
3863 {
|
|
3864 short scl_id = *p - SYNID_CLUSTER;
|
|
3865
|
|
3866 msg_putchar('@');
|
|
3867 msg_outtrans(SYN_CLSTR(curbuf)[scl_id].scl_name);
|
|
3868 }
|
|
3869 else
|
|
3870 msg_outtrans(HL_TABLE()[*p - 1].sg_name);
|
|
3871 if (p[1])
|
|
3872 msg_putchar(',');
|
|
3873 }
|
|
3874 msg_putchar(' ');
|
|
3875 }
|
|
3876
|
|
3877 static void
|
|
3878 put_pattern(s, c, spp, attr)
|
|
3879 char *s;
|
|
3880 int c;
|
|
3881 synpat_T *spp;
|
|
3882 int attr;
|
|
3883 {
|
|
3884 long n;
|
|
3885 int mask;
|
|
3886 int first;
|
|
3887 static char *sepchars = "/+=-#@\"|'^&";
|
|
3888 int i;
|
|
3889
|
|
3890 /* May have to write "matchgroup=group" */
|
|
3891 if (last_matchgroup != spp->sp_syn_match_id)
|
|
3892 {
|
|
3893 last_matchgroup = spp->sp_syn_match_id;
|
|
3894 msg_puts_attr((char_u *)"matchgroup", attr);
|
|
3895 msg_putchar('=');
|
|
3896 if (last_matchgroup == 0)
|
|
3897 msg_outtrans((char_u *)"NONE");
|
|
3898 else
|
|
3899 msg_outtrans(HL_TABLE()[last_matchgroup - 1].sg_name);
|
|
3900 msg_putchar(' ');
|
|
3901 }
|
|
3902
|
|
3903 /* output the name of the pattern and an '=' or ' ' */
|
|
3904 msg_puts_attr((char_u *)s, attr);
|
|
3905 msg_putchar(c);
|
|
3906
|
|
3907 /* output the pattern, in between a char that is not in the pattern */
|
|
3908 for (i = 0; vim_strchr(spp->sp_pattern, sepchars[i]) != NULL; )
|
|
3909 if (sepchars[++i] == NUL)
|
|
3910 {
|
|
3911 i = 0; /* no good char found, just use the first one */
|
|
3912 break;
|
|
3913 }
|
|
3914 msg_putchar(sepchars[i]);
|
|
3915 msg_outtrans(spp->sp_pattern);
|
|
3916 msg_putchar(sepchars[i]);
|
|
3917
|
|
3918 /* output any pattern options */
|
|
3919 first = TRUE;
|
|
3920 for (i = 0; i < SPO_COUNT; ++i)
|
|
3921 {
|
|
3922 mask = (1 << i);
|
|
3923 if (spp->sp_off_flags & (mask + (mask << SPO_COUNT)))
|
|
3924 {
|
|
3925 if (!first)
|
|
3926 msg_putchar(','); /* separate with commas */
|
|
3927 msg_puts((char_u *)spo_name_tab[i]);
|
|
3928 n = spp->sp_offsets[i];
|
|
3929 if (i != SPO_LC_OFF)
|
|
3930 {
|
|
3931 if (spp->sp_off_flags & mask)
|
|
3932 msg_putchar('s');
|
|
3933 else
|
|
3934 msg_putchar('e');
|
|
3935 if (n > 0)
|
|
3936 msg_putchar('+');
|
|
3937 }
|
|
3938 if (n || i == SPO_LC_OFF)
|
|
3939 msg_outnum(n);
|
|
3940 first = FALSE;
|
|
3941 }
|
|
3942 }
|
|
3943 msg_putchar(' ');
|
|
3944 }
|
|
3945
|
|
3946 /*
|
|
3947 * List or clear the keywords for one syntax group.
|
|
3948 * Return TRUE if the header has been printed.
|
|
3949 */
|
|
3950 static int
|
134
|
3951 syn_list_keywords(id, ht, did_header, attr)
|
7
|
3952 int id;
|
134
|
3953 hashtab_T *ht;
|
7
|
3954 int did_header; /* header has already been printed */
|
|
3955 int attr;
|
|
3956 {
|
|
3957 int outlen;
|
134
|
3958 hashitem_T *hi;
|
|
3959 keyentry_T *kp;
|
|
3960 int todo;
|
7
|
3961 int prev_contained = 0;
|
|
3962 short *prev_next_list = NULL;
|
|
3963 short *prev_cont_in_list = NULL;
|
|
3964 int prev_skipnl = 0;
|
|
3965 int prev_skipwhite = 0;
|
|
3966 int prev_skipempty = 0;
|
|
3967
|
|
3968 /*
|
|
3969 * Unfortunately, this list of keywords is not sorted on alphabet but on
|
|
3970 * hash value...
|
|
3971 */
|
835
|
3972 todo = (int)ht->ht_used;
|
134
|
3973 for (hi = ht->ht_array; todo > 0 && !got_int; ++hi)
|
|
3974 {
|
|
3975 if (!HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi))
|
|
3976 {
|
|
3977 --todo;
|
|
3978 for (kp = HI2KE(hi); kp != NULL && !got_int; kp = kp->ke_next)
|
7
|
3979 {
|
134
|
3980 if (kp->k_syn.id == id)
|
7
|
3981 {
|
134
|
3982 if (prev_contained != (kp->flags & HL_CONTAINED)
|
|
3983 || prev_skipnl != (kp->flags & HL_SKIPNL)
|
|
3984 || prev_skipwhite != (kp->flags & HL_SKIPWHITE)
|
|
3985 || prev_skipempty != (kp->flags & HL_SKIPEMPTY)
|
|
3986 || prev_cont_in_list != kp->k_syn.cont_in_list
|
|
3987 || prev_next_list != kp->next_list)
|
|
3988 outlen = 9999;
|
|
3989 else
|
|
3990 outlen = (int)STRLEN(kp->keyword);
|
|
3991 /* output "contained" and "nextgroup" on each line */
|
|
3992 if (syn_list_header(did_header, outlen, id))
|
|
3993 {
|
|
3994 prev_contained = 0;
|
|
3995 prev_next_list = NULL;
|
|
3996 prev_cont_in_list = NULL;
|
|
3997 prev_skipnl = 0;
|
|
3998 prev_skipwhite = 0;
|
|
3999 prev_skipempty = 0;
|
|
4000 }
|
|
4001 did_header = TRUE;
|
|
4002 if (prev_contained != (kp->flags & HL_CONTAINED))
|
|
4003 {
|
|
4004 msg_puts_attr((char_u *)"contained", attr);
|
|
4005 msg_putchar(' ');
|
|
4006 prev_contained = (kp->flags & HL_CONTAINED);
|
|
4007 }
|
|
4008 if (kp->k_syn.cont_in_list != prev_cont_in_list)
|
|
4009 {
|
|
4010 put_id_list((char_u *)"containedin",
|
|
4011 kp->k_syn.cont_in_list, attr);
|
|
4012 msg_putchar(' ');
|
|
4013 prev_cont_in_list = kp->k_syn.cont_in_list;
|
|
4014 }
|
|
4015 if (kp->next_list != prev_next_list)
|
|
4016 {
|
|
4017 put_id_list((char_u *)"nextgroup", kp->next_list, attr);
|
|
4018 msg_putchar(' ');
|
|
4019 prev_next_list = kp->next_list;
|
|
4020 if (kp->flags & HL_SKIPNL)
|
|
4021 {
|
|
4022 msg_puts_attr((char_u *)"skipnl", attr);
|
|
4023 msg_putchar(' ');
|
|
4024 prev_skipnl = (kp->flags & HL_SKIPNL);
|
|
4025 }
|
|
4026 if (kp->flags & HL_SKIPWHITE)
|
|
4027 {
|
|
4028 msg_puts_attr((char_u *)"skipwhite", attr);
|
|
4029 msg_putchar(' ');
|
|
4030 prev_skipwhite = (kp->flags & HL_SKIPWHITE);
|
|
4031 }
|
|
4032 if (kp->flags & HL_SKIPEMPTY)
|
|
4033 {
|
|
4034 msg_puts_attr((char_u *)"skipempty", attr);
|
|
4035 msg_putchar(' ');
|
|
4036 prev_skipempty = (kp->flags & HL_SKIPEMPTY);
|
|
4037 }
|
|
4038 }
|
|
4039 msg_outtrans(kp->keyword);
|
7
|
4040 }
|
|
4041 }
|
|
4042 }
|
|
4043 }
|
|
4044
|
|
4045 return did_header;
|
|
4046 }
|
|
4047
|
|
4048 static void
|
134
|
4049 syn_clear_keyword(id, ht)
|
7
|
4050 int id;
|
134
|
4051 hashtab_T *ht;
|
|
4052 {
|
|
4053 hashitem_T *hi;
|
|
4054 keyentry_T *kp;
|
|
4055 keyentry_T *kp_prev;
|
|
4056 keyentry_T *kp_next;
|
|
4057 int todo;
|
|
4058
|
|
4059 hash_lock(ht);
|
835
|
4060 todo = (int)ht->ht_used;
|
134
|
4061 for (hi = ht->ht_array; todo > 0; ++hi)
|
|
4062 {
|
|
4063 if (!HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi))
|
|
4064 {
|
|
4065 --todo;
|
|
4066 kp_prev = NULL;
|
|
4067 for (kp = HI2KE(hi); kp != NULL; )
|
7
|
4068 {
|
134
|
4069 if (kp->k_syn.id == id)
|
|
4070 {
|
|
4071 kp_next = kp->ke_next;
|
|
4072 if (kp_prev == NULL)
|
|
4073 {
|
|
4074 if (kp_next == NULL)
|
|
4075 hash_remove(ht, hi);
|
|
4076 else
|
|
4077 hi->hi_key = KE2HIKEY(kp_next);
|
|
4078 }
|
|
4079 else
|
|
4080 kp_prev->ke_next = kp_next;
|
|
4081 vim_free(kp->next_list);
|
|
4082 vim_free(kp->k_syn.cont_in_list);
|
|
4083 vim_free(kp);
|
|
4084 kp = kp_next;
|
|
4085 }
|
7
|
4086 else
|
134
|
4087 {
|
|
4088 kp_prev = kp;
|
|
4089 kp = kp->ke_next;
|
|
4090 }
|
7
|
4091 }
|
134
|
4092 }
|
|
4093 }
|
|
4094 hash_unlock(ht);
|
|
4095 }
|
|
4096
|
|
4097 /*
|
|
4098 * Clear a whole keyword table.
|
7
|
4099 */
|
|
4100 static void
|
134
|
4101 clear_keywtab(ht)
|
|
4102 hashtab_T *ht;
|
|
4103 {
|
|
4104 hashitem_T *hi;
|
|
4105 int todo;
|
|
4106 keyentry_T *kp;
|
|
4107 keyentry_T *kp_next;
|
|
4108
|
835
|
4109 todo = (int)ht->ht_used;
|
134
|
4110 for (hi = ht->ht_array; todo > 0; ++hi)
|
|
4111 {
|
|
4112 if (!HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi))
|
|
4113 {
|
|
4114 --todo;
|
|
4115 kp = HI2KE(hi);
|
|
4116 for (kp = HI2KE(hi); kp != NULL; kp = kp_next)
|
7
|
4117 {
|
134
|
4118 kp_next = kp->ke_next;
|
|
4119 vim_free(kp->next_list);
|
|
4120 vim_free(kp->k_syn.cont_in_list);
|
|
4121 vim_free(kp);
|
7
|
4122 }
|
134
|
4123 }
|
|
4124 }
|
|
4125 hash_clear(ht);
|
|
4126 hash_init(ht);
|
7
|
4127 }
|
|
4128
|
|
4129 /*
|
|
4130 * Add a keyword to the list of keywords.
|
|
4131 */
|
|
4132 static void
|
|
4133 add_keyword(name, id, flags, cont_in_list, next_list)
|
|
4134 char_u *name; /* name of keyword */
|
|
4135 int id; /* group ID for this keyword */
|
|
4136 int flags; /* flags for this keyword */
|
|
4137 short *cont_in_list; /* containedin for this keyword */
|
|
4138 short *next_list; /* nextgroup for this keyword */
|
|
4139 {
|
134
|
4140 keyentry_T *kp;
|
|
4141 hashtab_T *ht;
|
|
4142 hashitem_T *hi;
|
154
|
4143 char_u *name_ic;
|
134
|
4144 long_u hash;
|
154
|
4145 char_u name_folded[MAXKEYWLEN + 1];
|
7
|
4146
|
|
4147 if (curbuf->b_syn_ic)
|
154
|
4148 name_ic = str_foldcase(name, (int)STRLEN(name),
|
|
4149 name_folded, MAXKEYWLEN + 1);
|
|
4150 else
|
|
4151 name_ic = name;
|
134
|
4152 kp = (keyentry_T *)alloc((int)(sizeof(keyentry_T) + STRLEN(name_ic)));
|
|
4153 if (kp == NULL)
|
|
4154 return;
|
|
4155 STRCPY(kp->keyword, name_ic);
|
|
4156 kp->k_syn.id = id;
|
|
4157 kp->k_syn.inc_tag = current_syn_inc_tag;
|
|
4158 kp->flags = flags;
|
|
4159 kp->k_syn.cont_in_list = copy_id_list(cont_in_list);
|
|
4160 if (cont_in_list != NULL)
|
|
4161 curbuf->b_syn_containedin = TRUE;
|
|
4162 kp->next_list = copy_id_list(next_list);
|
|
4163
|
|
4164 if (curbuf->b_syn_ic)
|
|
4165 ht = &curbuf->b_keywtab_ic;
|
7
|
4166 else
|
134
|
4167 ht = &curbuf->b_keywtab;
|
|
4168
|
|
4169 hash = hash_hash(kp->keyword);
|
|
4170 hi = hash_lookup(ht, kp->keyword, hash);
|
|
4171 if (HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi))
|
|
4172 {
|
|
4173 /* new keyword, add to hashtable */
|
|
4174 kp->ke_next = NULL;
|
|
4175 hash_add_item(ht, hi, kp->keyword, hash);
|
|
4176 }
|
|
4177 else
|
|
4178 {
|
|
4179 /* keyword already exists, prepend to list */
|
|
4180 kp->ke_next = HI2KE(hi);
|
|
4181 hi->hi_key = KE2HIKEY(kp);
|
|
4182 }
|
7
|
4183 }
|
|
4184
|
|
4185 /*
|
|
4186 * Get the start and end of the group name argument.
|
|
4187 * Return a pointer to the first argument.
|
|
4188 * Return NULL if the end of the command was found instead of further args.
|
|
4189 */
|
|
4190 static char_u *
|
|
4191 get_group_name(arg, name_end)
|
|
4192 char_u *arg; /* start of the argument */
|
|
4193 char_u **name_end; /* pointer to end of the name */
|
|
4194 {
|
|
4195 char_u *rest;
|
|
4196
|
|
4197 *name_end = skiptowhite(arg);
|
|
4198 rest = skipwhite(*name_end);
|
|
4199
|
|
4200 /*
|
|
4201 * Check if there are enough arguments. The first argument may be a
|
|
4202 * pattern, where '|' is allowed, so only check for NUL.
|
|
4203 */
|
|
4204 if (ends_excmd(*arg) || *rest == NUL)
|
|
4205 return NULL;
|
|
4206 return rest;
|
|
4207 }
|
|
4208
|
|
4209 /*
|
|
4210 * Check for syntax command option arguments.
|
|
4211 * This can be called at any place in the list of arguments, and just picks
|
|
4212 * out the arguments that are known. Can be called several times in a row to
|
|
4213 * collect all options in between other arguments.
|
|
4214 * Return a pointer to the next argument (which isn't an option).
|
|
4215 * Return NULL for any error;
|
|
4216 */
|
|
4217 static char_u *
|
154
|
4218 get_syn_options(arg, opt)
|
|
4219 char_u *arg; /* next argument to be checked */
|
|
4220 syn_opt_arg_T *opt; /* various things */
|
|
4221 {
|
7
|
4222 char_u *gname_start, *gname;
|
|
4223 int syn_id;
|
|
4224 int len;
|
154
|
4225 char *p;
|
7
|
4226 int i;
|
|
4227 int fidx;
|
|
4228 static struct flag
|
|
4229 {
|
|
4230 char *name;
|
154
|
4231 int argtype;
|
|
4232 int flags;
|
|
4233 } flagtab[] = { {"cCoOnNtTaAiInNeEdD", 0, HL_CONTAINED},
|
|
4234 {"oOnNeElLiInNeE", 0, HL_ONELINE},
|
|
4235 {"kKeEeEpPeEnNdD", 0, HL_KEEPEND},
|
|
4236 {"eExXtTeEnNdD", 0, HL_EXTEND},
|
|
4237 {"eExXcClLuUdDeEnNlL", 0, HL_EXCLUDENL},
|
|
4238 {"tTrRaAnNsSpPaArReEnNtT", 0, HL_TRANSP},
|
|
4239 {"sSkKiIpPnNlL", 0, HL_SKIPNL},
|
|
4240 {"sSkKiIpPwWhHiItTeE", 0, HL_SKIPWHITE},
|
|
4241 {"sSkKiIpPeEmMpPtTyY", 0, HL_SKIPEMPTY},
|
|
4242 {"gGrRoOuUpPhHeErReE", 0, HL_SYNC_HERE},
|
|
4243 {"gGrRoOuUpPtThHeErReE", 0, HL_SYNC_THERE},
|
|
4244 {"dDiIsSpPlLaAyY", 0, HL_DISPLAY},
|
|
4245 {"fFoOlLdD", 0, HL_FOLD},
|
|
4246 {"cCoOnNtTaAiInNsS", 1, 0},
|
|
4247 {"cCoOnNtTaAiInNeEdDiInN", 2, 0},
|
|
4248 {"nNeExXtTgGrRoOuUpP", 3, 0},
|
7
|
4249 };
|
154
|
4250 static char *first_letters = "cCoOkKeEtTsSgGdDfFnN";
|
7
|
4251
|
|
4252 if (arg == NULL) /* already detected error */
|
|
4253 return NULL;
|
|
4254
|
|
4255 for (;;)
|
|
4256 {
|
154
|
4257 /*
|
|
4258 * This is used very often when a large number of keywords is defined.
|
|
4259 * Need to skip quickly when no option name is found.
|
|
4260 * Also avoid tolower(), it's slow.
|
|
4261 */
|
|
4262 if (strchr(first_letters, *arg) == NULL)
|
|
4263 break;
|
7
|
4264
|
|
4265 for (fidx = sizeof(flagtab) / sizeof(struct flag); --fidx >= 0; )
|
|
4266 {
|
154
|
4267 p = flagtab[fidx].name;
|
|
4268 for (i = 0, len = 0; p[i] != NUL; i += 2, ++len)
|
|
4269 if (arg[len] != p[i] && arg[len] != p[i + 1])
|
|
4270 break;
|
|
4271 if (p[i] == NUL && (vim_iswhite(arg[len])
|
|
4272 || (flagtab[fidx].argtype > 0
|
|
4273 ? arg[len] == '='
|
|
4274 : ends_excmd(arg[len]))))
|
7
|
4275 {
|
154
|
4276 if (opt->keyword
|
|
4277 && (flagtab[fidx].flags == HL_DISPLAY
|
|
4278 || flagtab[fidx].flags == HL_FOLD
|
|
4279 || flagtab[fidx].flags == HL_EXTEND))
|
7
|
4280 /* treat "display", "fold" and "extend" as a keyword */
|
|
4281 fidx = -1;
|
|
4282 break;
|
|
4283 }
|
|
4284 }
|
154
|
4285 if (fidx < 0) /* no match found */
|
|
4286 break;
|
|
4287
|
|
4288 if (flagtab[fidx].argtype == 1)
|
|
4289 {
|
|
4290 if (!opt->has_cont_list)
|
7
|
4291 {
|
|
4292 EMSG(_("E395: contains argument not accepted here"));
|
|
4293 return NULL;
|
|
4294 }
|
154
|
4295 if (get_id_list(&arg, 8, &opt->cont_list) == FAIL)
|
7
|
4296 return NULL;
|
|
4297 }
|
154
|
4298 else if (flagtab[fidx].argtype == 2)
|
|
4299 {
|
|
4300 #if 0 /* cannot happen */
|
|
4301 if (opt->cont_in_list == NULL)
|
7
|
4302 {
|
|
4303 EMSG(_("E396: containedin argument not accepted here"));
|
|
4304 return NULL;
|
|
4305 }
|
154
|
4306 #endif
|
|
4307 if (get_id_list(&arg, 11, &opt->cont_in_list) == FAIL)
|
7
|
4308 return NULL;
|
|
4309 }
|
154
|
4310 else if (flagtab[fidx].argtype == 3)
|
|
4311 {
|
|
4312 if (get_id_list(&arg, 9, &opt->next_list) == FAIL)
|
7
|
4313 return NULL;
|
|
4314 }
|
|
4315 else
|
154
|
4316 {
|
|
4317 opt->flags |= flagtab[fidx].flags;
|
|
4318 arg = skipwhite(arg + len);
|
|
4319
|
|
4320 if (flagtab[fidx].flags == HL_SYNC_HERE
|
|
4321 || flagtab[fidx].flags == HL_SYNC_THERE)
|
|
4322 {
|
|
4323 if (opt->sync_idx == NULL)
|
|
4324 {
|
|
4325 EMSG(_("E393: group[t]here not accepted here"));
|
|
4326 return NULL;
|
|
4327 }
|
|
4328 gname_start = arg;
|
|
4329 arg = skiptowhite(arg);
|
|
4330 if (gname_start == arg)
|
|
4331 return NULL;
|
|
4332 gname = vim_strnsave(gname_start, (int)(arg - gname_start));
|
|
4333 if (gname == NULL)
|
|
4334 return NULL;
|
|
4335 if (STRCMP(gname, "NONE") == 0)
|
|
4336 *opt->sync_idx = NONE_IDX;
|
|
4337 else
|
|
4338 {
|
|
4339 syn_id = syn_name2id(gname);
|
|
4340 for (i = curbuf->b_syn_patterns.ga_len; --i >= 0; )
|
|
4341 if (SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[i].sp_syn.id == syn_id
|
|
4342 && SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[i].sp_type == SPTYPE_START)
|
|
4343 {
|
|
4344 *opt->sync_idx = i;
|
|
4345 break;
|
|
4346 }
|
|
4347 if (i < 0)
|
|
4348 {
|
|
4349 EMSG2(_("E394: Didn't find region item for %s"), gname);
|
|
4350 vim_free(gname);
|
|
4351 return NULL;
|
|
4352 }
|
|
4353 }
|
|
4354
|
|
4355 vim_free(gname);
|
|
4356 arg = skipwhite(arg);
|
|
4357 }
|
|
4358 #ifdef FEAT_FOLDING
|
|
4359 else if (flagtab[fidx].flags == HL_FOLD
|
|
4360 && foldmethodIsSyntax(curwin))
|
|
4361 /* Need to update folds later. */
|
|
4362 foldUpdateAll(curwin);
|
|
4363 #endif
|
|
4364 }
|
|
4365 }
|
7
|
4366
|
|
4367 return arg;
|
|
4368 }
|
|
4369
|
|
4370 /*
|
|
4371 * Adjustments to syntax item when declared in a ":syn include"'d file.
|
|
4372 * Set the contained flag, and if the item is not already contained, add it
|
|
4373 * to the specified top-level group, if any.
|
|
4374 */
|
|
4375 static void
|
|
4376 syn_incl_toplevel(id, flagsp)
|
|
4377 int id;
|
|
4378 int *flagsp;
|
|
4379 {
|
|
4380 if ((*flagsp & HL_CONTAINED) || curbuf->b_syn_topgrp == 0)
|
|
4381 return;
|
|
4382 *flagsp |= HL_CONTAINED;
|
|
4383 if (curbuf->b_syn_topgrp >= SYNID_CLUSTER)
|
|
4384 {
|
|
4385 /* We have to alloc this, because syn_combine_list() will free it. */
|
|
4386 short *grp_list = (short *)alloc((unsigned)(2 * sizeof(short)));
|
|
4387 int tlg_id = curbuf->b_syn_topgrp - SYNID_CLUSTER;
|
|
4388
|
|
4389 if (grp_list != NULL)
|
|
4390 {
|
|
4391 grp_list[0] = id;
|
|
4392 grp_list[1] = 0;
|
|
4393 syn_combine_list(&SYN_CLSTR(curbuf)[tlg_id].scl_list, &grp_list,
|
|
4394 CLUSTER_ADD);
|
|
4395 }
|
|
4396 }
|
|
4397 }
|
|
4398
|
|
4399 /*
|
|
4400 * Handle ":syntax include [@{group-name}] filename" command.
|
|
4401 */
|
|
4402 /* ARGSUSED */
|
|
4403 static void
|
|
4404 syn_cmd_include(eap, syncing)
|
|
4405 exarg_T *eap;
|
|
4406 int syncing; /* not used */
|
|
4407 {
|
|
4408 char_u *arg = eap->arg;
|
|
4409 int sgl_id = 1;
|
|
4410 char_u *group_name_end;
|
|
4411 char_u *rest;
|
|
4412 char_u *errormsg = NULL;
|
|
4413 int prev_toplvl_grp;
|
|
4414 int prev_syn_inc_tag;
|
|
4415 int source = FALSE;
|
|
4416
|
|
4417 eap->nextcmd = find_nextcmd(arg);
|
|
4418 if (eap->skip)
|
|
4419 return;
|
|
4420
|
|
4421 if (arg[0] == '@')
|
|
4422 {
|
|
4423 ++arg;
|
|
4424 rest = get_group_name(arg, &group_name_end);
|
|
4425 if (rest == NULL)
|
|
4426 {
|
|
4427 EMSG((char_u *)_("E397: Filename required"));
|
|
4428 return;
|
|
4429 }
|
|
4430 sgl_id = syn_check_cluster(arg, (int)(group_name_end - arg));
|
|
4431 /* separate_nextcmd() and expand_filename() depend on this */
|
|
4432 eap->arg = rest;
|
|
4433 }
|
|
4434
|
|
4435 /*
|
|
4436 * Everything that's left, up to the next command, should be the
|
|
4437 * filename to include.
|
|
4438 */
|
|
4439 eap->argt |= (XFILE | NOSPC);
|
|
4440 separate_nextcmd(eap);
|
|
4441 if (*eap->arg == '<' || *eap->arg == '$' || mch_isFullName(eap->arg))
|
|
4442 {
|
|
4443 /* For an absolute path, "$VIM/..." or "<sfile>.." we ":source" the
|
|
4444 * file. Need to expand the file name first. In other cases
|
|
4445 * ":runtime!" is used. */
|
|
4446 source = TRUE;
|
|
4447 if (expand_filename(eap, syn_cmdlinep, &errormsg) == FAIL)
|
|
4448 {
|
|
4449 if (errormsg != NULL)
|
|
4450 EMSG(errormsg);
|
|
4451 return;
|
|
4452 }
|
|
4453 }
|
|
4454
|
|
4455 /*
|
|
4456 * Save and restore the existing top-level grouplist id and ":syn
|
|
4457 * include" tag around the actual inclusion.
|
|
4458 */
|
|
4459 prev_syn_inc_tag = current_syn_inc_tag;
|
|
4460 current_syn_inc_tag = ++running_syn_inc_tag;
|
|
4461 prev_toplvl_grp = curbuf->b_syn_topgrp;
|
|
4462 curbuf->b_syn_topgrp = sgl_id;
|
|
4463 if (source ? do_source(eap->arg, FALSE, FALSE) == FAIL
|
819
|
4464 : source_runtime(eap->arg, DOSO_NONE) == FAIL)
|
7
|
4465 EMSG2(_(e_notopen), eap->arg);
|
|
4466 curbuf->b_syn_topgrp = prev_toplvl_grp;
|
|
4467 current_syn_inc_tag = prev_syn_inc_tag;
|
|
4468 }
|
|
4469
|
|
4470 /*
|
|
4471 * Handle ":syntax keyword {group-name} [{option}] keyword .." command.
|
|
4472 */
|
|
4473 /* ARGSUSED */
|
|
4474 static void
|
|
4475 syn_cmd_keyword(eap, syncing)
|
|
4476 exarg_T *eap;
|
|
4477 int syncing; /* not used */
|
|
4478 {
|
|
4479 char_u *arg = eap->arg;
|
|
4480 char_u *group_name_end;
|
|
4481 int syn_id;
|
|
4482 char_u *rest;
|
|
4483 char_u *keyword_copy;
|
|
4484 char_u *p;
|
154
|
4485 char_u *kw;
|
|
4486 syn_opt_arg_T syn_opt_arg;
|
|
4487 int cnt;
|
7
|
4488
|
|
4489 rest = get_group_name(arg, &group_name_end);
|
|
4490
|
|
4491 if (rest != NULL)
|
|
4492 {
|
|
4493 syn_id = syn_check_group(arg, (int)(group_name_end - arg));
|
|
4494
|
|
4495 /* allocate a buffer, for removing the backslashes in the keyword */
|
|
4496 keyword_copy = alloc((unsigned)STRLEN(rest) + 1);
|
|
4497 if (keyword_copy != NULL)
|
|
4498 {
|
154
|
4499 syn_opt_arg.flags = 0;
|
|
4500 syn_opt_arg.keyword = TRUE;
|
|
4501 syn_opt_arg.sync_idx = NULL;
|
|
4502 syn_opt_arg.has_cont_list = FALSE;
|
|
4503 syn_opt_arg.cont_in_list = NULL;
|
|
4504 syn_opt_arg.next_list = NULL;
|
|
4505
|
7
|
4506 /*
|
|
4507 * The options given apply to ALL keywords, so all options must be
|
|
4508 * found before keywords can be created.
|
154
|
4509 * 1: collect the options and copy the keywords to keyword_copy.
|
7
|
4510 */
|
154
|
4511 cnt = 0;
|
|
4512 p = keyword_copy;
|
|
4513 for ( ; rest != NULL && !ends_excmd(*rest); rest = skipwhite(rest))
|
7
|
4514 {
|
154
|
4515 rest = get_syn_options(rest, &syn_opt_arg);
|
|
4516 if (rest == NULL || ends_excmd(*rest))
|
|
4517 break;
|
|
4518 /* Copy the keyword, removing backslashes, and add a NUL. */
|
|
4519 while (*rest != NUL && !vim_iswhite(*rest))
|
|
4520 {
|
|
4521 if (*rest == '\\' && rest[1] != NUL)
|
|
4522 ++rest;
|
|
4523 *p++ = *rest++;
|
|
4524 }
|
|
4525 *p++ = NUL;
|
|
4526 ++cnt;
|
|
4527 }
|
|
4528
|
|
4529 if (!eap->skip)
|
|
4530 {
|
|
4531 /* Adjust flags for use of ":syn include". */
|
|
4532 syn_incl_toplevel(syn_id, &syn_opt_arg.flags);
|
|
4533
|
7
|
4534 /*
|
154
|
4535 * 2: Add an entry for each keyword.
|
7
|
4536 */
|
154
|
4537 for (kw = keyword_copy; --cnt >= 0; kw += STRLEN(kw) + 1)
|
7
|
4538 {
|
154
|
4539 for (p = vim_strchr(kw, '['); ; )
|
7
|
4540 {
|
154
|
4541 if (p != NULL)
|
|
4542 *p = NUL;
|
|
4543 add_keyword(kw, syn_id, syn_opt_arg.flags,
|
|
4544 syn_opt_arg.cont_in_list,
|
|
4545 syn_opt_arg.next_list);
|
168
|
4546 if (p == NULL)
|
|
4547 break;
|
|
4548 if (p[1] == NUL)
|
|
4549 {
|
838
|
4550 EMSG2(_("E789: Missing ']': %s"), kw);
|
168
|
4551 kw = p + 2; /* skip over the NUL */
|
154
|
4552 break;
|
168
|
4553 }
|
|
4554 if (p[1] == ']')
|
|
4555 {
|
|
4556 kw = p + 1; /* skip over the "]" */
|
|
4557 break;
|
|
4558 }
|
154
|
4559 #ifdef FEAT_MBYTE
|
|
4560 if (has_mbyte)
|
7
|
4561 {
|
474
|
4562 int l = (*mb_ptr2len)(p + 1);
|
154
|
4563
|
|
4564 mch_memmove(p, p + 1, l);
|
|
4565 p += l;
|
|
4566 }
|
|
4567 else
|
7
|
4568 #endif
|
154
|
4569 {
|
|
4570 p[0] = p[1];
|
|
4571 ++p;
|
7
|
4572 }
|
|
4573 }
|
|
4574 }
|
|
4575 }
|
154
|
4576
|
7
|
4577 vim_free(keyword_copy);
|
168
|
4578 vim_free(syn_opt_arg.cont_in_list);
|
|
4579 vim_free(syn_opt_arg.next_list);
|
7
|
4580 }
|
|
4581 }
|
|
4582
|
|
4583 if (rest != NULL)
|
|
4584 eap->nextcmd = check_nextcmd(rest);
|
|
4585 else
|
|
4586 EMSG2(_(e_invarg2), arg);
|
|
4587
|
745
|
4588 redraw_curbuf_later(SOME_VALID);
|
7
|
4589 syn_stack_free_all(curbuf); /* Need to recompute all syntax. */
|
|
4590 }
|
|
4591
|
|
4592 /*
|
|
4593 * Handle ":syntax match {name} [{options}] {pattern} [{options}]".
|
|
4594 *
|
|
4595 * Also ":syntax sync match {name} [[grouphere | groupthere] {group-name}] .."
|
|
4596 */
|
|
4597 static void
|
|
4598 syn_cmd_match(eap, syncing)
|
|
4599 exarg_T *eap;
|
|
4600 int syncing; /* TRUE for ":syntax sync match .. " */
|
|
4601 {
|
|
4602 char_u *arg = eap->arg;
|
|
4603 char_u *group_name_end;
|
|
4604 char_u *rest;
|
|
4605 synpat_T item; /* the item found in the line */
|
|
4606 int syn_id;
|
|
4607 int idx;
|
154
|
4608 syn_opt_arg_T syn_opt_arg;
|
7
|
4609 int sync_idx = 0;
|
|
4610
|
|
4611 /* Isolate the group name, check for validity */
|
|
4612 rest = get_group_name(arg, &group_name_end);
|
|
4613
|
|
4614 /* Get options before the pattern */
|
154
|
4615 syn_opt_arg.flags = 0;
|
|
4616 syn_opt_arg.keyword = FALSE;
|
|
4617 syn_opt_arg.sync_idx = syncing ? &sync_idx : NULL;
|
|
4618 syn_opt_arg.has_cont_list = TRUE;
|
|
4619 syn_opt_arg.cont_list = NULL;
|
|
4620 syn_opt_arg.cont_in_list = NULL;
|
|
4621 syn_opt_arg.next_list = NULL;
|
|
4622 rest = get_syn_options(rest, &syn_opt_arg);
|
7
|
4623
|
|
4624 /* get the pattern. */
|
|
4625 init_syn_patterns();
|
|
4626 vim_memset(&item, 0, sizeof(item));
|
|
4627 rest = get_syn_pattern(rest, &item);
|
154
|
4628 if (vim_regcomp_had_eol() && !(syn_opt_arg.flags & HL_EXCLUDENL))
|
|
4629 syn_opt_arg.flags |= HL_HAS_EOL;
|
7
|
4630
|
|
4631 /* Get options after the pattern */
|
154
|
4632 rest = get_syn_options(rest, &syn_opt_arg);
|
7
|
4633
|
|
4634 if (rest != NULL) /* all arguments are valid */
|
|
4635 {
|
|
4636 /*
|
|
4637 * Check for trailing command and illegal trailing arguments.
|
|
4638 */
|
|
4639 eap->nextcmd = check_nextcmd(rest);
|
|
4640 if (!ends_excmd(*rest) || eap->skip)
|
|
4641 rest = NULL;
|
|
4642 else if (ga_grow(&curbuf->b_syn_patterns, 1) != FAIL
|
|
4643 && (syn_id = syn_check_group(arg,
|
|
4644 (int)(group_name_end - arg))) != 0)
|
|
4645 {
|
154
|
4646 syn_incl_toplevel(syn_id, &syn_opt_arg.flags);
|
7
|
4647 /*
|
|
4648 * Store the pattern in the syn_items list
|
|
4649 */
|
|
4650 idx = curbuf->b_syn_patterns.ga_len;
|
|
4651 SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[idx] = item;
|
|
4652 SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[idx].sp_syncing = syncing;
|
|
4653 SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[idx].sp_type = SPTYPE_MATCH;
|
|
4654 SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[idx].sp_syn.id = syn_id;
|
|
4655 SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[idx].sp_syn.inc_tag = current_syn_inc_tag;
|
154
|
4656 SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[idx].sp_flags = syn_opt_arg.flags;
|
7
|
4657 SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[idx].sp_sync_idx = sync_idx;
|
154
|
4658 SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[idx].sp_cont_list = syn_opt_arg.cont_list;
|
|
4659 SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[idx].sp_syn.cont_in_list =
|
|
4660 syn_opt_arg.cont_in_list;
|
|
4661 if (syn_opt_arg.cont_in_list != NULL)
|
7
|
4662 curbuf->b_syn_containedin = TRUE;
|
154
|
4663 SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[idx].sp_next_list = syn_opt_arg.next_list;
|
7
|
4664 ++curbuf->b_syn_patterns.ga_len;
|
|
4665
|
|
4666 /* remember that we found a match for syncing on */
|
154
|
4667 if (syn_opt_arg.flags & (HL_SYNC_HERE|HL_SYNC_THERE))
|
7
|
4668 curbuf->b_syn_sync_flags |= SF_MATCH;
|
|
4669 #ifdef FEAT_FOLDING
|
154
|
4670 if (syn_opt_arg.flags & HL_FOLD)
|
7
|
4671 ++curbuf->b_syn_folditems;
|
|
4672 #endif
|
|
4673
|
745
|
4674 redraw_curbuf_later(SOME_VALID);
|
7
|
4675 syn_stack_free_all(curbuf); /* Need to recompute all syntax. */
|
|
4676 return; /* don't free the progs and patterns now */
|
|
4677 }
|
|
4678 }
|
|
4679
|
|
4680 /*
|
|
4681 * Something failed, free the allocated memory.
|
|
4682 */
|
|
4683 vim_free(item.sp_prog);
|
|
4684 vim_free(item.sp_pattern);
|
154
|
4685 vim_free(syn_opt_arg.cont_list);
|
|
4686 vim_free(syn_opt_arg.cont_in_list);
|
|
4687 vim_free(syn_opt_arg.next_list);
|
7
|
4688
|
|
4689 if (rest == NULL)
|
|
4690 EMSG2(_(e_invarg2), arg);
|
|
4691 }
|
|
4692
|
|
4693 /*
|
|
4694 * Handle ":syntax region {group-name} [matchgroup={group-name}]
|
|
4695 * start {start} .. [skip {skip}] end {end} .. [{options}]".
|
|
4696 */
|
|
4697 static void
|
|
4698 syn_cmd_region(eap, syncing)
|
|
4699 exarg_T *eap;
|
|
4700 int syncing; /* TRUE for ":syntax sync region .." */
|
|
4701 {
|
|
4702 char_u *arg = eap->arg;
|
|
4703 char_u *group_name_end;
|
|
4704 char_u *rest; /* next arg, NULL on error */
|
|
4705 char_u *key_end;
|
|
4706 char_u *key = NULL;
|
|
4707 char_u *p;
|
|
4708 int item;
|
|
4709 #define ITEM_START 0
|
|
4710 #define ITEM_SKIP 1
|
|
4711 #define ITEM_END 2
|
|
4712 #define ITEM_MATCHGROUP 3
|
|
4713 struct pat_ptr
|
|
4714 {
|
|
4715 synpat_T *pp_synp; /* pointer to syn_pattern */
|
|
4716 int pp_matchgroup_id; /* matchgroup ID */
|
|
4717 struct pat_ptr *pp_next; /* pointer to next pat_ptr */
|
|
4718 } *(pat_ptrs[3]);
|
|
4719 /* patterns found in the line */
|
|
4720 struct pat_ptr *ppp;
|
|
4721 struct pat_ptr *ppp_next;
|
|
4722 int pat_count = 0; /* nr of syn_patterns found */
|
|
4723 int syn_id;
|
|
4724 int matchgroup_id = 0;
|
|
4725 int not_enough = FALSE; /* not enough arguments */
|
|
4726 int illegal = FALSE; /* illegal arguments */
|
|
4727 int success = FALSE;
|
|
4728 int idx;
|
154
|
4729 syn_opt_arg_T syn_opt_arg;
|
7
|
4730
|
|
4731 /* Isolate the group name, check for validity */
|
|
4732 rest = get_group_name(arg, &group_name_end);
|
|
4733
|
|
4734 pat_ptrs[0] = NULL;
|
|
4735 pat_ptrs[1] = NULL;
|
|
4736 pat_ptrs[2] = NULL;
|
|
4737
|
|
4738 init_syn_patterns();
|
|
4739
|
154
|
4740 syn_opt_arg.flags = 0;
|
|
4741 syn_opt_arg.keyword = FALSE;
|
|
4742 syn_opt_arg.sync_idx = NULL;
|
|
4743 syn_opt_arg.has_cont_list = TRUE;
|
|
4744 syn_opt_arg.cont_list = NULL;
|
|
4745 syn_opt_arg.cont_in_list = NULL;
|
|
4746 syn_opt_arg.next_list = NULL;
|
|
4747
|
7
|
4748 /*
|
|
4749 * get the options, patterns and matchgroup.
|
|
4750 */
|
|
4751 while (rest != NULL && !ends_excmd(*rest))
|
|
4752 {
|
|
4753 /* Check for option arguments */
|
154
|
4754 rest = get_syn_options(rest, &syn_opt_arg);
|
7
|
4755 if (rest == NULL || ends_excmd(*rest))
|
|
4756 break;
|
|
4757
|
|
4758 /* must be a pattern or matchgroup then */
|
|
4759 key_end = rest;
|
|
4760 while (*key_end && !vim_iswhite(*key_end) && *key_end != '=')
|
|
4761 ++key_end;
|
|
4762 vim_free(key);
|
|
4763 key = vim_strnsave_up(rest, (int)(key_end - rest));
|
|
4764 if (key == NULL) /* out of memory */
|
|
4765 {
|
|
4766 rest = NULL;
|
|
4767 break;
|
|
4768 }
|
|
4769 if (STRCMP(key, "MATCHGROUP") == 0)
|
|
4770 item = ITEM_MATCHGROUP;
|
|
4771 else if (STRCMP(key, "START") == 0)
|
|
4772 item = ITEM_START;
|
|
4773 else if (STRCMP(key, "END") == 0)
|
|
4774 item = ITEM_END;
|
|
4775 else if (STRCMP(key, "SKIP") == 0)
|
|
4776 {
|
|
4777 if (pat_ptrs[ITEM_SKIP] != NULL) /* one skip pattern allowed */
|
|
4778 {
|
|
4779 illegal = TRUE;
|
|
4780 break;
|
|
4781 }
|
|
4782 item = ITEM_SKIP;
|
|
4783 }
|
|
4784 else
|
|
4785 break;
|
|
4786 rest = skipwhite(key_end);
|
|
4787 if (*rest != '=')
|
|
4788 {
|
|
4789 rest = NULL;
|
|
4790 EMSG2(_("E398: Missing '=': %s"), arg);
|
|
4791 break;
|
|
4792 }
|
|
4793 rest = skipwhite(rest + 1);
|
|
4794 if (*rest == NUL)
|
|
4795 {
|
|
4796 not_enough = TRUE;
|
|
4797 break;
|
|
4798 }
|
|
4799
|
|
4800 if (item == ITEM_MATCHGROUP)
|
|
4801 {
|
|
4802 p = skiptowhite(rest);
|
|
4803 if ((p - rest == 4 && STRNCMP(rest, "NONE", 4) == 0) || eap->skip)
|
|
4804 matchgroup_id = 0;
|
|
4805 else
|
|
4806 {
|
|
4807 matchgroup_id = syn_check_group(rest, (int)(p - rest));
|
|
4808 if (matchgroup_id == 0)
|
|
4809 {
|
|
4810 illegal = TRUE;
|
|
4811 break;
|
|
4812 }
|
|
4813 }
|
|
4814 rest = skipwhite(p);
|
|
4815 }
|
|
4816 else
|
|
4817 {
|
|
4818 /*
|
|
4819 * Allocate room for a syn_pattern, and link it in the list of
|
|
4820 * syn_patterns for this item, at the start (because the list is
|
|
4821 * used from end to start).
|
|
4822 */
|
|
4823 ppp = (struct pat_ptr *)alloc((unsigned)sizeof(struct pat_ptr));
|
|
4824 if (ppp == NULL)
|
|
4825 {
|
|
4826 rest = NULL;
|
|
4827 break;
|
|
4828 }
|
|
4829 ppp->pp_next = pat_ptrs[item];
|
|
4830 pat_ptrs[item] = ppp;
|
|
4831 ppp->pp_synp = (synpat_T *)alloc_clear((unsigned)sizeof(synpat_T));
|
|
4832 if (ppp->pp_synp == NULL)
|
|
4833 {
|
|
4834 rest = NULL;
|
|
4835 break;
|
|
4836 }
|
|
4837
|
|
4838 /*
|
|
4839 * Get the syntax pattern and the following offset(s).
|
|
4840 */
|
|
4841 /* Enable the appropriate \z specials. */
|
|
4842 if (item == ITEM_START)
|
|
4843 reg_do_extmatch = REX_SET;
|
|
4844 else if (item == ITEM_SKIP || item == ITEM_END)
|
|
4845 reg_do_extmatch = REX_USE;
|
|
4846 rest = get_syn_pattern(rest, ppp->pp_synp);
|
|
4847 reg_do_extmatch = 0;
|
|
4848 if (item == ITEM_END && vim_regcomp_had_eol()
|
154
|
4849 && !(syn_opt_arg.flags & HL_EXCLUDENL))
|
7
|
4850 ppp->pp_synp->sp_flags |= HL_HAS_EOL;
|
|
4851 ppp->pp_matchgroup_id = matchgroup_id;
|
|
4852 ++pat_count;
|
|
4853 }
|
|
4854 }
|
|
4855 vim_free(key);
|
|
4856 if (illegal || not_enough)
|
|
4857 rest = NULL;
|
|
4858
|
|
4859 /*
|
|
4860 * Must have a "start" and "end" pattern.
|
|
4861 */
|
|
4862 if (rest != NULL && (pat_ptrs[ITEM_START] == NULL ||
|
|
4863 pat_ptrs[ITEM_END] == NULL))
|
|
4864 {
|
|
4865 not_enough = TRUE;
|
|
4866 rest = NULL;
|
|
4867 }
|
|
4868
|
|
4869 if (rest != NULL)
|
|
4870 {
|
|
4871 /*
|
|
4872 * Check for trailing garbage or command.
|
|
4873 * If OK, add the item.
|
|
4874 */
|
|
4875 eap->nextcmd = check_nextcmd(rest);
|
|
4876 if (!ends_excmd(*rest) || eap->skip)
|
|
4877 rest = NULL;
|
|
4878 else if (ga_grow(&(curbuf->b_syn_patterns), pat_count) != FAIL
|
|
4879 && (syn_id = syn_check_group(arg,
|
|
4880 (int)(group_name_end - arg))) != 0)
|
|
4881 {
|
154
|
4882 syn_incl_toplevel(syn_id, &syn_opt_arg.flags);
|
7
|
4883 /*
|
|
4884 * Store the start/skip/end in the syn_items list
|
|
4885 */
|
|
4886 idx = curbuf->b_syn_patterns.ga_len;
|
|
4887 for (item = ITEM_START; item <= ITEM_END; ++item)
|
|
4888 {
|
|
4889 for (ppp = pat_ptrs[item]; ppp != NULL; ppp = ppp->pp_next)
|
|
4890 {
|
|
4891 SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[idx] = *(ppp->pp_synp);
|
|
4892 SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[idx].sp_syncing = syncing;
|
|
4893 SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[idx].sp_type =
|
|
4894 (item == ITEM_START) ? SPTYPE_START :
|
|
4895 (item == ITEM_SKIP) ? SPTYPE_SKIP : SPTYPE_END;
|
154
|
4896 SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[idx].sp_flags |= syn_opt_arg.flags;
|
7
|
4897 SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[idx].sp_syn.id = syn_id;
|
|
4898 SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[idx].sp_syn.inc_tag = current_syn_inc_tag;
|
|
4899 SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[idx].sp_syn_match_id =
|
|
4900 ppp->pp_matchgroup_id;
|
|
4901 if (item == ITEM_START)
|
|
4902 {
|
154
|
4903 SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[idx].sp_cont_list =
|
|
4904 syn_opt_arg.cont_list;
|
7
|
4905 SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[idx].sp_syn.cont_in_list =
|
154
|
4906 syn_opt_arg.cont_in_list;
|
|
4907 if (syn_opt_arg.cont_in_list != NULL)
|
7
|
4908 curbuf->b_syn_containedin = TRUE;
|
154
|
4909 SYN_ITEMS(curbuf)[idx].sp_next_list =
|
|
4910 syn_opt_arg.next_list;
|
7
|
4911 }
|
|
4912 ++curbuf->b_syn_patterns.ga_len;
|
|
4913 ++idx;
|
|
4914 #ifdef FEAT_FOLDING
|
154
|
4915 if (syn_opt_arg.flags & HL_FOLD)
|
7
|
4916 ++curbuf->b_syn_folditems;
|
|
4917 #endif
|
|
4918 }
|
|
4919 }
|
|
4920
|
745
|
4921 redraw_curbuf_later(SOME_VALID);
|
7
|
4922 syn_stack_free_all(curbuf); /* Need to recompute all syntax. */
|
|
4923 success = TRUE; /* don't free the progs and patterns now */
|
|
4924 }
|
|
4925 }
|
|
4926
|
|
4927 /*
|
|
4928 * Free the allocated memory.
|
|
4929 */
|
|
4930 for (item = ITEM_START; item <= ITEM_END; ++item)
|
|
4931 for (ppp = pat_ptrs[item]; ppp != NULL; ppp = ppp_next)
|
|
4932 {
|
|
4933 if (!success)
|
|
4934 {
|
|
4935 vim_free(ppp->pp_synp->sp_prog);
|
|
4936 vim_free(ppp->pp_synp->sp_pattern);
|
|
4937 }
|
|
4938 vim_free(ppp->pp_synp);
|
|
4939 ppp_next = ppp->pp_next;
|
|
4940 vim_free(ppp);
|
|
4941 }
|
|
4942
|
|
4943 if (!success)
|
|
4944 {
|
154
|
4945 vim_free(syn_opt_arg.cont_list);
|
|
4946 vim_free(syn_opt_arg.cont_in_list);
|
|
4947 vim_free(syn_opt_arg.next_list);
|
7
|
4948 if (not_enough)
|
|
4949 EMSG2(_("E399: Not enough arguments: syntax region %s"), arg);
|
|
4950 else if (illegal || rest == NULL)
|
|
4951 EMSG2(_(e_invarg2), arg);
|
|
4952 }
|
|
4953 }
|
|
4954
|
|
4955 /*
|
|
4956 * A simple syntax group ID comparison function suitable for use in qsort()
|
|
4957 */
|
|
4958 static int
|
|
4959 #ifdef __BORLANDC__
|
|
4960 _RTLENTRYF
|
|
4961 #endif
|
|
4962 syn_compare_stub(v1, v2)
|
|
4963 const void *v1;
|
|
4964 const void *v2;
|
|
4965 {
|
|
4966 const short *s1 = v1;
|
|
4967 const short *s2 = v2;
|
|
4968
|
|
4969 return (*s1 > *s2 ? 1 : *s1 < *s2 ? -1 : 0);
|
|
4970 }
|
|
4971
|
|
4972 /*
|
|
4973 * Combines lists of syntax clusters.
|
|
4974 * *clstr1 and *clstr2 must both be allocated memory; they will be consumed.
|
|
4975 */
|
|
4976 static void
|
|
4977 syn_combine_list(clstr1, clstr2, list_op)
|
|
4978 short **clstr1;
|
|
4979 short **clstr2;
|
|
4980 int list_op;
|
|
4981 {
|
|
4982 int count1 = 0;
|
|
4983 int count2 = 0;
|
|
4984 short *g1;
|
|
4985 short *g2;
|
|
4986 short *clstr = NULL;
|
|
4987 int count;
|
|
4988 int round;
|
|
4989
|
|
4990 /*
|
|
4991 * Handle degenerate cases.
|
|
4992 */
|
|
4993 if (*clstr2 == NULL)
|
|
4994 return;
|
|
4995 if (*clstr1 == NULL || list_op == CLUSTER_REPLACE)
|
|
4996 {
|
|
4997 if (list_op == CLUSTER_REPLACE)
|
|
4998 vim_free(*clstr1);
|
|
4999 if (list_op == CLUSTER_REPLACE || list_op == CLUSTER_ADD)
|
|
5000 *clstr1 = *clstr2;
|
|
5001 else
|
|
5002 vim_free(*clstr2);
|
|
5003 return;
|
|
5004 }
|
|
5005
|
|
5006 for (g1 = *clstr1; *g1; g1++)
|
|
5007 ++count1;
|
|
5008 for (g2 = *clstr2; *g2; g2++)
|
|
5009 ++count2;
|
|
5010
|
|
5011 /*
|
|
5012 * For speed purposes, sort both lists.
|
|
5013 */
|
|
5014 qsort(*clstr1, (size_t)count1, sizeof(short), syn_compare_stub);
|
|
5015 qsort(*clstr2, (size_t)count2, sizeof(short), syn_compare_stub);
|
|
5016
|
|
5017 /*
|
|
5018 * We proceed in two passes; in round 1, we count the elements to place
|
|
5019 * in the new list, and in round 2, we allocate and populate the new
|
|
5020 * list. For speed, we use a mergesort-like method, adding the smaller
|
|
5021 * of the current elements in each list to the new list.
|
|
5022 */
|
|
5023 for (round = 1; round <= 2; round++)
|
|
5024 {
|
|
5025 g1 = *clstr1;
|
|
5026 g2 = *clstr2;
|
|
5027 count = 0;
|
|
5028
|
|
5029 /*
|
|
5030 * First, loop through the lists until one of them is empty.
|
|
5031 */
|
|
5032 while (*g1 && *g2)
|
|
5033 {
|
|
5034 /*
|
|
5035 * We always want to add from the first list.
|
|
5036 */
|
|
5037 if (*g1 < *g2)
|
|
5038 {
|
|
5039 if (round == 2)
|
|
5040 clstr[count] = *g1;
|
|
5041 count++;
|
|
5042 g1++;
|
|
5043 continue;
|
|
5044 }
|
|
5045 /*
|
|
5046 * We only want to add from the second list if we're adding the
|
|
5047 * lists.
|
|
5048 */
|
|
5049 if (list_op == CLUSTER_ADD)
|
|
5050 {
|
|
5051 if (round == 2)
|
|
5052 clstr[count] = *g2;
|
|
5053 count++;
|
|
5054 }
|
|
5055 if (*g1 == *g2)
|
|
5056 g1++;
|
|
5057 g2++;
|
|
5058 }
|
|
5059
|
|
5060 /*
|
|
5061 * Now add the leftovers from whichever list didn't get finished
|
|
5062 * first. As before, we only want to add from the second list if
|
|
5063 * we're adding the lists.
|
|
5064 */
|
|
5065 for (; *g1; g1++, count++)
|
|
5066 if (round == 2)
|
|
5067 clstr[count] = *g1;
|
|
5068 if (list_op == CLUSTER_ADD)
|
|
5069 for (; *g2; g2++, count++)
|
|
5070 if (round == 2)
|
|
5071 clstr[count] = *g2;
|
|
5072
|
|
5073 if (round == 1)
|
|
5074 {
|
|
5075 /*
|
|
5076 * If the group ended up empty, we don't need to allocate any
|
|
5077 * space for it.
|
|
5078 */
|
|
5079 if (count == 0)
|
|
5080 {
|
|
5081 clstr = NULL;
|
|
5082 break;
|
|
5083 }
|
|
5084 clstr = (short *)alloc((unsigned)((count + 1) * sizeof(short)));
|
|
5085 if (clstr == NULL)
|
|
5086 break;
|
|
5087 clstr[count] = 0;
|
|
5088 }
|
|
5089 }
|
|
5090
|
|
5091 /*
|
|
5092 * Finally, put the new list in place.
|
|
5093 */
|
|
5094 vim_free(*clstr1);
|
|
5095 vim_free(*clstr2);
|
|
5096 *clstr1 = clstr;
|
|
5097 }
|
|
5098
|
|
5099 /*
|
|
5100 * Lookup a syntax cluster name and return it's ID.
|
|
5101 * If it is not found, 0 is returned.
|
|
5102 */
|
|
5103 static int
|
|
5104 syn_scl_name2id(name)
|
|
5105 char_u *name;
|
|
5106 {
|
|
5107 int i;
|
|
5108 char_u *name_u;
|
|
5109
|
|
5110 /* Avoid using stricmp() too much, it's slow on some systems */
|
|
5111 name_u = vim_strsave_up(name);
|
|
5112 if (name_u == NULL)
|
|
5113 return 0;
|
|
5114 for (i = curbuf->b_syn_clusters.ga_len; --i >= 0; )
|
|
5115 if (SYN_CLSTR(curbuf)[i].scl_name_u != NULL
|
|
5116 && STRCMP(name_u, SYN_CLSTR(curbuf)[i].scl_name_u) == 0)
|
|
5117 break;
|
|
5118 vim_free(name_u);
|
|
5119 return (i < 0 ? 0 : i + SYNID_CLUSTER);
|
|
5120 }
|
|
5121
|
|
5122 /*
|
|
5123 * Like syn_scl_name2id(), but take a pointer + length argument.
|
|
5124 */
|
|
5125 static int
|
|
5126 syn_scl_namen2id(linep, len)
|
|
5127 char_u *linep;
|
|
5128 int len;
|
|
5129 {
|
|
5130 char_u *name;
|
|
5131 int id = 0;
|
|
5132
|
|
5133 name = vim_strnsave(linep, len);
|
|
5134 if (name != NULL)
|
|
5135 {
|
|
5136 id = syn_scl_name2id(name);
|
|
5137 vim_free(name);
|
|
5138 }
|
|
5139 return id;
|
|
5140 }
|
|
5141
|
|
5142 /*
|
|
5143 * Find syntax cluster name in the table and return it's ID.
|
|
5144 * The argument is a pointer to the name and the length of the name.
|
|
5145 * If it doesn't exist yet, a new entry is created.
|
|
5146 * Return 0 for failure.
|
|
5147 */
|
|
5148 static int
|
|
5149 syn_check_cluster(pp, len)
|
|
5150 char_u *pp;
|
|
5151 int len;
|
|
5152 {
|
|
5153 int id;
|
|
5154 char_u *name;
|
|
5155
|
|
5156 name = vim_strnsave(pp, len);
|
|
5157 if (name == NULL)
|
|
5158 return 0;
|
|
5159
|
|
5160 id = syn_scl_name2id(name);
|
|
5161 if (id == 0) /* doesn't exist yet */
|
|
5162 id = syn_add_cluster(name);
|
|
5163 else
|
|
5164 vim_free(name);
|
|
5165 return id;
|
|
5166 }
|
|
5167
|
|
5168 /*
|
|
5169 * Add new syntax cluster and return it's ID.
|
|
5170 * "name" must be an allocated string, it will be consumed.
|
|
5171 * Return 0 for failure.
|
|
5172 */
|
|
5173 static int
|
|
5174 syn_add_cluster(name)
|
221
|
5175 char_u *name;
|
|
5176 {
|
|
5177 int len;
|
7
|
5178
|
|
5179 /*
|
|
5180 * First call for this growarray: init growing array.
|
|
5181 */
|
|
5182 if (curbuf->b_syn_clusters.ga_data == NULL)
|
|
5183 {
|
221
|
5184 curbuf->b_syn_clusters.ga_itemsize = sizeof(syn_cluster_T);
|
7
|
5185 curbuf->b_syn_clusters.ga_growsize = 10;
|
|
5186 }
|
|
5187
|
|
5188 /*
|
|
5189 * Make room for at least one other cluster entry.
|
|
5190 */
|
|
5191 if (ga_grow(&curbuf->b_syn_clusters, 1) == FAIL)
|
|
5192 {
|
|
5193 vim_free(name);
|
|
5194 return 0;
|
|
5195 }
|
|
5196 len = curbuf->b_syn_clusters.ga_len;
|
|
5197
|
221
|
5198 vim_memset(&(SYN_CLSTR(curbuf)[len]), 0, sizeof(syn_cluster_T));
|
7
|
5199 SYN_CLSTR(curbuf)[len].scl_name = name;
|
|
5200 SYN_CLSTR(curbuf)[len].scl_name_u = vim_strsave_up(name);
|
|
5201 SYN_CLSTR(curbuf)[len].scl_list = NULL;
|
|
5202 ++curbuf->b_syn_clusters.ga_len;
|
|
5203
|
221
|
5204 if (STRICMP(name, "Spell") == 0)
|
|
5205 curbuf->b_spell_cluster_id = len + SYNID_CLUSTER;
|
227
|
5206 if (STRICMP(name, "NoSpell") == 0)
|
|
5207 curbuf->b_nospell_cluster_id = len + SYNID_CLUSTER;
|
221
|
5208
|
7
|
5209 return len + SYNID_CLUSTER;
|
|
5210 }
|
|
5211
|
|
5212 /*
|
|
5213 * Handle ":syntax cluster {cluster-name} [contains={groupname},..]
|
|
5214 * [add={groupname},..] [remove={groupname},..]".
|
|
5215 */
|
|
5216 /* ARGSUSED */
|
|
5217 static void
|
|
5218 syn_cmd_cluster(eap, syncing)
|
|
5219 exarg_T *eap;
|
|
5220 int syncing; /* not used */
|
|
5221 {
|
|
5222 char_u *arg = eap->arg;
|
|
5223 char_u *group_name_end;
|
|
5224 char_u *rest;
|
|
5225 int scl_id;
|
|
5226 short *clstr_list;
|
|
5227 int got_clstr = FALSE;
|
|
5228 int opt_len;
|
|
5229 int list_op;
|
|
5230
|
|
5231 eap->nextcmd = find_nextcmd(arg);
|
|
5232 if (eap->skip)
|
|
5233 return;
|
|
5234
|
|
5235 rest = get_group_name(arg, &group_name_end);
|
|
5236
|
|
5237 if (rest != NULL)
|
|
5238 {
|
|
5239 scl_id = syn_check_cluster(arg, (int)(group_name_end - arg))
|
221
|
5240 - SYNID_CLUSTER;
|
7
|
5241
|
|
5242 for (;;)
|
|
5243 {
|
|
5244 if (STRNICMP(rest, "add", 3) == 0
|
|
5245 && (vim_iswhite(rest[3]) || rest[3] == '='))
|
|
5246 {
|
|
5247 opt_len = 3;
|
|
5248 list_op = CLUSTER_ADD;
|
|
5249 }
|
|
5250 else if (STRNICMP(rest, "remove", 6) == 0
|
|
5251 && (vim_iswhite(rest[6]) || rest[6] == '='))
|
|
5252 {
|
|
5253 opt_len = 6;
|
|
5254 list_op = CLUSTER_SUBTRACT;
|
|
5255 }
|
|
5256 else if (STRNICMP(rest, "contains", 8) == 0
|
|
5257 && (vim_iswhite(rest[8]) || rest[8] == '='))
|
|
5258 {
|
|
5259 opt_len = 8;
|
|
5260 list_op = CLUSTER_REPLACE;
|
|
5261 }
|
|
5262 else
|
|
5263 break;
|
|
5264
|
|
5265 clstr_list = NULL;
|
|
5266 if (get_id_list(&rest, opt_len, &clstr_list) == FAIL)
|
|
5267 {
|
|
5268 EMSG2(_(e_invarg2), rest);
|
|
5269 break;
|
|
5270 }
|
|
5271 syn_combine_list(&SYN_CLSTR(curbuf)[scl_id].scl_list,
|
|
5272 &clstr_list, list_op);
|
|
5273 got_clstr = TRUE;
|
|
5274 }
|
|
5275
|
|
5276 if (got_clstr)
|
|
5277 {
|
745
|
5278 redraw_curbuf_later(SOME_VALID);
|
7
|
5279 syn_stack_free_all(curbuf); /* Need to recompute all syntax. */
|
|
5280 }
|
|
5281 }
|
|
5282
|
|
5283 if (!got_clstr)
|
|
5284 EMSG(_("E400: No cluster specified"));
|
|
5285 if (rest == NULL || !ends_excmd(*rest))
|
|
5286 EMSG2(_(e_invarg2), arg);
|
|
5287 }
|
|
5288
|
|
5289 /*
|
|
5290 * On first call for current buffer: Init growing array.
|
|
5291 */
|
|
5292 static void
|
|
5293 init_syn_patterns()
|
|
5294 {
|
|
5295 curbuf->b_syn_patterns.ga_itemsize = sizeof(synpat_T);
|
|
5296 curbuf->b_syn_patterns.ga_growsize = 10;
|
|
5297 }
|
|
5298
|
|
5299 /*
|
|
5300 * Get one pattern for a ":syntax match" or ":syntax region" command.
|
|
5301 * Stores the pattern and program in a synpat_T.
|
|
5302 * Returns a pointer to the next argument, or NULL in case of an error.
|
|
5303 */
|
|
5304 static char_u *
|
|
5305 get_syn_pattern(arg, ci)
|
|
5306 char_u *arg;
|
|
5307 synpat_T *ci;
|
|
5308 {
|
|
5309 char_u *end;
|
|
5310 int *p;
|
|
5311 int idx;
|
|
5312 char_u *cpo_save;
|
|
5313
|
|
5314 /* need at least three chars */
|
|
5315 if (arg == NULL || arg[1] == NUL || arg[2] == NUL)
|
|
5316 return NULL;
|
|
5317
|
|
5318 end = skip_regexp(arg + 1, *arg, TRUE, NULL);
|
|
5319 if (*end != *arg) /* end delimiter not found */
|
|
5320 {
|
|
5321 EMSG2(_("E401: Pattern delimiter not found: %s"), arg);
|
|
5322 return NULL;
|
|
5323 }
|
|
5324 /* store the pattern and compiled regexp program */
|
|
5325 if ((ci->sp_pattern = vim_strnsave(arg + 1, (int)(end - arg - 1))) == NULL)
|
|
5326 return NULL;
|
|
5327
|
|
5328 /* Make 'cpoptions' empty, to avoid the 'l' flag */
|
|
5329 cpo_save = p_cpo;
|
|
5330 p_cpo = (char_u *)"";
|
|
5331 ci->sp_prog = vim_regcomp(ci->sp_pattern, RE_MAGIC);
|
|
5332 p_cpo = cpo_save;
|
|
5333
|
|
5334 if (ci->sp_prog == NULL)
|
|
5335 return NULL;
|
|
5336 ci->sp_ic = curbuf->b_syn_ic;
|
|
5337
|
|
5338 /*
|
|
5339 * Check for a match, highlight or region offset.
|
|
5340 */
|
|
5341 ++end;
|
|
5342 do
|
|
5343 {
|
|
5344 for (idx = SPO_COUNT; --idx >= 0; )
|
|
5345 if (STRNCMP(end, spo_name_tab[idx], 3) == 0)
|
|
5346 break;
|
|
5347 if (idx >= 0)
|
|
5348 {
|
|
5349 p = &(ci->sp_offsets[idx]);
|
|
5350 if (idx != SPO_LC_OFF)
|
|
5351 switch (end[3])
|
|
5352 {
|
|
5353 case 's': break;
|
|
5354 case 'b': break;
|
|
5355 case 'e': idx += SPO_COUNT; break;
|
|
5356 default: idx = -1; break;
|
|
5357 }
|
|
5358 if (idx >= 0)
|
|
5359 {
|
|
5360 ci->sp_off_flags |= (1 << idx);
|
|
5361 if (idx == SPO_LC_OFF) /* lc=99 */
|
|
5362 {
|
|
5363 end += 3;
|
|
5364 *p = getdigits(&end);
|
|
5365
|
|
5366 /* "lc=" offset automatically sets "ms=" offset */
|
|
5367 if (!(ci->sp_off_flags & (1 << SPO_MS_OFF)))
|
|
5368 {
|
|
5369 ci->sp_off_flags |= (1 << SPO_MS_OFF);
|
|
5370 ci->sp_offsets[SPO_MS_OFF] = *p;
|
|
5371 }
|
|
5372 }
|
|
5373 else /* yy=x+99 */
|
|
5374 {
|
|
5375 end += 4;
|
|
5376 if (*end == '+')
|
|
5377 {
|
|
5378 ++end;
|
|
5379 *p = getdigits(&end); /* positive offset */
|
|
5380 }
|
|
5381 else if (*end == '-')
|
|
5382 {
|
|
5383 ++end;
|
|
5384 *p = -getdigits(&end); /* negative offset */
|
|
5385 }
|
|
5386 }
|
|
5387 if (*end != ',')
|
|
5388 break;
|
|
5389 ++end;
|
|
5390 }
|
|
5391 }
|
|
5392 } while (idx >= 0);
|
|
5393
|
|
5394 if (!ends_excmd(*end) && !vim_iswhite(*end))
|
|
5395 {
|
|
5396 EMSG2(_("E402: Garbage after pattern: %s"), arg);
|
|
5397 return NULL;
|
|
5398 }
|
|
5399 return skipwhite(end);
|
|
5400 }
|
|
5401
|
|
5402 /*
|
|
5403 * Handle ":syntax sync .." command.
|
|
5404 */
|
|
5405 /* ARGSUSED */
|
|
5406 static void
|
|
5407 syn_cmd_sync(eap, syncing)
|
|
5408 exarg_T *eap;
|
|
5409 int syncing; /* not used */
|
|
5410 {
|
|
5411 char_u *arg_start = eap->arg;
|
|
5412 char_u *arg_end;
|
|
5413 char_u *key = NULL;
|
|
5414 char_u *next_arg;
|
|
5415 int illegal = FALSE;
|
|
5416 int finished = FALSE;
|
|
5417 long n;
|
|
5418 char_u *cpo_save;
|
|
5419
|
|
5420 if (ends_excmd(*arg_start))
|
|
5421 {
|
|
5422 syn_cmd_list(eap, TRUE);
|
|
5423 return;
|
|
5424 }
|
|
5425
|
|
5426 while (!ends_excmd(*arg_start))
|
|
5427 {
|
|
5428 arg_end = skiptowhite(arg_start);
|
|
5429 next_arg = skipwhite(arg_end);
|
|
5430 vim_free(key);
|
|
5431 key = vim_strnsave_up(arg_start, (int)(arg_end - arg_start));
|
|
5432 if (STRCMP(key, "CCOMMENT") == 0)
|
|
5433 {
|
|
5434 if (!eap->skip)
|
|
5435 curbuf->b_syn_sync_flags |= SF_CCOMMENT;
|
|
5436 if (!ends_excmd(*next_arg))
|
|
5437 {
|
|
5438 arg_end = skiptowhite(next_arg);
|
|
5439 if (!eap->skip)
|
|
5440 curbuf->b_syn_sync_id = syn_check_group(next_arg,
|
|
5441 (int)(arg_end - next_arg));
|
|
5442 next_arg = skipwhite(arg_end);
|
|
5443 }
|
|
5444 else if (!eap->skip)
|
|
5445 curbuf->b_syn_sync_id = syn_name2id((char_u *)"Comment");
|
|
5446 }
|
|
5447 else if ( STRNCMP(key, "LINES", 5) == 0
|
|
5448 || STRNCMP(key, "MINLINES", 8) == 0
|
|
5449 || STRNCMP(key, "MAXLINES", 8) == 0
|
|
5450 || STRNCMP(key, "LINEBREAKS", 10) == 0)
|
|
5451 {
|
|
5452 if (key[4] == 'S')
|
|
5453 arg_end = key + 6;
|
|
5454 else if (key[0] == 'L')
|
|
5455 arg_end = key + 11;
|
|
5456 else
|
|
5457 arg_end = key + 9;
|
|
5458 if (arg_end[-1] != '=' || !VIM_ISDIGIT(*arg_end))
|
|
5459 {
|
|
5460 illegal = TRUE;
|
|
5461 break;
|
|
5462 }
|
|
5463 n = getdigits(&arg_end);
|
|
5464 if (!eap->skip)
|
|
5465 {
|
|
5466 if (key[4] == 'B')
|
|
5467 curbuf->b_syn_sync_linebreaks = n;
|
|
5468 else if (key[1] == 'A')
|
|
5469 curbuf->b_syn_sync_maxlines = n;
|
|
5470 else
|
|
5471 curbuf->b_syn_sync_minlines = n;
|
|
5472 }
|
|
5473 }
|
|
5474 else if (STRCMP(key, "FROMSTART") == 0)
|
|
5475 {
|
|
5476 if (!eap->skip)
|
|
5477 {
|
|
5478 curbuf->b_syn_sync_minlines = MAXLNUM;
|
|
5479 curbuf->b_syn_sync_maxlines = 0;
|
|
5480 }
|
|
5481 }
|
|
5482 else if (STRCMP(key, "LINECONT") == 0)
|
|
5483 {
|
|
5484 if (curbuf->b_syn_linecont_pat != NULL)
|
|
5485 {
|
|
5486 EMSG(_("E403: syntax sync: line continuations pattern specified twice"));
|
|
5487 finished = TRUE;
|
|
5488 break;
|
|
5489 }
|
|
5490 arg_end = skip_regexp(next_arg + 1, *next_arg, TRUE, NULL);
|
|
5491 if (*arg_end != *next_arg) /* end delimiter not found */
|
|
5492 {
|
|
5493 illegal = TRUE;
|
|
5494 break;
|
|
5495 }
|
|
5496
|
|
5497 if (!eap->skip)
|
|
5498 {
|
|
5499 /* store the pattern and compiled regexp program */
|
|
5500 if ((curbuf->b_syn_linecont_pat = vim_strnsave(next_arg + 1,
|
|
5501 (int)(arg_end - next_arg - 1))) == NULL)
|
|
5502 {
|
|
5503 finished = TRUE;
|
|
5504 break;
|
|
5505 }
|
|
5506 curbuf->b_syn_linecont_ic = curbuf->b_syn_ic;
|
|
5507
|
|
5508 /* Make 'cpoptions' empty, to avoid the 'l' flag */
|
|
5509 cpo_save = p_cpo;
|
|
5510 p_cpo = (char_u *)"";
|
|
5511 curbuf->b_syn_linecont_prog =
|
|
5512 vim_regcomp(curbuf->b_syn_linecont_pat, RE_MAGIC);
|
|
5513 p_cpo = cpo_save;
|
|
5514
|
|
5515 if (curbuf->b_syn_linecont_prog == NULL)
|
|
5516 {
|
|
5517 vim_free(curbuf->b_syn_linecont_pat);
|
|
5518 curbuf->b_syn_linecont_pat = NULL;
|
|
5519 finished = TRUE;
|
|
5520 break;
|
|
5521 }
|
|
5522 }
|
|
5523 next_arg = skipwhite(arg_end + 1);
|
|
5524 }
|
|
5525 else
|
|
5526 {
|
|
5527 eap->arg = next_arg;
|
|
5528 if (STRCMP(key, "MATCH") == 0)
|
|
5529 syn_cmd_match(eap, TRUE);
|
|
5530 else if (STRCMP(key, "REGION") == 0)
|
|
5531 syn_cmd_region(eap, TRUE);
|
|
5532 else if (STRCMP(key, "CLEAR") == 0)
|
|
5533 syn_cmd_clear(eap, TRUE);
|
|
5534 else
|
|
5535 illegal = TRUE;
|
|
5536 finished = TRUE;
|
|
5537 break;
|
|
5538 }
|
|
5539 arg_start = next_arg;
|
|
5540 }
|
|
5541 vim_free(key);
|
|
5542 if (illegal)
|
|
5543 EMSG2(_("E404: Illegal arguments: %s"), arg_start);
|
|
5544 else if (!finished)
|
|
5545 {
|
|
5546 eap->nextcmd = check_nextcmd(arg_start);
|
745
|
5547 redraw_curbuf_later(SOME_VALID);
|
7
|
5548 syn_stack_free_all(curbuf); /* Need to recompute all syntax. */
|
|
5549 }
|
|
5550 }
|
|
5551
|
|
5552 /*
|
|
5553 * Convert a line of highlight group names into a list of group ID numbers.
|
|
5554 * "arg" should point to the "contains" or "nextgroup" keyword.
|
|
5555 * "arg" is advanced to after the last group name.
|
|
5556 * Careful: the argument is modified (NULs added).
|
|
5557 * returns FAIL for some error, OK for success.
|
|
5558 */
|
|
5559 static int
|
|
5560 get_id_list(arg, keylen, list)
|
|
5561 char_u **arg;
|
|
5562 int keylen; /* length of keyword */
|
|
5563 short **list; /* where to store the resulting list, if not
|
|
5564 NULL, the list is silently skipped! */
|
|
5565 {
|
|
5566 char_u *p = NULL;
|
|
5567 char_u *end;
|
|
5568 int round;
|
|
5569 int count;
|
|
5570 int total_count = 0;
|
|
5571 short *retval = NULL;
|
|
5572 char_u *name;
|
|
5573 regmatch_T regmatch;
|
|
5574 int id;
|
|
5575 int i;
|
|
5576 int failed = FALSE;
|
|
5577
|
|
5578 /*
|
|
5579 * We parse the list twice:
|
|
5580 * round == 1: count the number of items, allocate the array.
|
|
5581 * round == 2: fill the array with the items.
|
|
5582 * In round 1 new groups may be added, causing the number of items to
|
|
5583 * grow when a regexp is used. In that case round 1 is done once again.
|
|
5584 */
|
|
5585 for (round = 1; round <= 2; ++round)
|
|
5586 {
|
|
5587 /*
|
|
5588 * skip "contains"
|
|
5589 */
|
|
5590 p = skipwhite(*arg + keylen);
|
|
5591 if (*p != '=')
|
|
5592 {
|
|
5593 EMSG2(_("E405: Missing equal sign: %s"), *arg);
|
|
5594 break;
|
|
5595 }
|
|
5596 p = skipwhite(p + 1);
|
|
5597 if (ends_excmd(*p))
|
|
5598 {
|
|
5599 EMSG2(_("E406: Empty argument: %s"), *arg);
|
|
5600 break;
|
|
5601 }
|
|
5602
|
|
5603 /*
|
|
5604 * parse the arguments after "contains"
|
|
5605 */
|
|
5606 count = 0;
|
|
5607 while (!ends_excmd(*p))
|
|
5608 {
|
|
5609 for (end = p; *end && !vim_iswhite(*end) && *end != ','; ++end)
|
|
5610 ;
|
|
5611 name = alloc((int)(end - p + 3)); /* leave room for "^$" */
|
|
5612 if (name == NULL)
|
|
5613 {
|
|
5614 failed = TRUE;
|
|
5615 break;
|
|
5616 }
|
419
|
5617 vim_strncpy(name + 1, p, end - p);
|
7
|
5618 if ( STRCMP(name + 1, "ALLBUT") == 0
|
|
5619 || STRCMP(name + 1, "ALL") == 0
|
|
5620 || STRCMP(name + 1, "TOP") == 0
|
|
5621 || STRCMP(name + 1, "CONTAINED") == 0)
|
|
5622 {
|
|
5623 if (TOUPPER_ASC(**arg) != 'C')
|
|
5624 {
|
|
5625 EMSG2(_("E407: %s not allowed here"), name + 1);
|
|
5626 failed = TRUE;
|
|
5627 vim_free(name);
|
|
5628 break;
|
|
5629 }
|
|
5630 if (count != 0)
|
|
5631 {
|
|
5632 EMSG2(_("E408: %s must be first in contains list"), name + 1);
|
|
5633 failed = TRUE;
|
|
5634 vim_free(name);
|
|
5635 break;
|
|
5636 }
|
|
5637 if (name[1] == 'A')
|
|
5638 id = SYNID_ALLBUT;
|
|
5639 else if (name[1] == 'T')
|
|
5640 id = SYNID_TOP;
|
|
5641 else
|
|
5642 id = SYNID_CONTAINED;
|
|
5643 id += current_syn_inc_tag;
|
|
5644 }
|
|
5645 else if (name[1] == '@')
|
|
5646 {
|
|
5647 id = syn_check_cluster(name + 2, (int)(end - p - 1));
|
|
5648 }
|
|
5649 else
|
|
5650 {
|
|
5651 /*
|
|
5652 * Handle full group name.
|
|
5653 */
|
|
5654 if (vim_strpbrk(name + 1, (char_u *)"\\.*^$~[") == NULL)
|
|
5655 id = syn_check_group(name + 1, (int)(end - p));
|
|
5656 else
|
|
5657 {
|
|
5658 /*
|
|
5659 * Handle match of regexp with group names.
|
|
5660 */
|
|
5661 *name = '^';
|
|
5662 STRCAT(name, "$");
|
|
5663 regmatch.regprog = vim_regcomp(name, RE_MAGIC);
|
|
5664 if (regmatch.regprog == NULL)
|
|
5665 {
|
|
5666 failed = TRUE;
|
|
5667 vim_free(name);
|
|
5668 break;
|
|
5669 }
|
|
5670
|
|
5671 regmatch.rm_ic = TRUE;
|
|
5672 id = 0;
|
|
5673 for (i = highlight_ga.ga_len; --i >= 0; )
|
|
5674 {
|
|
5675 if (vim_regexec(®match, HL_TABLE()[i].sg_name,
|
|
5676 (colnr_T)0))
|
|
5677 {
|
|
5678 if (round == 2)
|
|
5679 {
|
|
5680 /* Got more items than expected; can happen
|
|
5681 * when adding items that match:
|
|
5682 * "contains=a.*b,axb".
|
|
5683 * Go back to first round */
|
|
5684 if (count >= total_count)
|
|
5685 {
|
|
5686 vim_free(retval);
|
|
5687 round = 1;
|
|
5688 }
|
|
5689 else
|
|
5690 retval[count] = i + 1;
|
|
5691 }
|
|
5692 ++count;
|
|
5693 id = -1; /* remember that we found one */
|
|
5694 }
|
|
5695 }
|
|
5696 vim_free(regmatch.regprog);
|
|
5697 }
|
|
5698 }
|
|
5699 vim_free(name);
|
|
5700 if (id == 0)
|
|
5701 {
|
|
5702 EMSG2(_("E409: Unknown group name: %s"), p);
|
|
5703 failed = TRUE;
|
|
5704 break;
|
|
5705 }
|
|
5706 if (id > 0)
|
|
5707 {
|
|
5708 if (round == 2)
|
|
5709 {
|
|
5710 /* Got more items than expected, go back to first round */
|
|
5711 if (count >= total_count)
|
|
5712 {
|
|
5713 vim_free(retval);
|
|
5714 round = 1;
|
|
5715 }
|
|
5716 else
|
|
5717 retval[count] = id;
|
|
5718 }
|
|
5719 ++count;
|
|
5720 }
|
|
5721 p = skipwhite(end);
|
|
5722 if (*p != ',')
|
|
5723 break;
|
|
5724 p = skipwhite(p + 1); /* skip comma in between arguments */
|
|
5725 }
|
|
5726 if (failed)
|
|
5727 break;
|
|
5728 if (round == 1)
|
|
5729 {
|
|
5730 retval = (short *)alloc((unsigned)((count + 1) * sizeof(short)));
|
|
5731 if (retval == NULL)
|
|
5732 break;
|
|
5733 retval[count] = 0; /* zero means end of the list */
|
|
5734 total_count = count;
|
|
5735 }
|
|
5736 }
|
|
5737
|
|
5738 *arg = p;
|
|
5739 if (failed || retval == NULL)
|
|
5740 {
|
|
5741 vim_free(retval);
|
|
5742 return FAIL;
|
|
5743 }
|
|
5744
|
|
5745 if (*list == NULL)
|
|
5746 *list = retval;
|
|
5747 else
|
|
5748 vim_free(retval); /* list already found, don't overwrite it */
|
|
5749
|
|
5750 return OK;
|
|
5751 }
|
|
5752
|
|
5753 /*
|
|
5754 * Make a copy of an ID list.
|
|
5755 */
|
|
5756 static short *
|
|
5757 copy_id_list(list)
|
|
5758 short *list;
|
|
5759 {
|
|
5760 int len;
|
|
5761 int count;
|
|
5762 short *retval;
|
|
5763
|
|
5764 if (list == NULL)
|
|
5765 return NULL;
|
|
5766
|
|
5767 for (count = 0; list[count]; ++count)
|
|
5768 ;
|
|
5769 len = (count + 1) * sizeof(short);
|
|
5770 retval = (short *)alloc((unsigned)len);
|
|
5771 if (retval != NULL)
|
|
5772 mch_memmove(retval, list, (size_t)len);
|
|
5773
|
|
5774 return retval;
|
|
5775 }
|
|
5776
|
|
5777 /*
|
|
5778 * Check if syntax group "ssp" is in the ID list "list" of "cur_si".
|
|
5779 * "cur_si" can be NULL if not checking the "containedin" list.
|
|
5780 * Used to check if a syntax item is in the "contains" or "nextgroup" list of
|
|
5781 * the current item.
|
|
5782 * This function is called very often, keep it fast!!
|
|
5783 */
|
|
5784 static int
|
|
5785 in_id_list(cur_si, list, ssp, contained)
|
|
5786 stateitem_T *cur_si; /* current item or NULL */
|
|
5787 short *list; /* id list */
|
|
5788 struct sp_syn *ssp; /* group id and ":syn include" tag of group */
|
|
5789 int contained; /* group id is contained */
|
|
5790 {
|
|
5791 int retval;
|
|
5792 short *scl_list;
|
|
5793 short item;
|
|
5794 short id = ssp->id;
|
|
5795 static int depth = 0;
|
|
5796 int r;
|
|
5797
|
|
5798 /* If spp has a "containedin" list and "cur_si" is in it, return TRUE. */
|
36
|
5799 if (cur_si != NULL && ssp->cont_in_list != NULL
|
|
5800 && !(cur_si->si_flags & HL_MATCH))
|
7
|
5801 {
|
|
5802 /* Ignore transparent items without a contains argument. Double check
|
|
5803 * that we don't go back past the first one. */
|
|
5804 while ((cur_si->si_flags & HL_TRANS_CONT)
|
|
5805 && cur_si > (stateitem_T *)(current_state.ga_data))
|
|
5806 --cur_si;
|
|
5807 /* cur_si->si_idx is -1 for keywords, these never contain anything. */
|
|
5808 if (cur_si->si_idx >= 0 && in_id_list(NULL, ssp->cont_in_list,
|
|
5809 &(SYN_ITEMS(syn_buf)[cur_si->si_idx].sp_syn),
|
|
5810 SYN_ITEMS(syn_buf)[cur_si->si_idx].sp_flags & HL_CONTAINED))
|
|
5811 return TRUE;
|
|
5812 }
|
|
5813
|
|
5814 if (list == NULL)
|
|
5815 return FALSE;
|
|
5816
|
|
5817 /*
|
|
5818 * If list is ID_LIST_ALL, we are in a transparent item that isn't
|
|
5819 * inside anything. Only allow not-contained groups.
|
|
5820 */
|
|
5821 if (list == ID_LIST_ALL)
|
|
5822 return !contained;
|
|
5823
|
|
5824 /*
|
|
5825 * If the first item is "ALLBUT", return TRUE if "id" is NOT in the
|
|
5826 * contains list. We also require that "id" is at the same ":syn include"
|
|
5827 * level as the list.
|
|
5828 */
|
|
5829 item = *list;
|
|
5830 if (item >= SYNID_ALLBUT && item < SYNID_CLUSTER)
|
|
5831 {
|
|
5832 if (item < SYNID_TOP)
|
|
5833 {
|
|
5834 /* ALL or ALLBUT: accept all groups in the same file */
|
|
5835 if (item - SYNID_ALLBUT != ssp->inc_tag)
|
|
5836 return FALSE;
|
|
5837 }
|
|
5838 else if (item < SYNID_CONTAINED)
|
|
5839 {
|
|
5840 /* TOP: accept all not-contained groups in the same file */
|
|
5841 if (item - SYNID_TOP != ssp->inc_tag || contained)
|
|
5842 return FALSE;
|
|
5843 }
|
|
5844 else
|
|
5845 {
|
|
5846 /* CONTAINED: accept all contained groups in the same file */
|
|
5847 if (item - SYNID_CONTAINED != ssp->inc_tag || !contained)
|
|
5848 return FALSE;
|
|
5849 }
|
|
5850 item = *++list;
|
|
5851 retval = FALSE;
|
|
5852 }
|
|
5853 else
|
|
5854 retval = TRUE;
|
|
5855
|
|
5856 /*
|
|
5857 * Return "retval" if id is in the contains list.
|
|
5858 */
|
|
5859 while (item != 0)
|
|
5860 {
|
|
5861 if (item == id)
|
|
5862 return retval;
|
|
5863 if (item >= SYNID_CLUSTER)
|
|
5864 {
|
|
5865 scl_list = SYN_CLSTR(syn_buf)[item - SYNID_CLUSTER].scl_list;
|
|
5866 /* restrict recursiveness to 30 to avoid an endless loop for a
|
|
5867 * cluster that includes itself (indirectly) */
|
|
5868 if (scl_list != NULL && depth < 30)
|
|
5869 {
|
|
5870 ++depth;
|
|
5871 r = in_id_list(NULL, scl_list, ssp, contained);
|
|
5872 --depth;
|
|
5873 if (r)
|
|
5874 return retval;
|
|
5875 }
|
|
5876 }
|
|
5877 item = *++list;
|
|
5878 }
|
|
5879 return !retval;
|
|
5880 }
|
|
5881
|
|
5882 struct subcommand
|
|
5883 {
|
|
5884 char *name; /* subcommand name */
|
|
5885 void (*func)__ARGS((exarg_T *, int)); /* function to call */
|
|
5886 };
|
|
5887
|
|
5888 static struct subcommand subcommands[] =
|
|
5889 {
|
|
5890 {"case", syn_cmd_case},
|
|
5891 {"clear", syn_cmd_clear},
|
|
5892 {"cluster", syn_cmd_cluster},
|
|
5893 {"enable", syn_cmd_enable},
|
|
5894 {"include", syn_cmd_include},
|
|
5895 {"keyword", syn_cmd_keyword},
|
|
5896 {"list", syn_cmd_list},
|
|
5897 {"manual", syn_cmd_manual},
|
|
5898 {"match", syn_cmd_match},
|
|
5899 {"on", syn_cmd_on},
|
|
5900 {"off", syn_cmd_off},
|
|
5901 {"region", syn_cmd_region},
|
|
5902 {"reset", syn_cmd_reset},
|
419
|
5903 {"spell", syn_cmd_spell},
|
7
|
5904 {"sync", syn_cmd_sync},
|
|
5905 {"", syn_cmd_list},
|
|
5906 {NULL, NULL}
|
|
5907 };
|
|
5908
|
|
5909 /*
|
|
5910 * ":syntax".
|
|
5911 * This searches the subcommands[] table for the subcommand name, and calls a
|
|
5912 * syntax_subcommand() function to do the rest.
|
|
5913 */
|
|
5914 void
|
|
5915 ex_syntax(eap)
|
|
5916 exarg_T *eap;
|
|
5917 {
|
|
5918 char_u *arg = eap->arg;
|
|
5919 char_u *subcmd_end;
|
|
5920 char_u *subcmd_name;
|
|
5921 int i;
|
|
5922
|
|
5923 syn_cmdlinep = eap->cmdlinep;
|
|
5924
|
|
5925 /* isolate subcommand name */
|
|
5926 for (subcmd_end = arg; ASCII_ISALPHA(*subcmd_end); ++subcmd_end)
|
|
5927 ;
|
|
5928 subcmd_name = vim_strnsave(arg, (int)(subcmd_end - arg));
|
|
5929 if (subcmd_name != NULL)
|
|
5930 {
|
|
5931 if (eap->skip) /* skip error messages for all subcommands */
|
|
5932 ++emsg_skip;
|
|
5933 for (i = 0; ; ++i)
|
|
5934 {
|
|
5935 if (subcommands[i].name == NULL)
|
|
5936 {
|
|
5937 EMSG2(_("E410: Invalid :syntax subcommand: %s"), subcmd_name);
|
|
5938 break;
|
|
5939 }
|
|
5940 if (STRCMP(subcmd_name, (char_u *)subcommands[i].name) == 0)
|
|
5941 {
|
|
5942 eap->arg = skipwhite(subcmd_end);
|
|
5943 (subcommands[i].func)(eap, FALSE);
|
|
5944 break;
|
|
5945 }
|
|
5946 }
|
|
5947 vim_free(subcmd_name);
|
|
5948 if (eap->skip)
|
|
5949 --emsg_skip;
|
|
5950 }
|
|
5951 }
|
|
5952
|
|
5953 int
|
|
5954 syntax_present(buf)
|
|
5955 buf_T *buf;
|
|
5956 {
|
|
5957 return (buf->b_syn_patterns.ga_len != 0
|
|
5958 || buf->b_syn_clusters.ga_len != 0
|
134
|
5959 || curbuf->b_keywtab.ht_used > 0
|
|
5960 || curbuf->b_keywtab_ic.ht_used > 0);
|
7
|
5961 }
|
|
5962
|
|
5963 #if defined(FEAT_CMDL_COMPL) || defined(PROTO)
|
|
5964
|
|
5965 static enum
|
|
5966 {
|
|
5967 EXP_SUBCMD, /* expand ":syn" sub-commands */
|
|
5968 EXP_CASE /* expand ":syn case" arguments */
|
|
5969 } expand_what;
|
|
5970
|
|
5971
|
|
5972 /*
|
|
5973 * Handle command line completion for :syntax command.
|
|
5974 */
|
|
5975 void
|
|
5976 set_context_in_syntax_cmd(xp, arg)
|
|
5977 expand_T *xp;
|
|
5978 char_u *arg;
|
|
5979 {
|
|
5980 char_u *p;
|
|
5981
|
|
5982 /* Default: expand subcommands */
|
|
5983 xp->xp_context = EXPAND_SYNTAX;
|
|
5984 expand_what = EXP_SUBCMD;
|
|
5985 xp->xp_pattern = arg;
|
|
5986 include_link = FALSE;
|
|
5987 include_default = FALSE;
|
|
5988
|
|
5989 /* (part of) subcommand already typed */
|
|
5990 if (*arg != NUL)
|
|
5991 {
|
|
5992 p = skiptowhite(arg);
|
|
5993 if (*p != NUL) /* past first word */
|
|
5994 {
|
|
5995 xp->xp_pattern = skipwhite(p);
|
|
5996 if (*skiptowhite(xp->xp_pattern) != NUL)
|
|
5997 xp->xp_context = EXPAND_NOTHING;
|
|
5998 else if (STRNICMP(arg, "case", p - arg) == 0)
|
|
5999 expand_what = EXP_CASE;
|
|
6000 else if ( STRNICMP(arg, "keyword", p - arg) == 0
|
|
6001 || STRNICMP(arg, "region", p - arg) == 0
|
|
6002 || STRNICMP(arg, "match", p - arg) == 0
|
|
6003 || STRNICMP(arg, "list", p - arg) == 0)
|
|
6004 xp->xp_context = EXPAND_HIGHLIGHT;
|
|
6005 else
|
|
6006 xp->xp_context = EXPAND_NOTHING;
|
|
6007 }
|
|
6008 }
|
|
6009 }
|
|
6010
|
|
6011 static char *(case_args[]) = {"match", "ignore", NULL};
|
|
6012
|
|
6013 /*
|
|
6014 * Function given to ExpandGeneric() to obtain the list syntax names for
|
|
6015 * expansion.
|
|
6016 */
|
|
6017 /*ARGSUSED*/
|
|
6018 char_u *
|
|
6019 get_syntax_name(xp, idx)
|
|
6020 expand_T *xp;
|
|
6021 int idx;
|
|
6022 {
|
|
6023 if (expand_what == EXP_SUBCMD)
|
|
6024 return (char_u *)subcommands[idx].name;
|
|
6025 return (char_u *)case_args[idx];
|
|
6026 }
|
|
6027
|
|
6028 #endif /* FEAT_CMDL_COMPL */
|
|
6029
|
|
6030 /*
|
|
6031 * Function called for expression evaluation: get syntax ID at file position.
|
|
6032 */
|
|
6033 int
|
499
|
6034 syn_get_id(wp, lnum, col, trans, spellp)
|
|
6035 win_T *wp;
|
7
|
6036 long lnum;
|
253
|
6037 colnr_T col;
|
7
|
6038 int trans; /* remove transparancy */
|
253
|
6039 int *spellp; /* return: can do spell checking */
|
7
|
6040 {
|
|
6041 /* When the position is not after the current position and in the same
|
|
6042 * line of the same buffer, need to restart parsing. */
|
499
|
6043 if (wp->w_buffer != syn_buf
|
7
|
6044 || lnum != current_lnum
|
253
|
6045 || col < current_col)
|
499
|
6046 syntax_start(wp, lnum);
|
7
|
6047
|
253
|
6048 (void)get_syntax_attr(col, spellp);
|
7
|
6049
|
|
6050 return (trans ? current_trans_id : current_id);
|
|
6051 }
|
|
6052
|
|
6053 #if defined(FEAT_FOLDING) || defined(PROTO)
|
|
6054 /*
|
|
6055 * Function called to get folding level for line "lnum" in window "wp".
|
|
6056 */
|
|
6057 int
|
|
6058 syn_get_foldlevel(wp, lnum)
|
|
6059 win_T *wp;
|
|
6060 long lnum;
|
|
6061 {
|
|
6062 int level = 0;
|
|
6063 int i;
|
|
6064
|
|
6065 /* Return quickly when there are no fold items at all. */
|
|
6066 if (wp->w_buffer->b_syn_folditems != 0)
|
|
6067 {
|
|
6068 syntax_start(wp, lnum);
|
|
6069
|
|
6070 for (i = 0; i < current_state.ga_len; ++i)
|
|
6071 if (CUR_STATE(i).si_flags & HL_FOLD)
|
|
6072 ++level;
|
|
6073 }
|
|
6074 if (level > wp->w_p_fdn)
|
1028
|
6075 {
|
7
|
6076 level = wp->w_p_fdn;
|
1028
|
6077 if (level < 0)
|
|
6078 level = 0;
|
|
6079 }
|
7
|
6080 return level;
|
|
6081 }
|
|
6082 #endif
|
|
6083
|
|
6084 #endif /* FEAT_SYN_HL */
|
|
6085
|
|
6086
|
|
6087 /**************************************
|
|
6088 * Highlighting stuff *
|
|
6089 **************************************/
|
|
6090
|
|
6091 /*
|
|
6092 * The default highlight groups. These are compiled-in for fast startup and
|
|
6093 * they still work when the runtime files can't be found.
|
|
6094 * When making changes here, also change runtime/colors/default.vim!
|
806
|
6095 * The #ifdefs are needed to reduce the amount of static data. Helps to make
|
|
6096 * the 16 bit DOS (museum) version compile.
|
7
|
6097 */
|
809
|
6098 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
|
6099 # define CENT(a, b) b
|
|
6100 #else
|
|
6101 # define CENT(a, b) a
|
|
6102 #endif
|
7
|
6103 static char *(highlight_init_both[]) =
|
|
6104 {
|
809
|
6105 CENT("ErrorMsg term=standout ctermbg=DarkRed ctermfg=White",
|
|
6106 "ErrorMsg term=standout ctermbg=DarkRed ctermfg=White guibg=Red guifg=White"),
|
1161
|
6107 #ifdef FEAT_SEARCH_EXTRA
|
809
|
6108 CENT("IncSearch term=reverse cterm=reverse",
|
|
6109 "IncSearch term=reverse cterm=reverse gui=reverse"),
|
1161
|
6110 #endif
|
809
|
6111 CENT("ModeMsg term=bold cterm=bold",
|
|
6112 "ModeMsg term=bold cterm=bold gui=bold"),
|
|
6113 CENT("NonText term=bold ctermfg=Blue",
|
|
6114 "NonText term=bold ctermfg=Blue gui=bold guifg=Blue"),
|
|
6115 CENT("StatusLine term=reverse,bold cterm=reverse,bold",
|
|
6116 "StatusLine term=reverse,bold cterm=reverse,bold gui=reverse,bold"),
|
|
6117 CENT("StatusLineNC term=reverse cterm=reverse",
|
|
6118 "StatusLineNC term=reverse cterm=reverse gui=reverse"),
|
806
|
6119 #ifdef FEAT_VERTSPLIT
|
809
|
6120 CENT("VertSplit term=reverse cterm=reverse",
|
|
6121 "VertSplit term=reverse cterm=reverse gui=reverse"),
|
806
|
6122 #endif
|
|
6123 #ifdef FEAT_CLIPBOARD
|
809
|
6124 CENT("VisualNOS term=underline,bold cterm=underline,bold",
|
|
6125 "VisualNOS term=underline,bold cterm=underline,bold gui=underline,bold"),
|
806
|
6126 #endif
|
|
6127 #ifdef FEAT_DIFF
|
809
|
6128 CENT("DiffText term=reverse cterm=bold ctermbg=Red",
|
|
6129 "DiffText term=reverse cterm=bold ctermbg=Red gui=bold guibg=Red"),
|
806
|
6130 #endif
|
|
6131 #ifdef FEAT_INS_EXPAND
|
809
|
6132 CENT("PmenuThumb cterm=reverse",
|
|
6133 "PmenuThumb cterm=reverse gui=reverse"),
|
|
6134 CENT("PmenuSbar ctermbg=Grey",
|
|
6135 "PmenuSbar ctermbg=Grey guibg=Grey"),
|
806
|
6136 #endif
|
|
6137 #ifdef FEAT_WINDOWS
|
809
|
6138 CENT("TabLineSel term=bold cterm=bold",
|
|
6139 "TabLineSel term=bold cterm=bold gui=bold"),
|
|
6140 CENT("TabLineFill term=reverse cterm=reverse",
|
|
6141 "TabLineFill term=reverse cterm=reverse gui=reverse"),
|
806
|
6142 #endif
|
7
|
6143 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
|
6144 "Cursor guibg=fg guifg=bg",
|
809
|
6145 "lCursor guibg=fg guifg=bg", /* should be different, but what? */
|
7
|
6146 #endif
|
|
6147 NULL
|
|
6148 };
|
|
6149
|
|
6150 static char *(highlight_init_light[]) =
|
|
6151 {
|
809
|
6152 CENT("Directory term=bold ctermfg=DarkBlue",
|
|
6153 "Directory term=bold ctermfg=DarkBlue guifg=Blue"),
|
|
6154 CENT("LineNr term=underline ctermfg=Brown",
|
|
6155 "LineNr term=underline ctermfg=Brown guifg=Brown"),
|
|
6156 CENT("MoreMsg term=bold ctermfg=DarkGreen",
|
|
6157 "MoreMsg term=bold ctermfg=DarkGreen gui=bold guifg=SeaGreen"),
|
|
6158 CENT("Question term=standout ctermfg=DarkGreen",
|
|
6159 "Question term=standout ctermfg=DarkGreen gui=bold guifg=SeaGreen"),
|
|
6160 CENT("Search term=reverse ctermbg=Yellow ctermfg=NONE",
|
|
6161 "Search term=reverse ctermbg=Yellow ctermfg=NONE guibg=Yellow guifg=NONE"),
|
806
|
6162 #ifdef FEAT_SPELL
|
809
|
6163 CENT("SpellBad term=reverse ctermbg=LightRed",
|
|
6164 "SpellBad term=reverse ctermbg=LightRed guisp=Red gui=undercurl"),
|
|
6165 CENT("SpellCap term=reverse ctermbg=LightBlue",
|
|
6166 "SpellCap term=reverse ctermbg=LightBlue guisp=Blue gui=undercurl"),
|
|
6167 CENT("SpellRare term=reverse ctermbg=LightMagenta",
|
|
6168 "SpellRare term=reverse ctermbg=LightMagenta guisp=Magenta gui=undercurl"),
|
|
6169 CENT("SpellLocal term=underline ctermbg=Cyan",
|
|
6170 "SpellLocal term=underline ctermbg=Cyan guisp=DarkCyan gui=undercurl"),
|
806
|
6171 #endif
|
|
6172 #ifdef FEAT_INS_EXPAND
|
809
|
6173 CENT("Pmenu ctermbg=LightMagenta",
|
|
6174 "Pmenu ctermbg=LightMagenta guibg=LightMagenta"),
|
|
6175 CENT("PmenuSel ctermbg=LightGrey",
|
|
6176 "PmenuSel ctermbg=LightGrey guibg=Grey"),
|
806
|
6177 #endif
|
809
|
6178 CENT("SpecialKey term=bold ctermfg=DarkBlue",
|
|
6179 "SpecialKey term=bold ctermfg=DarkBlue guifg=Blue"),
|
|
6180 CENT("Title term=bold ctermfg=DarkMagenta",
|
|
6181 "Title term=bold ctermfg=DarkMagenta gui=bold guifg=Magenta"),
|
|
6182 CENT("WarningMsg term=standout ctermfg=DarkRed",
|
|
6183 "WarningMsg term=standout ctermfg=DarkRed guifg=Red"),
|
806
|
6184 #ifdef FEAT_WILDMENU
|
809
|
6185 CENT("WildMenu term=standout ctermbg=Yellow ctermfg=Black",
|
|
6186 "WildMenu term=standout ctermbg=Yellow ctermfg=Black guibg=Yellow guifg=Black"),
|
806
|
6187 #endif
|
|
6188 #ifdef FEAT_FOLDING
|
809
|
6189 CENT("Folded term=standout ctermbg=Grey ctermfg=DarkBlue",
|
|
6190 "Folded term=standout ctermbg=Grey ctermfg=DarkBlue guibg=LightGrey guifg=DarkBlue"),
|
|
6191 CENT("FoldColumn term=standout ctermbg=Grey ctermfg=DarkBlue",
|
|
6192 "FoldColumn term=standout ctermbg=Grey ctermfg=DarkBlue guibg=Grey guifg=DarkBlue"),
|
806
|
6193 #endif
|
|
6194 #ifdef FEAT_SIGNS
|
809
|
6195 CENT("SignColumn term=standout ctermbg=Grey ctermfg=DarkBlue",
|
|
6196 "SignColumn term=standout ctermbg=Grey ctermfg=DarkBlue guibg=Grey guifg=DarkBlue"),
|
806
|
6197 #endif
|
|
6198 #ifdef FEAT_VISUAL
|
836
|
6199 CENT("Visual term=reverse",
|
|
6200 "Visual term=reverse guibg=LightGrey"),
|
806
|
6201 #endif
|
|
6202 #ifdef FEAT_DIFF
|
809
|
6203 CENT("DiffAdd term=bold ctermbg=LightBlue",
|
|
6204 "DiffAdd term=bold ctermbg=LightBlue guibg=LightBlue"),
|
|
6205 CENT("DiffChange term=bold ctermbg=LightMagenta",
|
|
6206 "DiffChange term=bold ctermbg=LightMagenta guibg=LightMagenta"),
|
|
6207 CENT("DiffDelete term=bold ctermfg=Blue ctermbg=LightCyan",
|
|
6208 "DiffDelete term=bold ctermfg=Blue ctermbg=LightCyan gui=bold guifg=Blue guibg=LightCyan"),
|
806
|
6209 #endif
|
|
6210 #ifdef FEAT_WINDOWS
|
809
|
6211 CENT("TabLine term=underline cterm=underline ctermfg=black ctermbg=LightGrey",
|
|
6212 "TabLine term=underline cterm=underline ctermfg=black ctermbg=LightGrey gui=underline guibg=LightGrey"),
|
806
|
6213 #endif
|
|
6214 #ifdef FEAT_SYN_HL
|
809
|
6215 CENT("CursorColumn term=reverse ctermbg=LightGrey",
|
818
|
6216 "CursorColumn term=reverse ctermbg=LightGrey guibg=Grey90"),
|
809
|
6217 CENT("CursorLine term=underline cterm=underline",
|
818
|
6218 "CursorLine term=underline cterm=underline guibg=Grey90"),
|
806
|
6219 #endif
|
834
|
6220 #ifdef FEAT_AUTOCMD
|
|
6221 CENT("MatchParen term=reverse ctermbg=Cyan",
|
|
6222 "MatchParen term=reverse ctermbg=Cyan guibg=Cyan"),
|
|
6223 #endif
|
806
|
6224 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
7
|
6225 "Normal gui=NONE",
|
806
|
6226 #endif
|
7
|
6227 NULL
|
|
6228 };
|
|
6229
|
|
6230 static char *(highlight_init_dark[]) =
|
|
6231 {
|
809
|
6232 CENT("Directory term=bold ctermfg=LightCyan",
|
|
6233 "Directory term=bold ctermfg=LightCyan guifg=Cyan"),
|
|
6234 CENT("LineNr term=underline ctermfg=Yellow",
|
|
6235 "LineNr term=underline ctermfg=Yellow guifg=Yellow"),
|
|
6236 CENT("MoreMsg term=bold ctermfg=LightGreen",
|
|
6237 "MoreMsg term=bold ctermfg=LightGreen gui=bold guifg=SeaGreen"),
|
|
6238 CENT("Question term=standout ctermfg=LightGreen",
|
|
6239 "Question term=standout ctermfg=LightGreen gui=bold guifg=Green"),
|
|
6240 CENT("Search term=reverse ctermbg=Yellow ctermfg=Black",
|
|
6241 "Search term=reverse ctermbg=Yellow ctermfg=Black guibg=Yellow guifg=Black"),
|
|
6242 CENT("SpecialKey term=bold ctermfg=LightBlue",
|
|
6243 "SpecialKey term=bold ctermfg=LightBlue guifg=Cyan"),
|
806
|
6244 #ifdef FEAT_SPELL
|
809
|
6245 CENT("SpellBad term=reverse ctermbg=Red",
|
|
6246 "SpellBad term=reverse ctermbg=Red guisp=Red gui=undercurl"),
|
|
6247 CENT("SpellCap term=reverse ctermbg=Blue",
|
|
6248 "SpellCap term=reverse ctermbg=Blue guisp=Blue gui=undercurl"),
|
|
6249 CENT("SpellRare term=reverse ctermbg=Magenta",
|
|
6250 "SpellRare term=reverse ctermbg=Magenta guisp=Magenta gui=undercurl"),
|
|
6251 CENT("SpellLocal term=underline ctermbg=Cyan",
|
|
6252 "SpellLocal term=underline ctermbg=Cyan guisp=Cyan gui=undercurl"),
|
806
|
6253 #endif
|
|
6254 #ifdef FEAT_INS_EXPAND
|
809
|
6255 CENT("Pmenu ctermbg=Magenta",
|
|
6256 "Pmenu ctermbg=Magenta guibg=Magenta"),
|
|
6257 CENT("PmenuSel ctermbg=DarkGrey",
|
|
6258 "PmenuSel ctermbg=DarkGrey guibg=DarkGrey"),
|
806
|
6259 #endif
|
809
|
6260 CENT("Title term=bold ctermfg=LightMagenta",
|
|
6261 "Title term=bold ctermfg=LightMagenta gui=bold guifg=Magenta"),
|
|
6262 CENT("WarningMsg term=standout ctermfg=LightRed",
|
|
6263 "WarningMsg term=standout ctermfg=LightRed guifg=Red"),
|
806
|
6264 #ifdef FEAT_WILDMENU
|
809
|
6265 CENT("WildMenu term=standout ctermbg=Yellow ctermfg=Black",
|
|
6266 "WildMenu term=standout ctermbg=Yellow ctermfg=Black guibg=Yellow guifg=Black"),
|
806
|
6267 #endif
|
|
6268 #ifdef FEAT_FOLDING
|
809
|
6269 CENT("Folded term=standout ctermbg=DarkGrey ctermfg=Cyan",
|
|
6270 "Folded term=standout ctermbg=DarkGrey ctermfg=Cyan guibg=DarkGrey guifg=Cyan"),
|
|
6271 CENT("FoldColumn term=standout ctermbg=DarkGrey ctermfg=Cyan",
|
|
6272 "FoldColumn term=standout ctermbg=DarkGrey ctermfg=Cyan guibg=Grey guifg=Cyan"),
|
806
|
6273 #endif
|
|
6274 #ifdef FEAT_SIGNS
|
809
|
6275 CENT("SignColumn term=standout ctermbg=DarkGrey ctermfg=Cyan",
|
|
6276 "SignColumn term=standout ctermbg=DarkGrey ctermfg=Cyan guibg=Grey guifg=Cyan"),
|
806
|
6277 #endif
|
|
6278 #ifdef FEAT_VISUAL
|
836
|
6279 CENT("Visual term=reverse",
|
|
6280 "Visual term=reverse guibg=DarkGrey"),
|
806
|
6281 #endif
|
|
6282 #ifdef FEAT_DIFF
|
809
|
6283 CENT("DiffAdd term=bold ctermbg=DarkBlue",
|
|
6284 "DiffAdd term=bold ctermbg=DarkBlue guibg=DarkBlue"),
|
|
6285 CENT("DiffChange term=bold ctermbg=DarkMagenta",
|
|
6286 "DiffChange term=bold ctermbg=DarkMagenta guibg=DarkMagenta"),
|
|
6287 CENT("DiffDelete term=bold ctermfg=Blue ctermbg=DarkCyan",
|
|
6288 "DiffDelete term=bold ctermfg=Blue ctermbg=DarkCyan gui=bold guifg=Blue guibg=DarkCyan"),
|
806
|
6289 #endif
|
|
6290 #ifdef FEAT_WINDOWS
|
809
|
6291 CENT("TabLine term=underline cterm=underline ctermfg=white ctermbg=DarkGrey",
|
|
6292 "TabLine term=underline cterm=underline ctermfg=white ctermbg=DarkGrey gui=underline guibg=DarkGrey"),
|
806
|
6293 #endif
|
|
6294 #ifdef FEAT_SYN_HL
|
809
|
6295 CENT("CursorColumn term=reverse ctermbg=DarkGrey",
|
834
|
6296 "CursorColumn term=reverse ctermbg=DarkGrey guibg=Grey40"),
|
809
|
6297 CENT("CursorLine term=underline cterm=underline",
|
834
|
6298 "CursorLine term=underline cterm=underline guibg=Grey40"),
|
|
6299 #endif
|
|
6300 #ifdef FEAT_AUTOCMD
|
|
6301 CENT("MatchParen term=reverse ctermbg=DarkCyan",
|
|
6302 "MatchParen term=reverse ctermbg=DarkCyan guibg=DarkCyan"),
|
806
|
6303 #endif
|
|
6304 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
7
|
6305 "Normal gui=NONE",
|
806
|
6306 #endif
|
7
|
6307 NULL
|
|
6308 };
|
|
6309
|
|
6310 void
|
|
6311 init_highlight(both, reset)
|
|
6312 int both; /* include groups where 'bg' doesn't matter */
|
|
6313 int reset; /* clear group first */
|
|
6314 {
|
|
6315 int i;
|
|
6316 char **pp;
|
|
6317 static int had_both = FALSE;
|
|
6318 #ifdef FEAT_EVAL
|
|
6319 char_u *p;
|
|
6320
|
|
6321 /*
|
|
6322 * Try finding the color scheme file. Used when a color file was loaded
|
|
6323 * and 'background' or 't_Co' is changed.
|
|
6324 */
|
|
6325 p = get_var_value((char_u *)"g:colors_name");
|
|
6326 if (p != NULL && load_colors(p) == OK)
|
|
6327 return;
|
|
6328 #endif
|
|
6329
|
|
6330 /*
|
|
6331 * Didn't use a color file, use the compiled-in colors.
|
|
6332 */
|
|
6333 if (both)
|
|
6334 {
|
|
6335 had_both = TRUE;
|
|
6336 pp = highlight_init_both;
|
|
6337 for (i = 0; pp[i] != NULL; ++i)
|
|
6338 do_highlight((char_u *)pp[i], reset, TRUE);
|
|
6339 }
|
|
6340 else if (!had_both)
|
|
6341 /* Don't do anything before the call with both == TRUE from main().
|
|
6342 * Not everything has been setup then, and that call will overrule
|
|
6343 * everything anyway. */
|
|
6344 return;
|
|
6345
|
|
6346 if (*p_bg == 'l')
|
|
6347 pp = highlight_init_light;
|
|
6348 else
|
|
6349 pp = highlight_init_dark;
|
|
6350 for (i = 0; pp[i] != NULL; ++i)
|
|
6351 do_highlight((char_u *)pp[i], reset, TRUE);
|
|
6352
|
836
|
6353 /* Reverse looks ugly, but grey may not work for 8 colors. Thus let it
|
844
|
6354 * depend on the number of colors available.
|
|
6355 * With 8 colors brown is equal to yellow, need to use black for Search fg
|
|
6356 * to avoid Statement highlighted text disappears. */
|
527
|
6357 if (t_colors > 8)
|
|
6358 do_highlight((char_u *)(*p_bg == 'l' ? "Visual ctermbg=LightGrey"
|
838
|
6359 : "Visual ctermbg=DarkGrey"), FALSE, TRUE);
|
836
|
6360 else
|
844
|
6361 {
|
838
|
6362 do_highlight((char_u *)"Visual cterm=reverse", FALSE, TRUE);
|
844
|
6363 if (*p_bg == 'l')
|
|
6364 do_highlight((char_u *)"Search ctermfg=black", FALSE, TRUE);
|
|
6365 }
|
527
|
6366
|
7
|
6367 #ifdef FEAT_SYN_HL
|
|
6368 /*
|
|
6369 * If syntax highlighting is enabled load the highlighting for it.
|
|
6370 */
|
|
6371 if (get_var_value((char_u *)"g:syntax_on") != NULL)
|
24
|
6372 {
|
|
6373 static int recursive = 0;
|
|
6374
|
|
6375 if (recursive >= 5)
|
|
6376 EMSG(_("E679: recursive loop loading syncolor.vim"));
|
|
6377 else
|
|
6378 {
|
|
6379 ++recursive;
|
480
|
6380 (void)source_runtime((char_u *)"syntax/syncolor.vim", TRUE);
|
24
|
6381 --recursive;
|
|
6382 }
|
|
6383 }
|
7
|
6384 #endif
|
|
6385 }
|
|
6386
|
|
6387 /*
|
12
|
6388 * Load color file "name".
|
7
|
6389 * Return OK for success, FAIL for failure.
|
|
6390 */
|
|
6391 int
|
12
|
6392 load_colors(name)
|
|
6393 char_u *name;
|
7
|
6394 {
|
|
6395 char_u *buf;
|
|
6396 int retval = FAIL;
|
|
6397 static int recursive = FALSE;
|
|
6398
|
|
6399 /* When being called recursively, this is probably because setting
|
|
6400 * 'background' caused the highlighting to be reloaded. This means it is
|
|
6401 * working, thus we should return OK. */
|
|
6402 if (recursive)
|
|
6403 return OK;
|
|
6404
|
|
6405 recursive = TRUE;
|
12
|
6406 buf = alloc((unsigned)(STRLEN(name) + 12));
|
7
|
6407 if (buf != NULL)
|
|
6408 {
|
12
|
6409 sprintf((char *)buf, "colors/%s.vim", name);
|
480
|
6410 retval = source_runtime(buf, FALSE);
|
7
|
6411 vim_free(buf);
|
12
|
6412 #ifdef FEAT_AUTOCMD
|
|
6413 apply_autocmds(EVENT_COLORSCHEME, NULL, NULL, FALSE, curbuf);
|
|
6414 #endif
|
7
|
6415 }
|
|
6416 recursive = FALSE;
|
|
6417
|
|
6418 return retval;
|
|
6419 }
|
|
6420
|
|
6421 /*
|
|
6422 * Handle the ":highlight .." command.
|
|
6423 * When using ":hi clear" this is called recursively for each group with
|
|
6424 * "forceit" and "init" both TRUE.
|
|
6425 */
|
|
6426 void
|
|
6427 do_highlight(line, forceit, init)
|
|
6428 char_u *line;
|
|
6429 int forceit;
|
|
6430 int init; /* TRUE when called for initializing */
|
|
6431 {
|
|
6432 char_u *name_end;
|
|
6433 char_u *p;
|
|
6434 char_u *linep;
|
|
6435 char_u *key_start;
|
|
6436 char_u *arg_start;
|
|
6437 char_u *key = NULL, *arg = NULL;
|
|
6438 long i;
|
|
6439 int off;
|
|
6440 int len;
|
|
6441 int attr;
|
|
6442 int id;
|
|
6443 int idx;
|
|
6444 int dodefault = FALSE;
|
|
6445 int doclear = FALSE;
|
|
6446 int dolink = FALSE;
|
|
6447 int error = FALSE;
|
|
6448 int color;
|
|
6449 int is_normal_group = FALSE; /* "Normal" group */
|
|
6450 #ifdef FEAT_GUI_X11
|
|
6451 int is_menu_group = FALSE; /* "Menu" group */
|
|
6452 int is_scrollbar_group = FALSE; /* "Scrollbar" group */
|
|
6453 int is_tooltip_group = FALSE; /* "Tooltip" group */
|
|
6454 int do_colors = FALSE; /* need to update colors? */
|
|
6455 #else
|
|
6456 # define is_menu_group 0
|
|
6457 # define is_tooltip_group 0
|
|
6458 #endif
|
|
6459
|
|
6460 /*
|
|
6461 * If no argument, list current highlighting.
|
|
6462 */
|
|
6463 if (ends_excmd(*line))
|
|
6464 {
|
|
6465 for (i = 1; i <= highlight_ga.ga_len && !got_int; ++i)
|
|
6466 /* TODO: only call when the group has attributes set */
|
|
6467 highlight_list_one((int)i);
|
|
6468 return;
|
|
6469 }
|
|
6470
|
|
6471 /*
|
|
6472 * Isolate the name.
|
|
6473 */
|
|
6474 name_end = skiptowhite(line);
|
|
6475 linep = skipwhite(name_end);
|
|
6476
|
|
6477 /*
|
|
6478 * Check for "default" argument.
|
|
6479 */
|
|
6480 if (STRNCMP(line, "default", name_end - line) == 0)
|
|
6481 {
|
|
6482 dodefault = TRUE;
|
|
6483 line = linep;
|
|
6484 name_end = skiptowhite(line);
|
|
6485 linep = skipwhite(name_end);
|
|
6486 }
|
|
6487
|
|
6488 /*
|
|
6489 * Check for "clear" or "link" argument.
|
|
6490 */
|
|
6491 if (STRNCMP(line, "clear", name_end - line) == 0)
|
|
6492 doclear = TRUE;
|
|
6493 if (STRNCMP(line, "link", name_end - line) == 0)
|
|
6494 dolink = TRUE;
|
|
6495
|
|
6496 /*
|
|
6497 * ":highlight {group-name}": list highlighting for one group.
|
|
6498 */
|
|
6499 if (!doclear && !dolink && ends_excmd(*linep))
|
|
6500 {
|
|
6501 id = syn_namen2id(line, (int)(name_end - line));
|
|
6502 if (id == 0)
|
|
6503 EMSG2(_("E411: highlight group not found: %s"), line);
|
|
6504 else
|
|
6505 highlight_list_one(id);
|
|
6506 return;
|
|
6507 }
|
|
6508
|
|
6509 /*
|
|
6510 * Handle ":highlight link {from} {to}" command.
|
|
6511 */
|
|
6512 if (dolink)
|
|
6513 {
|
|
6514 char_u *from_start = linep;
|
|
6515 char_u *from_end;
|
|
6516 char_u *to_start;
|
|
6517 char_u *to_end;
|
|
6518 int from_id;
|
|
6519 int to_id;
|
|
6520
|
|
6521 from_end = skiptowhite(from_start);
|
|
6522 to_start = skipwhite(from_end);
|
|
6523 to_end = skiptowhite(to_start);
|
|
6524
|
|
6525 if (ends_excmd(*from_start) || ends_excmd(*to_start))
|
|
6526 {
|
|
6527 EMSG2(_("E412: Not enough arguments: \":highlight link %s\""),
|
|
6528 from_start);
|
|
6529 return;
|
|
6530 }
|
|
6531
|
|
6532 if (!ends_excmd(*skipwhite(to_end)))
|
|
6533 {
|
|
6534 EMSG2(_("E413: Too many arguments: \":highlight link %s\""), from_start);
|
|
6535 return;
|
|
6536 }
|
|
6537
|
|
6538 from_id = syn_check_group(from_start, (int)(from_end - from_start));
|
|
6539 if (STRNCMP(to_start, "NONE", 4) == 0)
|
|
6540 to_id = 0;
|
|
6541 else
|
|
6542 to_id = syn_check_group(to_start, (int)(to_end - to_start));
|
|
6543
|
|
6544 if (from_id > 0 && (!init || HL_TABLE()[from_id - 1].sg_set == 0))
|
|
6545 {
|
|
6546 /*
|
|
6547 * Don't allow a link when there already is some highlighting
|
|
6548 * for the group, unless '!' is used
|
|
6549 */
|
|
6550 if (to_id > 0 && !forceit && !init
|
|
6551 && hl_has_settings(from_id - 1, dodefault))
|
|
6552 {
|
|
6553 if (sourcing_name == NULL && !dodefault)
|
|
6554 EMSG(_("E414: group has settings, highlight link ignored"));
|
|
6555 }
|
|
6556 else
|
|
6557 {
|
|
6558 if (!init)
|
|
6559 HL_TABLE()[from_id - 1].sg_set |= SG_LINK;
|
|
6560 HL_TABLE()[from_id - 1].sg_link = to_id;
|
448
|
6561 #ifdef FEAT_EVAL
|
|
6562 HL_TABLE()[from_id - 1].sg_scriptID = current_SID;
|
|
6563 #endif
|
745
|
6564 redraw_all_later(SOME_VALID);
|
7
|
6565 }
|
|
6566 }
|
|
6567
|
|
6568 /* Only call highlight_changed() once, after sourcing a syntax file */
|
|
6569 need_highlight_changed = TRUE;
|
|
6570
|
|
6571 return;
|
|
6572 }
|
|
6573
|
|
6574 if (doclear)
|
|
6575 {
|
|
6576 /*
|
|
6577 * ":highlight clear [group]" command.
|
|
6578 */
|
|
6579 line = linep;
|
|
6580 if (ends_excmd(*line))
|
|
6581 {
|
|
6582 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
|
6583 /* First, we do not destroy the old values, but allocate the new
|
|
6584 * ones and update the display. THEN we destroy the old values.
|
|
6585 * If we destroy the old values first, then the old values
|
|
6586 * (such as GuiFont's or GuiFontset's) will still be displayed but
|
|
6587 * invalid because they were free'd.
|
|
6588 */
|
|
6589 if (gui.in_use)
|
|
6590 {
|
|
6591 # ifdef FEAT_BEVAL_TIP
|
|
6592 gui_init_tooltip_font();
|
|
6593 # endif
|
|
6594 # if defined(FEAT_MENU) && (defined(FEAT_GUI_ATHENA) || defined(FEAT_GUI_MOTIF))
|
|
6595 gui_init_menu_font();
|
|
6596 # endif
|
|
6597 }
|
|
6598 # if defined(FEAT_GUI_MSWIN) || defined(FEAT_GUI_X11)
|
|
6599 gui_mch_def_colors();
|
|
6600 # endif
|
|
6601 # ifdef FEAT_GUI_X11
|
|
6602 # ifdef FEAT_MENU
|
|
6603
|
|
6604 /* This only needs to be done when there is no Menu highlight
|
|
6605 * group defined by default, which IS currently the case.
|
|
6606 */
|
|
6607 gui_mch_new_menu_colors();
|
|
6608 # endif
|
|
6609 if (gui.in_use)
|
|
6610 {
|
|
6611 gui_new_scrollbar_colors();
|
|
6612 # ifdef FEAT_BEVAL
|
|
6613 gui_mch_new_tooltip_colors();
|
|
6614 # endif
|
|
6615 # ifdef FEAT_MENU
|
|
6616 gui_mch_new_menu_font();
|
|
6617 # endif
|
|
6618 }
|
|
6619 # endif
|
|
6620
|
|
6621 /* Ok, we're done allocating the new default graphics items.
|
|
6622 * The screen should already be refreshed at this point.
|
|
6623 * It is now Ok to clear out the old data.
|
|
6624 */
|
|
6625 #endif
|
|
6626 #ifdef FEAT_EVAL
|
148
|
6627 do_unlet((char_u *)"colors_name", TRUE);
|
7
|
6628 #endif
|
|
6629 restore_cterm_colors();
|
|
6630
|
|
6631 /*
|
|
6632 * Clear all default highlight groups and load the defaults.
|
|
6633 */
|
|
6634 for (idx = 0; idx < highlight_ga.ga_len; ++idx)
|
|
6635 highlight_clear(idx);
|
|
6636 init_highlight(TRUE, TRUE);
|
|
6637 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
|
6638 if (gui.in_use)
|
|
6639 highlight_gui_started();
|
|
6640 #endif
|
|
6641 highlight_changed();
|
|
6642 redraw_later_clear();
|
|
6643 return;
|
|
6644 }
|
|
6645 name_end = skiptowhite(line);
|
|
6646 linep = skipwhite(name_end);
|
|
6647 }
|
|
6648
|
|
6649 /*
|
|
6650 * Find the group name in the table. If it does not exist yet, add it.
|
|
6651 */
|
|
6652 id = syn_check_group(line, (int)(name_end - line));
|
|
6653 if (id == 0) /* failed (out of memory) */
|
|
6654 return;
|
|
6655 idx = id - 1; /* index is ID minus one */
|
|
6656
|
|
6657 /* Return if "default" was used and the group already has settings. */
|
|
6658 if (dodefault && hl_has_settings(idx, TRUE))
|
|
6659 return;
|
|
6660
|
|
6661 if (STRCMP(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_name_u, "NORMAL") == 0)
|
|
6662 is_normal_group = TRUE;
|
|
6663 #ifdef FEAT_GUI_X11
|
|
6664 else if (STRCMP(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_name_u, "MENU") == 0)
|
|
6665 is_menu_group = TRUE;
|
|
6666 else if (STRCMP(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_name_u, "SCROLLBAR") == 0)
|
|
6667 is_scrollbar_group = TRUE;
|
|
6668 else if (STRCMP(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_name_u, "TOOLTIP") == 0)
|
|
6669 is_tooltip_group = TRUE;
|
|
6670 #endif
|
|
6671
|
|
6672 /* Clear the highlighting for ":hi clear {group}" and ":hi clear". */
|
|
6673 if (doclear || (forceit && init))
|
|
6674 {
|
|
6675 highlight_clear(idx);
|
|
6676 if (!doclear)
|
|
6677 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_set = 0;
|
|
6678 }
|
|
6679
|
|
6680 if (!doclear)
|
|
6681 while (!ends_excmd(*linep))
|
|
6682 {
|
|
6683 key_start = linep;
|
|
6684 if (*linep == '=')
|
|
6685 {
|
|
6686 EMSG2(_("E415: unexpected equal sign: %s"), key_start);
|
|
6687 error = TRUE;
|
|
6688 break;
|
|
6689 }
|
|
6690
|
|
6691 /*
|
|
6692 * Isolate the key ("term", "ctermfg", "ctermbg", "font", "guifg" or
|
|
6693 * "guibg").
|
|
6694 */
|
|
6695 while (*linep && !vim_iswhite(*linep) && *linep != '=')
|
|
6696 ++linep;
|
|
6697 vim_free(key);
|
|
6698 key = vim_strnsave_up(key_start, (int)(linep - key_start));
|
|
6699 if (key == NULL)
|
|
6700 {
|
|
6701 error = TRUE;
|
|
6702 break;
|
|
6703 }
|
|
6704 linep = skipwhite(linep);
|
|
6705
|
|
6706 if (STRCMP(key, "NONE") == 0)
|
|
6707 {
|
|
6708 if (!init || HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_set == 0)
|
|
6709 {
|
|
6710 if (!init)
|
|
6711 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_set |= SG_TERM+SG_CTERM+SG_GUI;
|
|
6712 highlight_clear(idx);
|
|
6713 }
|
|
6714 continue;
|
|
6715 }
|
|
6716
|
|
6717 /*
|
|
6718 * Check for the equal sign.
|
|
6719 */
|
|
6720 if (*linep != '=')
|
|
6721 {
|
|
6722 EMSG2(_("E416: missing equal sign: %s"), key_start);
|
|
6723 error = TRUE;
|
|
6724 break;
|
|
6725 }
|
|
6726 ++linep;
|
|
6727
|
|
6728 /*
|
|
6729 * Isolate the argument.
|
|
6730 */
|
|
6731 linep = skipwhite(linep);
|
|
6732 if (*linep == '\'') /* guifg='color name' */
|
|
6733 {
|
|
6734 arg_start = ++linep;
|
|
6735 linep = vim_strchr(linep, '\'');
|
|
6736 if (linep == NULL)
|
|
6737 {
|
|
6738 EMSG2(_(e_invarg2), key_start);
|
|
6739 error = TRUE;
|
|
6740 break;
|
|
6741 }
|
|
6742 }
|
|
6743 else
|
|
6744 {
|
|
6745 arg_start = linep;
|
|
6746 linep = skiptowhite(linep);
|
|
6747 }
|
|
6748 if (linep == arg_start)
|
|
6749 {
|
|
6750 EMSG2(_("E417: missing argument: %s"), key_start);
|
|
6751 error = TRUE;
|
|
6752 break;
|
|
6753 }
|
|
6754 vim_free(arg);
|
|
6755 arg = vim_strnsave(arg_start, (int)(linep - arg_start));
|
|
6756 if (arg == NULL)
|
|
6757 {
|
|
6758 error = TRUE;
|
|
6759 break;
|
|
6760 }
|
|
6761 if (*linep == '\'')
|
|
6762 ++linep;
|
|
6763
|
|
6764 /*
|
|
6765 * Store the argument.
|
|
6766 */
|
|
6767 if ( STRCMP(key, "TERM") == 0
|
|
6768 || STRCMP(key, "CTERM") == 0
|
|
6769 || STRCMP(key, "GUI") == 0)
|
|
6770 {
|
|
6771 attr = 0;
|
|
6772 off = 0;
|
|
6773 while (arg[off] != NUL)
|
|
6774 {
|
|
6775 for (i = sizeof(hl_attr_table) / sizeof(int); --i >= 0; )
|
|
6776 {
|
|
6777 len = (int)STRLEN(hl_name_table[i]);
|
|
6778 if (STRNICMP(arg + off, hl_name_table[i], len) == 0)
|
|
6779 {
|
|
6780 attr |= hl_attr_table[i];
|
|
6781 off += len;
|
|
6782 break;
|
|
6783 }
|
|
6784 }
|
|
6785 if (i < 0)
|
|
6786 {
|
|
6787 EMSG2(_("E418: Illegal value: %s"), arg);
|
|
6788 error = TRUE;
|
|
6789 break;
|
|
6790 }
|
|
6791 if (arg[off] == ',') /* another one follows */
|
|
6792 ++off;
|
|
6793 }
|
|
6794 if (error)
|
|
6795 break;
|
|
6796 if (*key == 'T')
|
|
6797 {
|
|
6798 if (!init || !(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_set & SG_TERM))
|
|
6799 {
|
|
6800 if (!init)
|
|
6801 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_set |= SG_TERM;
|
|
6802 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_term = attr;
|
|
6803 }
|
|
6804 }
|
|
6805 else if (*key == 'C')
|
|
6806 {
|
|
6807 if (!init || !(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_set & SG_CTERM))
|
|
6808 {
|
|
6809 if (!init)
|
|
6810 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_set |= SG_CTERM;
|
|
6811 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_cterm = attr;
|
|
6812 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_cterm_bold = FALSE;
|
|
6813 }
|
|
6814 }
|
|
6815 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
|
6816 else
|
|
6817 {
|
|
6818 if (!init || !(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_set & SG_GUI))
|
|
6819 {
|
|
6820 if (!init)
|
|
6821 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_set |= SG_GUI;
|
|
6822 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui = attr;
|
|
6823 }
|
|
6824 }
|
|
6825 #endif
|
|
6826 }
|
|
6827 else if (STRCMP(key, "FONT") == 0)
|
|
6828 {
|
|
6829 /* in non-GUI fonts are simply ignored */
|
|
6830 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
|
6831 if (!gui.shell_created)
|
|
6832 {
|
|
6833 /* GUI not started yet, always accept the name. */
|
|
6834 vim_free(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_font_name);
|
|
6835 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_font_name = vim_strsave(arg);
|
|
6836 }
|
|
6837 else
|
|
6838 {
|
|
6839 GuiFont temp_sg_font = HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_font;
|
|
6840 # ifdef FEAT_XFONTSET
|
|
6841 GuiFontset temp_sg_fontset = HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_fontset;
|
|
6842 # endif
|
|
6843 /* First, save the current font/fontset.
|
|
6844 * Then try to allocate the font/fontset.
|
|
6845 * If the allocation fails, HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_font OR
|
|
6846 * sg_fontset will be set to NOFONT or NOFONTSET respectively.
|
|
6847 */
|
|
6848
|
|
6849 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_font = NOFONT;
|
|
6850 # ifdef FEAT_XFONTSET
|
|
6851 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_fontset = NOFONTSET;
|
|
6852 # endif
|
|
6853 hl_do_font(idx, arg, is_normal_group, is_menu_group,
|
|
6854 is_tooltip_group);
|
|
6855
|
|
6856 # ifdef FEAT_XFONTSET
|
|
6857 if (HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_fontset != NOFONTSET)
|
|
6858 {
|
|
6859 /* New fontset was accepted. Free the old one, if there was
|
|
6860 * one.
|
|
6861 */
|
|
6862 gui_mch_free_fontset(temp_sg_fontset);
|
|
6863 vim_free(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_font_name);
|
|
6864 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_font_name = vim_strsave(arg);
|
|
6865 }
|
|
6866 else
|
|
6867 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_fontset = temp_sg_fontset;
|
|
6868 # endif
|
|
6869 if (HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_font != NOFONT)
|
|
6870 {
|
|
6871 /* New font was accepted. Free the old one, if there was
|
|
6872 * one.
|
|
6873 */
|
|
6874 gui_mch_free_font(temp_sg_font);
|
|
6875 vim_free(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_font_name);
|
|
6876 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_font_name = vim_strsave(arg);
|
|
6877 }
|
|
6878 else
|
|
6879 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_font = temp_sg_font;
|
|
6880 }
|
|
6881 #endif
|
|
6882 }
|
|
6883 else if (STRCMP(key, "CTERMFG") == 0 || STRCMP(key, "CTERMBG") == 0)
|
|
6884 {
|
|
6885 if (!init || !(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_set & SG_CTERM))
|
|
6886 {
|
|
6887 if (!init)
|
|
6888 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_set |= SG_CTERM;
|
|
6889
|
|
6890 /* When setting the foreground color, and previously the "bold"
|
|
6891 * flag was set for a light color, reset it now */
|
|
6892 if (key[5] == 'F' && HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_cterm_bold)
|
|
6893 {
|
|
6894 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_cterm &= ~HL_BOLD;
|
|
6895 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_cterm_bold = FALSE;
|
|
6896 }
|
|
6897
|
|
6898 if (VIM_ISDIGIT(*arg))
|
|
6899 color = atoi((char *)arg);
|
|
6900 else if (STRICMP(arg, "fg") == 0)
|
|
6901 {
|
|
6902 if (cterm_normal_fg_color)
|
|
6903 color = cterm_normal_fg_color - 1;
|
|
6904 else
|
|
6905 {
|
|
6906 EMSG(_("E419: FG color unknown"));
|
|
6907 error = TRUE;
|
|
6908 break;
|
|
6909 }
|
|
6910 }
|
|
6911 else if (STRICMP(arg, "bg") == 0)
|
|
6912 {
|
|
6913 if (cterm_normal_bg_color > 0)
|
|
6914 color = cterm_normal_bg_color - 1;
|
|
6915 else
|
|
6916 {
|
|
6917 EMSG(_("E420: BG color unknown"));
|
|
6918 error = TRUE;
|
|
6919 break;
|
|
6920 }
|
|
6921 }
|
|
6922 else
|
|
6923 {
|
|
6924 static char *(color_names[28]) = {
|
|
6925 "Black", "DarkBlue", "DarkGreen", "DarkCyan",
|
|
6926 "DarkRed", "DarkMagenta", "Brown", "DarkYellow",
|
|
6927 "Gray", "Grey",
|
|
6928 "LightGray", "LightGrey", "DarkGray", "DarkGrey",
|
|
6929 "Blue", "LightBlue", "Green", "LightGreen",
|
|
6930 "Cyan", "LightCyan", "Red", "LightRed", "Magenta",
|
|
6931 "LightMagenta", "Yellow", "LightYellow", "White", "NONE"};
|
|
6932 static int color_numbers_16[28] = {0, 1, 2, 3,
|
|
6933 4, 5, 6, 6,
|
|
6934 7, 7,
|
|
6935 7, 7, 8, 8,
|
|
6936 9, 9, 10, 10,
|
|
6937 11, 11, 12, 12, 13,
|
|
6938 13, 14, 14, 15, -1};
|
|
6939 /* for xterm with 88 colors... */
|
|
6940 static int color_numbers_88[28] = {0, 4, 2, 6,
|
|
6941 1, 5, 32, 72,
|
|
6942 84, 84,
|
|
6943 7, 7, 82, 82,
|
|
6944 12, 43, 10, 61,
|
|
6945 14, 63, 9, 74, 13,
|
|
6946 75, 11, 78, 15, -1};
|
|
6947 /* for xterm with 256 colors... */
|
|
6948 static int color_numbers_256[28] = {0, 4, 2, 6,
|
|
6949 1, 5, 130, 130,
|
|
6950 248, 248,
|
|
6951 7, 7, 242, 242,
|
|
6952 12, 81, 10, 121,
|
|
6953 14, 159, 9, 224, 13,
|
|
6954 225, 11, 229, 15, -1};
|
|
6955 /* for terminals with less than 16 colors... */
|
|
6956 static int color_numbers_8[28] = {0, 4, 2, 6,
|
|
6957 1, 5, 3, 3,
|
|
6958 7, 7,
|
|
6959 7, 7, 0+8, 0+8,
|
|
6960 4+8, 4+8, 2+8, 2+8,
|
|
6961 6+8, 6+8, 1+8, 1+8, 5+8,
|
|
6962 5+8, 3+8, 3+8, 7+8, -1};
|
|
6963 #if defined(__QNXNTO__)
|
|
6964 static int *color_numbers_8_qansi = color_numbers_8;
|
|
6965 /* On qnx, the 8 & 16 color arrays are the same */
|
|
6966 if (STRNCMP(T_NAME, "qansi", 5) == 0)
|
|
6967 color_numbers_8_qansi = color_numbers_16;
|
|
6968 #endif
|
|
6969
|
|
6970 /* reduce calls to STRICMP a bit, it can be slow */
|
|
6971 off = TOUPPER_ASC(*arg);
|
|
6972 for (i = (sizeof(color_names) / sizeof(char *)); --i >= 0; )
|
|
6973 if (off == color_names[i][0]
|
|
6974 && STRICMP(arg + 1, color_names[i] + 1) == 0)
|
|
6975 break;
|
|
6976 if (i < 0)
|
|
6977 {
|
|
6978 EMSG2(_("E421: Color name or number not recognized: %s"), key_start);
|
|
6979 error = TRUE;
|
|
6980 break;
|
|
6981 }
|
|
6982
|
|
6983 /* Use the _16 table to check if its a valid color name. */
|
|
6984 color = color_numbers_16[i];
|
|
6985 if (color >= 0)
|
|
6986 {
|
|
6987 if (t_colors == 8)
|
|
6988 {
|
|
6989 /* t_Co is 8: use the 8 colors table */
|
|
6990 #if defined(__QNXNTO__)
|
|
6991 color = color_numbers_8_qansi[i];
|
|
6992 #else
|
|
6993 color = color_numbers_8[i];
|
|
6994 #endif
|
|
6995 if (key[5] == 'F')
|
|
6996 {
|
|
6997 /* set/reset bold attribute to get light foreground
|
|
6998 * colors (on some terminals, e.g. "linux") */
|
|
6999 if (color & 8)
|
|
7000 {
|
|
7001 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_cterm |= HL_BOLD;
|
|
7002 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_cterm_bold = TRUE;
|
|
7003 }
|
|
7004 else
|
|
7005 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_cterm &= ~HL_BOLD;
|
|
7006 }
|
|
7007 color &= 7; /* truncate to 8 colors */
|
|
7008 }
|
|
7009 else if (t_colors == 16 || t_colors == 88
|
|
7010 || t_colors == 256)
|
|
7011 {
|
|
7012 /*
|
|
7013 * Guess: if the termcap entry ends in 'm', it is
|
|
7014 * probably an xterm-like terminal. Use the changed
|
|
7015 * order for colors.
|
|
7016 */
|
|
7017 if (*T_CAF != NUL)
|
|
7018 p = T_CAF;
|
|
7019 else
|
|
7020 p = T_CSF;
|
|
7021 if (*p != NUL && *(p + STRLEN(p) - 1) == 'm')
|
|
7022 switch (t_colors)
|
|
7023 {
|
|
7024 case 16:
|
|
7025 color = color_numbers_8[i];
|
|
7026 break;
|
|
7027 case 88:
|
|
7028 color = color_numbers_88[i];
|
|
7029 break;
|
|
7030 case 256:
|
|
7031 color = color_numbers_256[i];
|
|
7032 break;
|
|
7033 }
|
|
7034 }
|
|
7035 }
|
|
7036 }
|
|
7037 /* Add one to the argument, to avoid zero */
|
|
7038 if (key[5] == 'F')
|
|
7039 {
|
|
7040 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_cterm_fg = color + 1;
|
|
7041 if (is_normal_group)
|
|
7042 {
|
|
7043 cterm_normal_fg_color = color + 1;
|
|
7044 cterm_normal_fg_bold = (HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_cterm & HL_BOLD);
|
|
7045 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
|
7046 /* Don't do this if the GUI is used. */
|
|
7047 if (!gui.in_use && !gui.starting)
|
|
7048 #endif
|
|
7049 {
|
|
7050 must_redraw = CLEAR;
|
|
7051 if (termcap_active)
|
|
7052 term_fg_color(color);
|
|
7053 }
|
|
7054 }
|
|
7055 }
|
|
7056 else
|
|
7057 {
|
|
7058 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_cterm_bg = color + 1;
|
|
7059 if (is_normal_group)
|
|
7060 {
|
|
7061 cterm_normal_bg_color = color + 1;
|
|
7062 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
|
7063 /* Don't mess with 'background' if the GUI is used. */
|
|
7064 if (!gui.in_use && !gui.starting)
|
|
7065 #endif
|
|
7066 {
|
|
7067 must_redraw = CLEAR;
|
|
7068 if (termcap_active)
|
|
7069 term_bg_color(color);
|
|
7070 if (t_colors < 16)
|
|
7071 i = (color == 0 || color == 4);
|
|
7072 else
|
|
7073 i = (color < 7 || color == 8);
|
|
7074 /* Set the 'background' option if the value is wrong. */
|
|
7075 if (i != (*p_bg == 'd'))
|
|
7076 set_option_value((char_u *)"bg", 0L,
|
|
7077 i ? (char_u *)"dark" : (char_u *)"light", 0);
|
|
7078 }
|
|
7079 }
|
|
7080 }
|
|
7081 }
|
|
7082 }
|
|
7083 else if (STRCMP(key, "GUIFG") == 0)
|
|
7084 {
|
|
7085 #ifdef FEAT_GUI /* in non-GUI guifg colors are simply ignored */
|
205
|
7086 if (!init || !(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_set & SG_GUI))
|
7
|
7087 {
|
205
|
7088 if (!init)
|
|
7089 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_set |= SG_GUI;
|
|
7090
|
|
7091 i = color_name2handle(arg);
|
|
7092 if (i != INVALCOLOR || STRCMP(arg, "NONE") == 0 || !gui.in_use)
|
|
7093 {
|
|
7094 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_fg = i;
|
|
7095 vim_free(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_fg_name);
|
|
7096 if (STRCMP(arg, "NONE"))
|
|
7097 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_fg_name = vim_strsave(arg);
|
|
7098 else
|
|
7099 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_fg_name = NULL;
|
7
|
7100 # ifdef FEAT_GUI_X11
|
205
|
7101 if (is_menu_group)
|
|
7102 gui.menu_fg_pixel = i;
|
|
7103 if (is_scrollbar_group)
|
|
7104 gui.scroll_fg_pixel = i;
|
7
|
7105 # ifdef FEAT_BEVAL
|
205
|
7106 if (is_tooltip_group)
|
|
7107 gui.tooltip_fg_pixel = i;
|
7
|
7108 # endif
|
205
|
7109 do_colors = TRUE;
|
7
|
7110 # endif
|
205
|
7111 }
|
7
|
7112 }
|
|
7113 #endif
|
|
7114 }
|
|
7115 else if (STRCMP(key, "GUIBG") == 0)
|
|
7116 {
|
|
7117 #ifdef FEAT_GUI /* in non-GUI guibg colors are simply ignored */
|
205
|
7118 if (!init || !(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_set & SG_GUI))
|
7
|
7119 {
|
205
|
7120 if (!init)
|
|
7121 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_set |= SG_GUI;
|
|
7122
|
|
7123 i = color_name2handle(arg);
|
|
7124 if (i != INVALCOLOR || STRCMP(arg, "NONE") == 0 || !gui.in_use)
|
|
7125 {
|
|
7126 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_bg = i;
|
|
7127 vim_free(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_bg_name);
|
|
7128 if (STRCMP(arg, "NONE") != 0)
|
|
7129 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_bg_name = vim_strsave(arg);
|
|
7130 else
|
|
7131 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_bg_name = NULL;
|
7
|
7132 # ifdef FEAT_GUI_X11
|
205
|
7133 if (is_menu_group)
|
|
7134 gui.menu_bg_pixel = i;
|
|
7135 if (is_scrollbar_group)
|
|
7136 gui.scroll_bg_pixel = i;
|
7
|
7137 # ifdef FEAT_BEVAL
|
205
|
7138 if (is_tooltip_group)
|
|
7139 gui.tooltip_bg_pixel = i;
|
7
|
7140 # endif
|
205
|
7141 do_colors = TRUE;
|
7
|
7142 # endif
|
205
|
7143 }
|
7
|
7144 }
|
205
|
7145 #endif
|
|
7146 }
|
|
7147 else if (STRCMP(key, "GUISP") == 0)
|
|
7148 {
|
|
7149 #ifdef FEAT_GUI /* in non-GUI guisp colors are simply ignored */
|
|
7150 if (!init || !(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_set & SG_GUI))
|
|
7151 {
|
|
7152 if (!init)
|
|
7153 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_set |= SG_GUI;
|
|
7154
|
|
7155 i = color_name2handle(arg);
|
|
7156 if (i != INVALCOLOR || STRCMP(arg, "NONE") == 0 || !gui.in_use)
|
|
7157 {
|
|
7158 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_sp = i;
|
|
7159 vim_free(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_sp_name);
|
|
7160 if (STRCMP(arg, "NONE") != 0)
|
|
7161 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_sp_name = vim_strsave(arg);
|
|
7162 else
|
|
7163 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_sp_name = NULL;
|
|
7164 }
|
|
7165 }
|
7
|
7166 #endif
|
|
7167 }
|
|
7168 else if (STRCMP(key, "START") == 0 || STRCMP(key, "STOP") == 0)
|
|
7169 {
|
|
7170 char_u buf[100];
|
|
7171 char_u *tname;
|
|
7172
|
|
7173 if (!init)
|
|
7174 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_set |= SG_TERM;
|
|
7175
|
|
7176 /*
|
|
7177 * The "start" and "stop" arguments can be a literal escape
|
1222
|
7178 * sequence, or a comma separated list of terminal codes.
|
7
|
7179 */
|
|
7180 if (STRNCMP(arg, "t_", 2) == 0)
|
|
7181 {
|
|
7182 off = 0;
|
|
7183 buf[0] = 0;
|
|
7184 while (arg[off] != NUL)
|
|
7185 {
|
|
7186 /* Isolate one termcap name */
|
|
7187 for (len = 0; arg[off + len] &&
|
|
7188 arg[off + len] != ','; ++len)
|
|
7189 ;
|
|
7190 tname = vim_strnsave(arg + off, len);
|
|
7191 if (tname == NULL) /* out of memory */
|
|
7192 {
|
|
7193 error = TRUE;
|
|
7194 break;
|
|
7195 }
|
|
7196 /* lookup the escape sequence for the item */
|
|
7197 p = get_term_code(tname);
|
|
7198 vim_free(tname);
|
|
7199 if (p == NULL) /* ignore non-existing things */
|
|
7200 p = (char_u *)"";
|
|
7201
|
|
7202 /* Append it to the already found stuff */
|
|
7203 if ((int)(STRLEN(buf) + STRLEN(p)) >= 99)
|
|
7204 {
|
|
7205 EMSG2(_("E422: terminal code too long: %s"), arg);
|
|
7206 error = TRUE;
|
|
7207 break;
|
|
7208 }
|
|
7209 STRCAT(buf, p);
|
|
7210
|
|
7211 /* Advance to the next item */
|
|
7212 off += len;
|
|
7213 if (arg[off] == ',') /* another one follows */
|
|
7214 ++off;
|
|
7215 }
|
|
7216 }
|
|
7217 else
|
|
7218 {
|
|
7219 /*
|
|
7220 * Copy characters from arg[] to buf[], translating <> codes.
|
|
7221 */
|
|
7222 for (p = arg, off = 0; off < 100 && *p; )
|
|
7223 {
|
|
7224 len = trans_special(&p, buf + off, FALSE);
|
|
7225 if (len) /* recognized special char */
|
|
7226 off += len;
|
|
7227 else /* copy as normal char */
|
|
7228 buf[off++] = *p++;
|
|
7229 }
|
|
7230 buf[off] = NUL;
|
|
7231 }
|
|
7232 if (error)
|
|
7233 break;
|
|
7234
|
|
7235 if (STRCMP(buf, "NONE") == 0) /* resetting the value */
|
|
7236 p = NULL;
|
|
7237 else
|
|
7238 p = vim_strsave(buf);
|
|
7239 if (key[2] == 'A')
|
|
7240 {
|
|
7241 vim_free(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_start);
|
|
7242 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_start = p;
|
|
7243 }
|
|
7244 else
|
|
7245 {
|
|
7246 vim_free(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_stop);
|
|
7247 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_stop = p;
|
|
7248 }
|
|
7249 }
|
|
7250 else
|
|
7251 {
|
|
7252 EMSG2(_("E423: Illegal argument: %s"), key_start);
|
|
7253 error = TRUE;
|
|
7254 break;
|
|
7255 }
|
|
7256
|
|
7257 /*
|
|
7258 * When highlighting has been given for a group, don't link it.
|
|
7259 */
|
|
7260 if (!init || !(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_set & SG_LINK))
|
|
7261 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_link = 0;
|
|
7262
|
|
7263 /*
|
|
7264 * Continue with next argument.
|
|
7265 */
|
|
7266 linep = skipwhite(linep);
|
|
7267 }
|
|
7268
|
|
7269 /*
|
|
7270 * If there is an error, and it's a new entry, remove it from the table.
|
|
7271 */
|
|
7272 if (error && idx == highlight_ga.ga_len)
|
|
7273 syn_unadd_group();
|
|
7274 else
|
|
7275 {
|
|
7276 if (is_normal_group)
|
|
7277 {
|
|
7278 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_term_attr = 0;
|
|
7279 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_cterm_attr = 0;
|
|
7280 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
|
7281 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_attr = 0;
|
|
7282 /*
|
|
7283 * Need to update all groups, because they might be using "bg"
|
|
7284 * and/or "fg", which have been changed now.
|
|
7285 */
|
|
7286 if (gui.in_use)
|
|
7287 highlight_gui_started();
|
|
7288 #endif
|
|
7289 }
|
|
7290 #ifdef FEAT_GUI_X11
|
|
7291 # ifdef FEAT_MENU
|
|
7292 else if (is_menu_group)
|
|
7293 {
|
|
7294 if (gui.in_use && do_colors)
|
|
7295 gui_mch_new_menu_colors();
|
|
7296 }
|
|
7297 # endif
|
|
7298 else if (is_scrollbar_group)
|
|
7299 {
|
|
7300 if (gui.in_use && do_colors)
|
|
7301 gui_new_scrollbar_colors();
|
|
7302 }
|
|
7303 # ifdef FEAT_BEVAL
|
|
7304 else if (is_tooltip_group)
|
|
7305 {
|
|
7306 if (gui.in_use && do_colors)
|
|
7307 gui_mch_new_tooltip_colors();
|
|
7308 }
|
|
7309 # endif
|
|
7310 #endif
|
|
7311 else
|
|
7312 set_hl_attr(idx);
|
448
|
7313 #ifdef FEAT_EVAL
|
|
7314 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_scriptID = current_SID;
|
|
7315 #endif
|
819
|
7316 redraw_all_later(NOT_VALID);
|
7
|
7317 }
|
|
7318 vim_free(key);
|
|
7319 vim_free(arg);
|
|
7320
|
|
7321 /* Only call highlight_changed() once, after sourcing a syntax file */
|
|
7322 need_highlight_changed = TRUE;
|
|
7323 }
|
|
7324
|
356
|
7325 #if defined(EXITFREE) || defined(PROTO)
|
|
7326 void
|
|
7327 free_highlight()
|
|
7328 {
|
|
7329 int i;
|
|
7330
|
|
7331 for (i = 0; i < highlight_ga.ga_len; ++i)
|
359
|
7332 {
|
356
|
7333 highlight_clear(i);
|
359
|
7334 vim_free(HL_TABLE()[i].sg_name);
|
|
7335 vim_free(HL_TABLE()[i].sg_name_u);
|
|
7336 }
|
356
|
7337 ga_clear(&highlight_ga);
|
|
7338 }
|
|
7339 #endif
|
|
7340
|
7
|
7341 /*
|
|
7342 * Reset the cterm colors to what they were before Vim was started, if
|
|
7343 * possible. Otherwise reset them to zero.
|
|
7344 */
|
|
7345 void
|
|
7346 restore_cterm_colors()
|
|
7347 {
|
|
7348 #if defined(MSDOS) || (defined(WIN3264) && !defined(FEAT_GUI_W32))
|
|
7349 /* Since t_me has been set, this probably means that the user
|
|
7350 * wants to use this as default colors. Need to reset default
|
|
7351 * background/foreground colors. */
|
|
7352 mch_set_normal_colors();
|
|
7353 #else
|
|
7354 cterm_normal_fg_color = 0;
|
|
7355 cterm_normal_fg_bold = 0;
|
|
7356 cterm_normal_bg_color = 0;
|
|
7357 #endif
|
|
7358 }
|
|
7359
|
|
7360 /*
|
|
7361 * Return TRUE if highlight group "idx" has any settings.
|
|
7362 * When "check_link" is TRUE also check for an existing link.
|
|
7363 */
|
|
7364 static int
|
|
7365 hl_has_settings(idx, check_link)
|
|
7366 int idx;
|
|
7367 int check_link;
|
|
7368 {
|
|
7369 return ( HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_term_attr != 0
|
|
7370 || HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_cterm_attr != 0
|
|
7371 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
|
7372 || HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_attr != 0
|
|
7373 #endif
|
|
7374 || (check_link && (HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_set & SG_LINK)));
|
|
7375 }
|
|
7376
|
|
7377 /*
|
|
7378 * Clear highlighting for one group.
|
|
7379 */
|
|
7380 static void
|
|
7381 highlight_clear(idx)
|
|
7382 int idx;
|
|
7383 {
|
|
7384 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_term = 0;
|
|
7385 vim_free(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_start);
|
|
7386 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_start = NULL;
|
|
7387 vim_free(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_stop);
|
|
7388 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_stop = NULL;
|
|
7389 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_term_attr = 0;
|
|
7390 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_cterm = 0;
|
|
7391 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_cterm_bold = FALSE;
|
|
7392 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_cterm_fg = 0;
|
|
7393 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_cterm_bg = 0;
|
|
7394 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_cterm_attr = 0;
|
|
7395 #ifdef FEAT_GUI /* in non-GUI fonts are simply ignored */
|
|
7396 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui = 0;
|
|
7397 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_fg = INVALCOLOR;
|
|
7398 vim_free(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_fg_name);
|
|
7399 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_fg_name = NULL;
|
|
7400 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_bg = INVALCOLOR;
|
|
7401 vim_free(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_bg_name);
|
|
7402 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_bg_name = NULL;
|
205
|
7403 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_sp = INVALCOLOR;
|
|
7404 vim_free(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_sp_name);
|
|
7405 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_sp_name = NULL;
|
7
|
7406 gui_mch_free_font(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_font);
|
|
7407 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_font = NOFONT;
|
|
7408 # ifdef FEAT_XFONTSET
|
|
7409 gui_mch_free_fontset(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_fontset);
|
|
7410 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_fontset = NOFONTSET;
|
|
7411 # endif
|
|
7412 vim_free(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_font_name);
|
|
7413 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_font_name = NULL;
|
|
7414 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_attr = 0;
|
|
7415 #endif
|
448
|
7416 #ifdef FEAT_EVAL
|
|
7417 /* Clear the script ID only when there is no link, since that is not
|
|
7418 * cleared. */
|
|
7419 if (HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_link == 0)
|
|
7420 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_scriptID = 0;
|
|
7421 #endif
|
7
|
7422 }
|
|
7423
|
|
7424 #if defined(FEAT_GUI) || defined(PROTO)
|
|
7425 /*
|
|
7426 * Set the normal foreground and background colors according to the "Normal"
|
|
7427 * highlighighting group. For X11 also set "Menu", "Scrollbar", and
|
|
7428 * "Tooltip" colors.
|
|
7429 */
|
|
7430 void
|
|
7431 set_normal_colors()
|
|
7432 {
|
|
7433 if (set_group_colors((char_u *)"Normal",
|
205
|
7434 &gui.norm_pixel, &gui.back_pixel,
|
|
7435 FALSE, TRUE, FALSE))
|
7
|
7436 {
|
|
7437 gui_mch_new_colors();
|
|
7438 must_redraw = CLEAR;
|
|
7439 }
|
|
7440 #ifdef FEAT_GUI_X11
|
|
7441 if (set_group_colors((char_u *)"Menu",
|
205
|
7442 &gui.menu_fg_pixel, &gui.menu_bg_pixel,
|
|
7443 TRUE, FALSE, FALSE))
|
7
|
7444 {
|
|
7445 # ifdef FEAT_MENU
|
|
7446 gui_mch_new_menu_colors();
|
|
7447 # endif
|
|
7448 must_redraw = CLEAR;
|
|
7449 }
|
|
7450 # ifdef FEAT_BEVAL
|
|
7451 if (set_group_colors((char_u *)"Tooltip",
|
|
7452 &gui.tooltip_fg_pixel, &gui.tooltip_bg_pixel,
|
|
7453 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE))
|
|
7454 {
|
|
7455 # ifdef FEAT_TOOLBAR
|
|
7456 gui_mch_new_tooltip_colors();
|
|
7457 # endif
|
|
7458 must_redraw = CLEAR;
|
|
7459 }
|
|
7460 #endif
|
|
7461 if (set_group_colors((char_u *)"Scrollbar",
|
205
|
7462 &gui.scroll_fg_pixel, &gui.scroll_bg_pixel,
|
|
7463 FALSE, FALSE, FALSE))
|
7
|
7464 {
|
|
7465 gui_new_scrollbar_colors();
|
|
7466 must_redraw = CLEAR;
|
|
7467 }
|
|
7468 #endif
|
|
7469 }
|
|
7470
|
|
7471 /*
|
|
7472 * Set the colors for "Normal", "Menu", "Tooltip" or "Scrollbar".
|
|
7473 */
|
|
7474 static int
|
|
7475 set_group_colors(name, fgp, bgp, do_menu, use_norm, do_tooltip)
|
|
7476 char_u *name;
|
|
7477 guicolor_T *fgp;
|
|
7478 guicolor_T *bgp;
|
|
7479 int do_menu;
|
|
7480 int use_norm;
|
|
7481 int do_tooltip;
|
|
7482 {
|
|
7483 int idx;
|
|
7484
|
|
7485 idx = syn_name2id(name) - 1;
|
|
7486 if (idx >= 0)
|
|
7487 {
|
|
7488 gui_do_one_color(idx, do_menu, do_tooltip);
|
|
7489
|
|
7490 if (HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_fg != INVALCOLOR)
|
|
7491 *fgp = HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_fg;
|
|
7492 else if (use_norm)
|
|
7493 *fgp = gui.def_norm_pixel;
|
|
7494 if (HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_bg != INVALCOLOR)
|
|
7495 *bgp = HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_bg;
|
|
7496 else if (use_norm)
|
|
7497 *bgp = gui.def_back_pixel;
|
|
7498 return TRUE;
|
|
7499 }
|
|
7500 return FALSE;
|
|
7501 }
|
|
7502
|
|
7503 /*
|
|
7504 * Get the font of the "Normal" group.
|
|
7505 * Returns "" when it's not found or not set.
|
|
7506 */
|
|
7507 char_u *
|
|
7508 hl_get_font_name()
|
|
7509 {
|
|
7510 int id;
|
|
7511 char_u *s;
|
|
7512
|
|
7513 id = syn_name2id((char_u *)"Normal");
|
|
7514 if (id > 0)
|
|
7515 {
|
|
7516 s = HL_TABLE()[id - 1].sg_font_name;
|
|
7517 if (s != NULL)
|
|
7518 return s;
|
|
7519 }
|
|
7520 return (char_u *)"";
|
|
7521 }
|
|
7522
|
|
7523 /*
|
|
7524 * Set font for "Normal" group. Called by gui_mch_init_font() when a font has
|
|
7525 * actually chosen to be used.
|
|
7526 */
|
|
7527 void
|
|
7528 hl_set_font_name(font_name)
|
|
7529 char_u *font_name;
|
|
7530 {
|
|
7531 int id;
|
|
7532
|
|
7533 id = syn_name2id((char_u *)"Normal");
|
|
7534 if (id > 0)
|
|
7535 {
|
|
7536 vim_free(HL_TABLE()[id - 1].sg_font_name);
|
|
7537 HL_TABLE()[id - 1].sg_font_name = vim_strsave(font_name);
|
|
7538 }
|
|
7539 }
|
|
7540
|
|
7541 /*
|
|
7542 * Set background color for "Normal" group. Called by gui_set_bg_color()
|
|
7543 * when the color is known.
|
|
7544 */
|
|
7545 void
|
|
7546 hl_set_bg_color_name(name)
|
|
7547 char_u *name; /* must have been allocated */
|
|
7548 {
|
|
7549 int id;
|
|
7550
|
|
7551 if (name != NULL)
|
|
7552 {
|
|
7553 id = syn_name2id((char_u *)"Normal");
|
|
7554 if (id > 0)
|
|
7555 {
|
|
7556 vim_free(HL_TABLE()[id - 1].sg_gui_bg_name);
|
|
7557 HL_TABLE()[id - 1].sg_gui_bg_name = name;
|
|
7558 }
|
|
7559 }
|
|
7560 }
|
|
7561
|
|
7562 /*
|
|
7563 * Set foreground color for "Normal" group. Called by gui_set_fg_color()
|
|
7564 * when the color is known.
|
|
7565 */
|
|
7566 void
|
|
7567 hl_set_fg_color_name(name)
|
|
7568 char_u *name; /* must have been allocated */
|
|
7569 {
|
|
7570 int id;
|
|
7571
|
|
7572 if (name != NULL)
|
|
7573 {
|
|
7574 id = syn_name2id((char_u *)"Normal");
|
|
7575 if (id > 0)
|
|
7576 {
|
|
7577 vim_free(HL_TABLE()[id - 1].sg_gui_fg_name);
|
|
7578 HL_TABLE()[id - 1].sg_gui_fg_name = name;
|
|
7579 }
|
|
7580 }
|
|
7581 }
|
|
7582
|
|
7583 /*
|
|
7584 * Return the handle for a color name.
|
|
7585 * Returns INVALCOLOR when failed.
|
|
7586 */
|
|
7587 static guicolor_T
|
|
7588 color_name2handle(name)
|
|
7589 char_u *name;
|
|
7590 {
|
|
7591 if (STRCMP(name, "NONE") == 0)
|
|
7592 return INVALCOLOR;
|
|
7593
|
|
7594 if (STRICMP(name, "fg") == 0 || STRICMP(name, "foreground") == 0)
|
|
7595 return gui.norm_pixel;
|
|
7596 if (STRICMP(name, "bg") == 0 || STRICMP(name, "background") == 0)
|
|
7597 return gui.back_pixel;
|
|
7598
|
|
7599 return gui_get_color(name);
|
|
7600 }
|
|
7601
|
|
7602 /*
|
|
7603 * Return the handle for a font name.
|
|
7604 * Returns NOFONT when failed.
|
|
7605 */
|
|
7606 static GuiFont
|
|
7607 font_name2handle(name)
|
|
7608 char_u *name;
|
|
7609 {
|
|
7610 if (STRCMP(name, "NONE") == 0)
|
|
7611 return NOFONT;
|
|
7612
|
|
7613 return gui_mch_get_font(name, TRUE);
|
|
7614 }
|
|
7615
|
|
7616 # ifdef FEAT_XFONTSET
|
|
7617 /*
|
|
7618 * Return the handle for a fontset name.
|
|
7619 * Returns NOFONTSET when failed.
|
|
7620 */
|
|
7621 static GuiFontset
|
|
7622 fontset_name2handle(name, fixed_width)
|
|
7623 char_u *name;
|
|
7624 int fixed_width;
|
|
7625 {
|
|
7626 if (STRCMP(name, "NONE") == 0)
|
|
7627 return NOFONTSET;
|
|
7628
|
|
7629 return gui_mch_get_fontset(name, TRUE, fixed_width);
|
|
7630 }
|
|
7631 # endif
|
|
7632
|
|
7633 /*
|
|
7634 * Get the font or fontset for one highlight group.
|
|
7635 */
|
|
7636 /*ARGSUSED*/
|
|
7637 static void
|
|
7638 hl_do_font(idx, arg, do_normal, do_menu, do_tooltip)
|
|
7639 int idx;
|
|
7640 char_u *arg;
|
|
7641 int do_normal; /* set normal font */
|
|
7642 int do_menu; /* set menu font */
|
|
7643 int do_tooltip; /* set tooltip font */
|
|
7644 {
|
|
7645 # ifdef FEAT_XFONTSET
|
|
7646 /* If 'guifontset' is not empty, first try using the name as a
|
|
7647 * fontset. If that doesn't work, use it as a font name. */
|
|
7648 if (*p_guifontset != NUL
|
|
7649 # ifdef FONTSET_ALWAYS
|
|
7650 || do_menu
|
|
7651 # endif
|
|
7652 # ifdef FEAT_BEVAL_TIP
|
|
7653 /* In Athena & Motif, the Tooltip highlight group is always a fontset */
|
|
7654 || do_tooltip
|
|
7655 # endif
|
|
7656 )
|
|
7657 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_fontset = fontset_name2handle(arg, 0
|
|
7658 # ifdef FONTSET_ALWAYS
|
|
7659 || do_menu
|
|
7660 # endif
|
|
7661 # ifdef FEAT_BEVAL_TIP
|
|
7662 || do_tooltip
|
|
7663 # endif
|
|
7664 );
|
|
7665 if (HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_fontset != NOFONTSET)
|
|
7666 {
|
|
7667 /* If it worked and it's the Normal group, use it as the
|
|
7668 * normal fontset. Same for the Menu group. */
|
|
7669 if (do_normal)
|
|
7670 gui_init_font(arg, TRUE);
|
|
7671 # if (defined(FEAT_GUI_MOTIF) || defined(FEAT_GUI_ATHENA)) && defined(FEAT_MENU)
|
|
7672 if (do_menu)
|
|
7673 {
|
|
7674 # ifdef FONTSET_ALWAYS
|
|
7675 gui.menu_fontset = HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_fontset;
|
|
7676 # else
|
|
7677 /* YIKES! This is a bug waiting to crash the program */
|
|
7678 gui.menu_font = HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_fontset;
|
|
7679 # endif
|
|
7680 gui_mch_new_menu_font();
|
|
7681 }
|
|
7682 # ifdef FEAT_BEVAL
|
|
7683 if (do_tooltip)
|
|
7684 {
|
|
7685 /* The Athena widget set cannot currently handle switching between
|
|
7686 * displaying a single font and a fontset.
|
|
7687 * If the XtNinternational resource is set to True at widget
|
1222
|
7688 * creation, then a fontset is always used, otherwise an
|
7
|
7689 * XFontStruct is used.
|
|
7690 */
|
|
7691 gui.tooltip_fontset = (XFontSet)HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_fontset;
|
|
7692 gui_mch_new_tooltip_font();
|
|
7693 }
|
|
7694 # endif
|
|
7695 # endif
|
|
7696 }
|
|
7697 else
|
|
7698 # endif
|
|
7699 {
|
|
7700 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_font = font_name2handle(arg);
|
|
7701 /* If it worked and it's the Normal group, use it as the
|
|
7702 * normal font. Same for the Menu group. */
|
|
7703 if (HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_font != NOFONT)
|
|
7704 {
|
|
7705 if (do_normal)
|
|
7706 gui_init_font(arg, FALSE);
|
|
7707 #ifndef FONTSET_ALWAYS
|
|
7708 # if (defined(FEAT_GUI_MOTIF) || defined(FEAT_GUI_ATHENA)) && defined(FEAT_MENU)
|
|
7709 if (do_menu)
|
|
7710 {
|
|
7711 gui.menu_font = HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_font;
|
|
7712 gui_mch_new_menu_font();
|
|
7713 }
|
|
7714 # endif
|
|
7715 #endif
|
|
7716 }
|
|
7717 }
|
|
7718 }
|
|
7719
|
|
7720 #endif /* FEAT_GUI */
|
|
7721
|
|
7722 /*
|
|
7723 * Table with the specifications for an attribute number.
|
|
7724 * Note that this table is used by ALL buffers. This is required because the
|
|
7725 * GUI can redraw at any time for any buffer.
|
|
7726 */
|
298
|
7727 static garray_T term_attr_table = {0, 0, 0, 0, NULL};
|
7
|
7728
|
|
7729 #define TERM_ATTR_ENTRY(idx) ((attrentry_T *)term_attr_table.ga_data)[idx]
|
|
7730
|
298
|
7731 static garray_T cterm_attr_table = {0, 0, 0, 0, NULL};
|
7
|
7732
|
|
7733 #define CTERM_ATTR_ENTRY(idx) ((attrentry_T *)cterm_attr_table.ga_data)[idx]
|
|
7734
|
|
7735 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
298
|
7736 static garray_T gui_attr_table = {0, 0, 0, 0, NULL};
|
7
|
7737
|
|
7738 #define GUI_ATTR_ENTRY(idx) ((attrentry_T *)gui_attr_table.ga_data)[idx]
|
|
7739 #endif
|
|
7740
|
|
7741 /*
|
|
7742 * Return the attr number for a set of colors and font.
|
|
7743 * Add a new entry to the term_attr_table, cterm_attr_table or gui_attr_table
|
|
7744 * if the combination is new.
|
|
7745 * Return 0 for error (no more room).
|
|
7746 */
|
|
7747 static int
|
|
7748 get_attr_entry(table, aep)
|
|
7749 garray_T *table;
|
|
7750 attrentry_T *aep;
|
|
7751 {
|
|
7752 int i;
|
359
|
7753 attrentry_T *taep;
|
7
|
7754 static int recursive = FALSE;
|
|
7755
|
|
7756 /*
|
|
7757 * Init the table, in case it wasn't done yet.
|
|
7758 */
|
|
7759 table->ga_itemsize = sizeof(attrentry_T);
|
|
7760 table->ga_growsize = 7;
|
|
7761
|
|
7762 /*
|
|
7763 * Try to find an entry with the same specifications.
|
|
7764 */
|
|
7765 for (i = 0; i < table->ga_len; ++i)
|
|
7766 {
|
359
|
7767 taep = &(((attrentry_T *)table->ga_data)[i]);
|
|
7768 if ( aep->ae_attr == taep->ae_attr
|
7
|
7769 && (
|
|
7770 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
|
7771 (table == &gui_attr_table
|
359
|
7772 && (aep->ae_u.gui.fg_color == taep->ae_u.gui.fg_color
|
|
7773 && aep->ae_u.gui.bg_color
|
|
7774 == taep->ae_u.gui.bg_color
|
|
7775 && aep->ae_u.gui.sp_color
|
|
7776 == taep->ae_u.gui.sp_color
|
|
7777 && aep->ae_u.gui.font == taep->ae_u.gui.font
|
7
|
7778 # ifdef FEAT_XFONTSET
|
359
|
7779 && aep->ae_u.gui.fontset == taep->ae_u.gui.fontset
|
7
|
7780 # endif
|
|
7781 ))
|
|
7782 ||
|
|
7783 #endif
|
|
7784 (table == &term_attr_table
|
359
|
7785 && (aep->ae_u.term.start == NULL)
|
|
7786 == (taep->ae_u.term.start == NULL)
|
7
|
7787 && (aep->ae_u.term.start == NULL
|
|
7788 || STRCMP(aep->ae_u.term.start,
|
359
|
7789 taep->ae_u.term.start) == 0)
|
|
7790 && (aep->ae_u.term.stop == NULL)
|
|
7791 == (taep->ae_u.term.stop == NULL)
|
7
|
7792 && (aep->ae_u.term.stop == NULL
|
|
7793 || STRCMP(aep->ae_u.term.stop,
|
359
|
7794 taep->ae_u.term.stop) == 0))
|
7
|
7795 || (table == &cterm_attr_table
|
359
|
7796 && aep->ae_u.cterm.fg_color
|
|
7797 == taep->ae_u.cterm.fg_color
|
|
7798 && aep->ae_u.cterm.bg_color
|
|
7799 == taep->ae_u.cterm.bg_color)
|
7
|
7800 ))
|
|
7801
|
|
7802 return i + ATTR_OFF;
|
|
7803 }
|
|
7804
|
271
|
7805 if (table->ga_len + ATTR_OFF > MAX_TYPENR)
|
7
|
7806 {
|
|
7807 /*
|
|
7808 * Running out of attribute entries! remove all attributes, and
|
|
7809 * compute new ones for all groups.
|
|
7810 * When called recursively, we are really out of numbers.
|
|
7811 */
|
|
7812 if (recursive)
|
|
7813 {
|
|
7814 EMSG(_("E424: Too many different highlighting attributes in use"));
|
|
7815 return 0;
|
|
7816 }
|
|
7817 recursive = TRUE;
|
|
7818
|
359
|
7819 clear_hl_tables();
|
|
7820
|
7
|
7821 must_redraw = CLEAR;
|
|
7822
|
|
7823 for (i = 0; i < highlight_ga.ga_len; ++i)
|
|
7824 set_hl_attr(i);
|
|
7825
|
|
7826 recursive = FALSE;
|
|
7827 }
|
|
7828
|
|
7829 /*
|
|
7830 * This is a new combination of colors and font, add an entry.
|
|
7831 */
|
|
7832 if (ga_grow(table, 1) == FAIL)
|
|
7833 return 0;
|
|
7834
|
359
|
7835 taep = &(((attrentry_T *)table->ga_data)[table->ga_len]);
|
|
7836 vim_memset(taep, 0, sizeof(attrentry_T));
|
|
7837 taep->ae_attr = aep->ae_attr;
|
7
|
7838 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
|
7839 if (table == &gui_attr_table)
|
|
7840 {
|
359
|
7841 taep->ae_u.gui.fg_color = aep->ae_u.gui.fg_color;
|
|
7842 taep->ae_u.gui.bg_color = aep->ae_u.gui.bg_color;
|
|
7843 taep->ae_u.gui.sp_color = aep->ae_u.gui.sp_color;
|
|
7844 taep->ae_u.gui.font = aep->ae_u.gui.font;
|
7
|
7845 # ifdef FEAT_XFONTSET
|
359
|
7846 taep->ae_u.gui.fontset = aep->ae_u.gui.fontset;
|
7
|
7847 # endif
|
|
7848 }
|
|
7849 #endif
|
|
7850 if (table == &term_attr_table)
|
|
7851 {
|
|
7852 if (aep->ae_u.term.start == NULL)
|
359
|
7853 taep->ae_u.term.start = NULL;
|
7
|
7854 else
|
359
|
7855 taep->ae_u.term.start = vim_strsave(aep->ae_u.term.start);
|
7
|
7856 if (aep->ae_u.term.stop == NULL)
|
359
|
7857 taep->ae_u.term.stop = NULL;
|
7
|
7858 else
|
359
|
7859 taep->ae_u.term.stop = vim_strsave(aep->ae_u.term.stop);
|
7
|
7860 }
|
|
7861 else if (table == &cterm_attr_table)
|
|
7862 {
|
359
|
7863 taep->ae_u.cterm.fg_color = aep->ae_u.cterm.fg_color;
|
|
7864 taep->ae_u.cterm.bg_color = aep->ae_u.cterm.bg_color;
|
7
|
7865 }
|
|
7866 ++table->ga_len;
|
|
7867 return (table->ga_len - 1 + ATTR_OFF);
|
|
7868 }
|
|
7869
|
359
|
7870 /*
|
|
7871 * Clear all highlight tables.
|
|
7872 */
|
|
7873 void
|
|
7874 clear_hl_tables()
|
|
7875 {
|
|
7876 int i;
|
|
7877 attrentry_T *taep;
|
|
7878
|
|
7879 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
|
7880 ga_clear(&gui_attr_table);
|
|
7881 #endif
|
|
7882 for (i = 0; i < term_attr_table.ga_len; ++i)
|
|
7883 {
|
|
7884 taep = &(((attrentry_T *)term_attr_table.ga_data)[i]);
|
|
7885 vim_free(taep->ae_u.term.start);
|
|
7886 vim_free(taep->ae_u.term.stop);
|
|
7887 }
|
|
7888 ga_clear(&term_attr_table);
|
|
7889 ga_clear(&cterm_attr_table);
|
|
7890 }
|
|
7891
|
745
|
7892 #if defined(FEAT_SYN_HL) || defined(FEAT_SPELL) || defined(PROTO)
|
221
|
7893 /*
|
348
|
7894 * Combine special attributes (e.g., for spelling) with other attributes
|
|
7895 * (e.g., for syntax highlighting).
|
|
7896 * "prim_attr" overrules "char_attr".
|
221
|
7897 * This creates a new group when required.
|
|
7898 * Since we expect there to be few spelling mistakes we don't cache the
|
|
7899 * result.
|
|
7900 * Return the resulting attributes.
|
|
7901 */
|
|
7902 int
|
348
|
7903 hl_combine_attr(char_attr, prim_attr)
|
221
|
7904 int char_attr;
|
348
|
7905 int prim_attr;
|
221
|
7906 {
|
|
7907 attrentry_T *char_aep = NULL;
|
|
7908 attrentry_T *spell_aep;
|
|
7909 attrentry_T new_en;
|
|
7910
|
|
7911 if (char_attr == 0)
|
348
|
7912 return prim_attr;
|
|
7913 if (char_attr <= HL_ALL && prim_attr <= HL_ALL)
|
|
7914 return char_attr | prim_attr;
|
221
|
7915 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
|
7916 if (gui.in_use)
|
|
7917 {
|
|
7918 if (char_attr > HL_ALL)
|
|
7919 char_aep = syn_gui_attr2entry(char_attr);
|
|
7920 if (char_aep != NULL)
|
|
7921 new_en = *char_aep;
|
|
7922 else
|
|
7923 {
|
|
7924 vim_memset(&new_en, 0, sizeof(new_en));
|
548
|
7925 new_en.ae_u.gui.fg_color = INVALCOLOR;
|
|
7926 new_en.ae_u.gui.bg_color = INVALCOLOR;
|
|
7927 new_en.ae_u.gui.sp_color = INVALCOLOR;
|
221
|
7928 if (char_attr <= HL_ALL)
|
|
7929 new_en.ae_attr = char_attr;
|
|
7930 }
|
|
7931
|
348
|
7932 if (prim_attr <= HL_ALL)
|
|
7933 new_en.ae_attr |= prim_attr;
|
221
|
7934 else
|
|
7935 {
|
348
|
7936 spell_aep = syn_gui_attr2entry(prim_attr);
|
221
|
7937 if (spell_aep != NULL)
|
|
7938 {
|
|
7939 new_en.ae_attr |= spell_aep->ae_attr;
|
|
7940 if (spell_aep->ae_u.gui.fg_color != INVALCOLOR)
|
|
7941 new_en.ae_u.gui.fg_color = spell_aep->ae_u.gui.fg_color;
|
|
7942 if (spell_aep->ae_u.gui.bg_color != INVALCOLOR)
|
|
7943 new_en.ae_u.gui.bg_color = spell_aep->ae_u.gui.bg_color;
|
|
7944 if (spell_aep->ae_u.gui.sp_color != INVALCOLOR)
|
|
7945 new_en.ae_u.gui.sp_color = spell_aep->ae_u.gui.sp_color;
|
|
7946 if (spell_aep->ae_u.gui.font != NOFONT)
|
|
7947 new_en.ae_u.gui.font = spell_aep->ae_u.gui.font;
|
|
7948 # ifdef FEAT_XFONTSET
|
|
7949 if (spell_aep->ae_u.gui.fontset != NOFONTSET)
|
|
7950 new_en.ae_u.gui.fontset = spell_aep->ae_u.gui.fontset;
|
|
7951 # endif
|
|
7952 }
|
|
7953 }
|
|
7954 return get_attr_entry(&gui_attr_table, &new_en);
|
|
7955 }
|
|
7956 #endif
|
|
7957
|
|
7958 if (t_colors > 1)
|
|
7959 {
|
|
7960 if (char_attr > HL_ALL)
|
|
7961 char_aep = syn_cterm_attr2entry(char_attr);
|
|
7962 if (char_aep != NULL)
|
|
7963 new_en = *char_aep;
|
|
7964 else
|
|
7965 {
|
|
7966 vim_memset(&new_en, 0, sizeof(new_en));
|
|
7967 if (char_attr <= HL_ALL)
|
|
7968 new_en.ae_attr = char_attr;
|
|
7969 }
|
|
7970
|
348
|
7971 if (prim_attr <= HL_ALL)
|
|
7972 new_en.ae_attr |= prim_attr;
|
221
|
7973 else
|
|
7974 {
|
348
|
7975 spell_aep = syn_cterm_attr2entry(prim_attr);
|
221
|
7976 if (spell_aep != NULL)
|
|
7977 {
|
|
7978 new_en.ae_attr |= spell_aep->ae_attr;
|
|
7979 if (spell_aep->ae_u.cterm.fg_color > 0)
|
|
7980 new_en.ae_u.cterm.fg_color = spell_aep->ae_u.cterm.fg_color;
|
|
7981 if (spell_aep->ae_u.cterm.bg_color > 0)
|
|
7982 new_en.ae_u.cterm.bg_color = spell_aep->ae_u.cterm.bg_color;
|
|
7983 }
|
|
7984 }
|
|
7985 return get_attr_entry(&cterm_attr_table, &new_en);
|
|
7986 }
|
|
7987
|
|
7988 if (char_attr > HL_ALL)
|
|
7989 char_aep = syn_term_attr2entry(char_attr);
|
|
7990 if (char_aep != NULL)
|
|
7991 new_en = *char_aep;
|
|
7992 else
|
|
7993 {
|
|
7994 vim_memset(&new_en, 0, sizeof(new_en));
|
|
7995 if (char_attr <= HL_ALL)
|
|
7996 new_en.ae_attr = char_attr;
|
|
7997 }
|
|
7998
|
348
|
7999 if (prim_attr <= HL_ALL)
|
|
8000 new_en.ae_attr |= prim_attr;
|
221
|
8001 else
|
|
8002 {
|
607
|
8003 spell_aep = syn_term_attr2entry(prim_attr);
|
221
|
8004 if (spell_aep != NULL)
|
|
8005 {
|
|
8006 new_en.ae_attr |= spell_aep->ae_attr;
|
|
8007 if (spell_aep->ae_u.term.start != NULL)
|
|
8008 {
|
|
8009 new_en.ae_u.term.start = spell_aep->ae_u.term.start;
|
|
8010 new_en.ae_u.term.stop = spell_aep->ae_u.term.stop;
|
|
8011 }
|
|
8012 }
|
|
8013 }
|
|
8014 return get_attr_entry(&term_attr_table, &new_en);
|
|
8015 }
|
|
8016 #endif
|
|
8017
|
7
|
8018 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
|
8019
|
|
8020 attrentry_T *
|
|
8021 syn_gui_attr2entry(attr)
|
|
8022 int attr;
|
|
8023 {
|
|
8024 attr -= ATTR_OFF;
|
|
8025 if (attr >= gui_attr_table.ga_len) /* did ":syntax clear" */
|
|
8026 return NULL;
|
|
8027 return &(GUI_ATTR_ENTRY(attr));
|
|
8028 }
|
|
8029 #endif /* FEAT_GUI */
|
|
8030
|
745
|
8031 /*
|
|
8032 * Get the highlight attributes (HL_BOLD etc.) from an attribute nr.
|
|
8033 * Only to be used when "attr" > HL_ALL.
|
|
8034 */
|
|
8035 int
|
|
8036 syn_attr2attr(attr)
|
|
8037 int attr;
|
|
8038 {
|
|
8039 attrentry_T *aep;
|
|
8040
|
|
8041 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
|
8042 if (gui.in_use)
|
|
8043 aep = syn_gui_attr2entry(attr);
|
|
8044 else
|
|
8045 #endif
|
|
8046 if (t_colors > 1)
|
|
8047 aep = syn_cterm_attr2entry(attr);
|
|
8048 else
|
|
8049 aep = syn_term_attr2entry(attr);
|
|
8050
|
|
8051 if (aep == NULL) /* highlighting not set */
|
|
8052 return 0;
|
|
8053 return aep->ae_attr;
|
|
8054 }
|
|
8055
|
|
8056
|
7
|
8057 attrentry_T *
|
|
8058 syn_term_attr2entry(attr)
|
|
8059 int attr;
|
|
8060 {
|
|
8061 attr -= ATTR_OFF;
|
|
8062 if (attr >= term_attr_table.ga_len) /* did ":syntax clear" */
|
|
8063 return NULL;
|
|
8064 return &(TERM_ATTR_ENTRY(attr));
|
|
8065 }
|
|
8066
|
|
8067 attrentry_T *
|
|
8068 syn_cterm_attr2entry(attr)
|
|
8069 int attr;
|
|
8070 {
|
|
8071 attr -= ATTR_OFF;
|
|
8072 if (attr >= cterm_attr_table.ga_len) /* did ":syntax clear" */
|
|
8073 return NULL;
|
|
8074 return &(CTERM_ATTR_ENTRY(attr));
|
|
8075 }
|
|
8076
|
|
8077 #define LIST_ATTR 1
|
|
8078 #define LIST_STRING 2
|
|
8079 #define LIST_INT 3
|
|
8080
|
|
8081 static void
|
|
8082 highlight_list_one(id)
|
|
8083 int id;
|
|
8084 {
|
|
8085 struct hl_group *sgp;
|
|
8086 int didh = FALSE;
|
|
8087
|
|
8088 sgp = &HL_TABLE()[id - 1]; /* index is ID minus one */
|
|
8089
|
|
8090 didh = highlight_list_arg(id, didh, LIST_ATTR,
|
|
8091 sgp->sg_term, NULL, "term");
|
|
8092 didh = highlight_list_arg(id, didh, LIST_STRING,
|
|
8093 0, sgp->sg_start, "start");
|
|
8094 didh = highlight_list_arg(id, didh, LIST_STRING,
|
|
8095 0, sgp->sg_stop, "stop");
|
|
8096
|
|
8097 didh = highlight_list_arg(id, didh, LIST_ATTR,
|
|
8098 sgp->sg_cterm, NULL, "cterm");
|
|
8099 didh = highlight_list_arg(id, didh, LIST_INT,
|
|
8100 sgp->sg_cterm_fg, NULL, "ctermfg");
|
|
8101 didh = highlight_list_arg(id, didh, LIST_INT,
|
|
8102 sgp->sg_cterm_bg, NULL, "ctermbg");
|
|
8103
|
|
8104 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
|
8105 didh = highlight_list_arg(id, didh, LIST_ATTR,
|
|
8106 sgp->sg_gui, NULL, "gui");
|
|
8107 didh = highlight_list_arg(id, didh, LIST_STRING,
|
|
8108 0, sgp->sg_gui_fg_name, "guifg");
|
|
8109 didh = highlight_list_arg(id, didh, LIST_STRING,
|
|
8110 0, sgp->sg_gui_bg_name, "guibg");
|
|
8111 didh = highlight_list_arg(id, didh, LIST_STRING,
|
301
|
8112 0, sgp->sg_gui_sp_name, "guisp");
|
|
8113 didh = highlight_list_arg(id, didh, LIST_STRING,
|
7
|
8114 0, sgp->sg_font_name, "font");
|
|
8115 #endif
|
|
8116
|
448
|
8117 if (sgp->sg_link && !got_int)
|
7
|
8118 {
|
|
8119 (void)syn_list_header(didh, 9999, id);
|
448
|
8120 didh = TRUE;
|
7
|
8121 msg_puts_attr((char_u *)"links to", hl_attr(HLF_D));
|
|
8122 msg_putchar(' ');
|
|
8123 msg_outtrans(HL_TABLE()[HL_TABLE()[id - 1].sg_link - 1].sg_name);
|
|
8124 }
|
448
|
8125
|
694
|
8126 if (!didh)
|
|
8127 highlight_list_arg(id, didh, LIST_STRING, 0, (char_u *)"cleared", "");
|
448
|
8128 #ifdef FEAT_EVAL
|
694
|
8129 if (p_verbose > 0)
|
448
|
8130 last_set_msg(sgp->sg_scriptID);
|
|
8131 #endif
|
7
|
8132 }
|
|
8133
|
|
8134 static int
|
|
8135 highlight_list_arg(id, didh, type, iarg, sarg, name)
|
|
8136 int id;
|
|
8137 int didh;
|
|
8138 int type;
|
|
8139 int iarg;
|
|
8140 char_u *sarg;
|
|
8141 char *name;
|
|
8142 {
|
|
8143 char_u buf[100];
|
|
8144 char_u *ts;
|
|
8145 int i;
|
|
8146
|
448
|
8147 if (got_int)
|
|
8148 return FALSE;
|
7
|
8149 if (type == LIST_STRING ? (sarg != NULL) : (iarg != 0))
|
|
8150 {
|
|
8151 ts = buf;
|
|
8152 if (type == LIST_INT)
|
|
8153 sprintf((char *)buf, "%d", iarg - 1);
|
|
8154 else if (type == LIST_STRING)
|
|
8155 ts = sarg;
|
|
8156 else /* type == LIST_ATTR */
|
|
8157 {
|
|
8158 buf[0] = NUL;
|
|
8159 for (i = 0; hl_attr_table[i] != 0; ++i)
|
|
8160 {
|
|
8161 if (iarg & hl_attr_table[i])
|
|
8162 {
|
|
8163 if (buf[0] != NUL)
|
|
8164 STRCAT(buf, ",");
|
|
8165 STRCAT(buf, hl_name_table[i]);
|
|
8166 iarg &= ~hl_attr_table[i]; /* don't want "inverse" */
|
|
8167 }
|
|
8168 }
|
|
8169 }
|
|
8170
|
|
8171 (void)syn_list_header(didh,
|
|
8172 (int)(vim_strsize(ts) + STRLEN(name) + 1), id);
|
|
8173 didh = TRUE;
|
448
|
8174 if (!got_int)
|
|
8175 {
|
694
|
8176 if (*name != NUL)
|
|
8177 {
|
|
8178 MSG_PUTS_ATTR(name, hl_attr(HLF_D));
|
|
8179 MSG_PUTS_ATTR("=", hl_attr(HLF_D));
|
|
8180 }
|
448
|
8181 msg_outtrans(ts);
|
|
8182 }
|
7
|
8183 }
|
|
8184 return didh;
|
|
8185 }
|
|
8186
|
|
8187 #if (((defined(FEAT_EVAL) || defined(FEAT_PRINTER))) && defined(FEAT_SYN_HL)) || defined(PROTO)
|
|
8188 /*
|
|
8189 * Return "1" if highlight group "id" has attribute "flag".
|
|
8190 * Return NULL otherwise.
|
|
8191 */
|
|
8192 char_u *
|
|
8193 highlight_has_attr(id, flag, modec)
|
|
8194 int id;
|
|
8195 int flag;
|
|
8196 int modec; /* 'g' for GUI, 'c' for cterm, 't' for term */
|
|
8197 {
|
|
8198 int attr;
|
|
8199
|
|
8200 if (id <= 0 || id > highlight_ga.ga_len)
|
|
8201 return NULL;
|
|
8202
|
|
8203 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
|
8204 if (modec == 'g')
|
|
8205 attr = HL_TABLE()[id - 1].sg_gui;
|
|
8206 else
|
|
8207 #endif
|
|
8208 if (modec == 'c')
|
|
8209 attr = HL_TABLE()[id - 1].sg_cterm;
|
|
8210 else
|
|
8211 attr = HL_TABLE()[id - 1].sg_term;
|
|
8212
|
|
8213 if (attr & flag)
|
|
8214 return (char_u *)"1";
|
|
8215 return NULL;
|
|
8216 }
|
|
8217 #endif
|
|
8218
|
|
8219 #if (defined(FEAT_SYN_HL) && defined(FEAT_EVAL)) || defined(PROTO)
|
|
8220 /*
|
|
8221 * Return color name of highlight group "id".
|
|
8222 */
|
|
8223 char_u *
|
|
8224 highlight_color(id, what, modec)
|
|
8225 int id;
|
205
|
8226 char_u *what; /* "fg", "bg", "sp", "fg#", "bg#" or "sp#" */
|
7
|
8227 int modec; /* 'g' for GUI, 'c' for cterm, 't' for term */
|
|
8228 {
|
|
8229 static char_u name[20];
|
|
8230 int n;
|
205
|
8231 int fg = FALSE;
|
|
8232 # ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
|
8233 int sp = FALSE;
|
|
8234 # endif
|
7
|
8235
|
|
8236 if (id <= 0 || id > highlight_ga.ga_len)
|
|
8237 return NULL;
|
|
8238
|
|
8239 if (TOLOWER_ASC(what[0]) == 'f')
|
|
8240 fg = TRUE;
|
205
|
8241 # ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
|
8242 else if (TOLOWER_ASC(what[0]) == 's')
|
|
8243 sp = TRUE;
|
7
|
8244 if (modec == 'g')
|
|
8245 {
|
|
8246 /* return #RRGGBB form (only possible when GUI is running) */
|
|
8247 if (gui.in_use && what[1] && what[2] == '#')
|
|
8248 {
|
|
8249 guicolor_T color;
|
|
8250 long_u rgb;
|
|
8251 static char_u buf[10];
|
|
8252
|
|
8253 if (fg)
|
|
8254 color = HL_TABLE()[id - 1].sg_gui_fg;
|
205
|
8255 else if (sp)
|
|
8256 color = HL_TABLE()[id - 1].sg_gui_sp;
|
7
|
8257 else
|
|
8258 color = HL_TABLE()[id - 1].sg_gui_bg;
|
|
8259 if (color == INVALCOLOR)
|
|
8260 return NULL;
|
|
8261 rgb = gui_mch_get_rgb(color);
|
|
8262 sprintf((char *)buf, "#%02x%02x%02x",
|
|
8263 (unsigned)(rgb >> 16),
|
|
8264 (unsigned)(rgb >> 8) & 255,
|
|
8265 (unsigned)rgb & 255);
|
|
8266 return buf;
|
|
8267 }
|
|
8268 if (fg)
|
|
8269 return (HL_TABLE()[id - 1].sg_gui_fg_name);
|
205
|
8270 if (sp)
|
|
8271 return (HL_TABLE()[id - 1].sg_gui_sp_name);
|
7
|
8272 return (HL_TABLE()[id - 1].sg_gui_bg_name);
|
|
8273 }
|
205
|
8274 # endif
|
7
|
8275 if (modec == 'c')
|
|
8276 {
|
|
8277 if (fg)
|
|
8278 n = HL_TABLE()[id - 1].sg_cterm_fg - 1;
|
|
8279 else
|
|
8280 n = HL_TABLE()[id - 1].sg_cterm_bg - 1;
|
|
8281 sprintf((char *)name, "%d", n);
|
|
8282 return name;
|
|
8283 }
|
|
8284 /* term doesn't have color */
|
|
8285 return NULL;
|
|
8286 }
|
|
8287 #endif
|
|
8288
|
|
8289 #if (defined(FEAT_SYN_HL) && defined(FEAT_GUI) && defined(FEAT_PRINTER)) \
|
|
8290 || defined(PROTO)
|
|
8291 /*
|
|
8292 * Return color name of highlight group "id" as RGB value.
|
|
8293 */
|
|
8294 long_u
|
|
8295 highlight_gui_color_rgb(id, fg)
|
|
8296 int id;
|
|
8297 int fg; /* TRUE = fg, FALSE = bg */
|
|
8298 {
|
|
8299 guicolor_T color;
|
|
8300
|
|
8301 if (id <= 0 || id > highlight_ga.ga_len)
|
|
8302 return 0L;
|
|
8303
|
|
8304 if (fg)
|
|
8305 color = HL_TABLE()[id - 1].sg_gui_fg;
|
|
8306 else
|
|
8307 color = HL_TABLE()[id - 1].sg_gui_bg;
|
|
8308
|
|
8309 if (color == INVALCOLOR)
|
|
8310 return 0L;
|
|
8311
|
|
8312 return gui_mch_get_rgb(color);
|
|
8313 }
|
|
8314 #endif
|
|
8315
|
|
8316 /*
|
|
8317 * Output the syntax list header.
|
|
8318 * Return TRUE when started a new line.
|
|
8319 */
|
|
8320 static int
|
|
8321 syn_list_header(did_header, outlen, id)
|
|
8322 int did_header; /* did header already */
|
|
8323 int outlen; /* length of string that comes */
|
|
8324 int id; /* highlight group id */
|
|
8325 {
|
|
8326 int endcol = 19;
|
|
8327 int newline = TRUE;
|
|
8328
|
|
8329 if (!did_header)
|
|
8330 {
|
|
8331 msg_putchar('\n');
|
448
|
8332 if (got_int)
|
|
8333 return TRUE;
|
7
|
8334 msg_outtrans(HL_TABLE()[id - 1].sg_name);
|
|
8335 endcol = 15;
|
|
8336 }
|
|
8337 else if (msg_col + outlen + 1 >= Columns)
|
448
|
8338 {
|
7
|
8339 msg_putchar('\n');
|
448
|
8340 if (got_int)
|
|
8341 return TRUE;
|
|
8342 }
|
7
|
8343 else
|
|
8344 {
|
|
8345 if (msg_col >= endcol) /* wrap around is like starting a new line */
|
|
8346 newline = FALSE;
|
|
8347 }
|
|
8348
|
|
8349 if (msg_col >= endcol) /* output at least one space */
|
|
8350 endcol = msg_col + 1;
|
|
8351 if (Columns <= endcol) /* avoid hang for tiny window */
|
|
8352 endcol = Columns - 1;
|
|
8353
|
|
8354 msg_advance(endcol);
|
|
8355
|
|
8356 /* Show "xxx" with the attributes. */
|
|
8357 if (!did_header)
|
|
8358 {
|
|
8359 msg_puts_attr((char_u *)"xxx", syn_id2attr(id));
|
|
8360 msg_putchar(' ');
|
|
8361 }
|
|
8362
|
|
8363 return newline;
|
|
8364 }
|
|
8365
|
|
8366 /*
|
|
8367 * Set the attribute numbers for a highlight group.
|
|
8368 * Called after one of the attributes has changed.
|
|
8369 */
|
|
8370 static void
|
|
8371 set_hl_attr(idx)
|
|
8372 int idx; /* index in array */
|
|
8373 {
|
|
8374 attrentry_T at_en;
|
|
8375 struct hl_group *sgp = HL_TABLE() + idx;
|
|
8376
|
|
8377 /* The "Normal" group doesn't need an attribute number */
|
|
8378 if (sgp->sg_name_u != NULL && STRCMP(sgp->sg_name_u, "NORMAL") == 0)
|
|
8379 return;
|
|
8380
|
|
8381 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
|
8382 /*
|
|
8383 * For the GUI mode: If there are other than "normal" highlighting
|
|
8384 * attributes, need to allocate an attr number.
|
|
8385 */
|
|
8386 if (sgp->sg_gui_fg == INVALCOLOR
|
|
8387 && sgp->sg_gui_bg == INVALCOLOR
|
205
|
8388 && sgp->sg_gui_sp == INVALCOLOR
|
7
|
8389 && sgp->sg_font == NOFONT
|
|
8390 # ifdef FEAT_XFONTSET
|
|
8391 && sgp->sg_fontset == NOFONTSET
|
|
8392 # endif
|
|
8393 )
|
|
8394 {
|
|
8395 sgp->sg_gui_attr = sgp->sg_gui;
|
|
8396 }
|
|
8397 else
|
|
8398 {
|
|
8399 at_en.ae_attr = sgp->sg_gui;
|
|
8400 at_en.ae_u.gui.fg_color = sgp->sg_gui_fg;
|
|
8401 at_en.ae_u.gui.bg_color = sgp->sg_gui_bg;
|
205
|
8402 at_en.ae_u.gui.sp_color = sgp->sg_gui_sp;
|
7
|
8403 at_en.ae_u.gui.font = sgp->sg_font;
|
|
8404 # ifdef FEAT_XFONTSET
|
|
8405 at_en.ae_u.gui.fontset = sgp->sg_fontset;
|
|
8406 # endif
|
|
8407 sgp->sg_gui_attr = get_attr_entry(&gui_attr_table, &at_en);
|
|
8408 }
|
|
8409 #endif
|
|
8410 /*
|
|
8411 * For the term mode: If there are other than "normal" highlighting
|
|
8412 * attributes, need to allocate an attr number.
|
|
8413 */
|
|
8414 if (sgp->sg_start == NULL && sgp->sg_stop == NULL)
|
|
8415 sgp->sg_term_attr = sgp->sg_term;
|
|
8416 else
|
|
8417 {
|
|
8418 at_en.ae_attr = sgp->sg_term;
|
|
8419 at_en.ae_u.term.start = sgp->sg_start;
|
|
8420 at_en.ae_u.term.stop = sgp->sg_stop;
|
|
8421 sgp->sg_term_attr = get_attr_entry(&term_attr_table, &at_en);
|
|
8422 }
|
|
8423
|
|
8424 /*
|
|
8425 * For the color term mode: If there are other than "normal"
|
|
8426 * highlighting attributes, need to allocate an attr number.
|
|
8427 */
|
|
8428 if (sgp->sg_cterm_fg == 0 && sgp->sg_cterm_bg == 0)
|
|
8429 sgp->sg_cterm_attr = sgp->sg_cterm;
|
|
8430 else
|
|
8431 {
|
|
8432 at_en.ae_attr = sgp->sg_cterm;
|
|
8433 at_en.ae_u.cterm.fg_color = sgp->sg_cterm_fg;
|
|
8434 at_en.ae_u.cterm.bg_color = sgp->sg_cterm_bg;
|
|
8435 sgp->sg_cterm_attr = get_attr_entry(&cterm_attr_table, &at_en);
|
|
8436 }
|
|
8437 }
|
|
8438
|
|
8439 /*
|
|
8440 * Lookup a highlight group name and return it's ID.
|
|
8441 * If it is not found, 0 is returned.
|
|
8442 */
|
|
8443 int
|
|
8444 syn_name2id(name)
|
|
8445 char_u *name;
|
|
8446 {
|
|
8447 int i;
|
|
8448 char_u name_u[200];
|
|
8449
|
|
8450 /* Avoid using stricmp() too much, it's slow on some systems */
|
|
8451 /* Avoid alloc()/free(), these are slow too. ID names over 200 chars
|
|
8452 * don't deserve to be found! */
|
419
|
8453 vim_strncpy(name_u, name, 199);
|
7
|
8454 vim_strup(name_u);
|
|
8455 for (i = highlight_ga.ga_len; --i >= 0; )
|
|
8456 if (HL_TABLE()[i].sg_name_u != NULL
|
|
8457 && STRCMP(name_u, HL_TABLE()[i].sg_name_u) == 0)
|
|
8458 break;
|
|
8459 return i + 1;
|
|
8460 }
|
|
8461
|
|
8462 #if defined(FEAT_EVAL) || defined(PROTO)
|
|
8463 /*
|
|
8464 * Return TRUE if highlight group "name" exists.
|
|
8465 */
|
|
8466 int
|
|
8467 highlight_exists(name)
|
|
8468 char_u *name;
|
|
8469 {
|
|
8470 return (syn_name2id(name) > 0);
|
|
8471 }
|
819
|
8472
|
|
8473 # if defined(FEAT_SEARCH_EXTRA) || defined(PROTO)
|
|
8474 /*
|
|
8475 * Return the name of highlight group "id".
|
|
8476 * When not a valid ID return an empty string.
|
|
8477 */
|
|
8478 char_u *
|
|
8479 syn_id2name(id)
|
|
8480 int id;
|
|
8481 {
|
|
8482 if (id <= 0 || id >= highlight_ga.ga_len)
|
|
8483 return (char_u *)"";
|
|
8484 return HL_TABLE()[id - 1].sg_name;
|
|
8485 }
|
|
8486 # endif
|
7
|
8487 #endif
|
|
8488
|
|
8489 /*
|
|
8490 * Like syn_name2id(), but take a pointer + length argument.
|
|
8491 */
|
|
8492 int
|
|
8493 syn_namen2id(linep, len)
|
|
8494 char_u *linep;
|
|
8495 int len;
|
|
8496 {
|
|
8497 char_u *name;
|
|
8498 int id = 0;
|
|
8499
|
|
8500 name = vim_strnsave(linep, len);
|
|
8501 if (name != NULL)
|
|
8502 {
|
|
8503 id = syn_name2id(name);
|
|
8504 vim_free(name);
|
|
8505 }
|
|
8506 return id;
|
|
8507 }
|
|
8508
|
|
8509 /*
|
|
8510 * Find highlight group name in the table and return it's ID.
|
|
8511 * The argument is a pointer to the name and the length of the name.
|
|
8512 * If it doesn't exist yet, a new entry is created.
|
|
8513 * Return 0 for failure.
|
|
8514 */
|
|
8515 int
|
|
8516 syn_check_group(pp, len)
|
|
8517 char_u *pp;
|
|
8518 int len;
|
|
8519 {
|
|
8520 int id;
|
|
8521 char_u *name;
|
|
8522
|
|
8523 name = vim_strnsave(pp, len);
|
|
8524 if (name == NULL)
|
|
8525 return 0;
|
|
8526
|
|
8527 id = syn_name2id(name);
|
|
8528 if (id == 0) /* doesn't exist yet */
|
|
8529 id = syn_add_group(name);
|
|
8530 else
|
|
8531 vim_free(name);
|
|
8532 return id;
|
|
8533 }
|
|
8534
|
|
8535 /*
|
|
8536 * Add new highlight group and return it's ID.
|
|
8537 * "name" must be an allocated string, it will be consumed.
|
|
8538 * Return 0 for failure.
|
|
8539 */
|
|
8540 static int
|
|
8541 syn_add_group(name)
|
|
8542 char_u *name;
|
|
8543 {
|
|
8544 char_u *p;
|
|
8545
|
|
8546 /* Check that the name is ASCII letters, digits and underscore. */
|
|
8547 for (p = name; *p != NUL; ++p)
|
|
8548 {
|
|
8549 if (!vim_isprintc(*p))
|
|
8550 {
|
|
8551 EMSG(_("E669: Unprintable character in group name"));
|
|
8552 return 0;
|
|
8553 }
|
|
8554 else if (!ASCII_ISALNUM(*p) && *p != '_')
|
|
8555 {
|
|
8556 /* This is an error, but since there previously was no check only
|
|
8557 * give a warning. */
|
16
|
8558 msg_source(hl_attr(HLF_W));
|
7
|
8559 MSG(_("W18: Invalid character in group name"));
|
|
8560 break;
|
|
8561 }
|
|
8562 }
|
|
8563
|
|
8564 /*
|
|
8565 * First call for this growarray: init growing array.
|
|
8566 */
|
|
8567 if (highlight_ga.ga_data == NULL)
|
|
8568 {
|
|
8569 highlight_ga.ga_itemsize = sizeof(struct hl_group);
|
|
8570 highlight_ga.ga_growsize = 10;
|
|
8571 }
|
|
8572
|
|
8573 /*
|
|
8574 * Make room for at least one other syntax_highlight entry.
|
|
8575 */
|
|
8576 if (ga_grow(&highlight_ga, 1) == FAIL)
|
|
8577 {
|
|
8578 vim_free(name);
|
|
8579 return 0;
|
|
8580 }
|
|
8581
|
|
8582 vim_memset(&(HL_TABLE()[highlight_ga.ga_len]), 0, sizeof(struct hl_group));
|
|
8583 HL_TABLE()[highlight_ga.ga_len].sg_name = name;
|
|
8584 HL_TABLE()[highlight_ga.ga_len].sg_name_u = vim_strsave_up(name);
|
|
8585 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
|
8586 HL_TABLE()[highlight_ga.ga_len].sg_gui_bg = INVALCOLOR;
|
|
8587 HL_TABLE()[highlight_ga.ga_len].sg_gui_fg = INVALCOLOR;
|
205
|
8588 HL_TABLE()[highlight_ga.ga_len].sg_gui_sp = INVALCOLOR;
|
7
|
8589 #endif
|
|
8590 ++highlight_ga.ga_len;
|
|
8591
|
|
8592 return highlight_ga.ga_len; /* ID is index plus one */
|
|
8593 }
|
|
8594
|
|
8595 /*
|
|
8596 * When, just after calling syn_add_group(), an error is discovered, this
|
|
8597 * function deletes the new name.
|
|
8598 */
|
|
8599 static void
|
|
8600 syn_unadd_group()
|
|
8601 {
|
|
8602 --highlight_ga.ga_len;
|
|
8603 vim_free(HL_TABLE()[highlight_ga.ga_len].sg_name);
|
|
8604 vim_free(HL_TABLE()[highlight_ga.ga_len].sg_name_u);
|
|
8605 }
|
|
8606
|
|
8607 /*
|
|
8608 * Translate a group ID to highlight attributes.
|
|
8609 */
|
|
8610 int
|
|
8611 syn_id2attr(hl_id)
|
|
8612 int hl_id;
|
|
8613 {
|
|
8614 int attr;
|
|
8615 struct hl_group *sgp;
|
|
8616
|
|
8617 hl_id = syn_get_final_id(hl_id);
|
|
8618 sgp = &HL_TABLE()[hl_id - 1]; /* index is ID minus one */
|
|
8619
|
|
8620 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
|
8621 /*
|
|
8622 * Only use GUI attr when the GUI is being used.
|
|
8623 */
|
|
8624 if (gui.in_use)
|
|
8625 attr = sgp->sg_gui_attr;
|
|
8626 else
|
|
8627 #endif
|
|
8628 if (t_colors > 1)
|
|
8629 attr = sgp->sg_cterm_attr;
|
|
8630 else
|
|
8631 attr = sgp->sg_term_attr;
|
|
8632
|
|
8633 return attr;
|
|
8634 }
|
|
8635
|
|
8636 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
|
8637 /*
|
|
8638 * Get the GUI colors and attributes for a group ID.
|
|
8639 * NOTE: the colors will be INVALCOLOR when not set, the color otherwise.
|
|
8640 */
|
|
8641 int
|
|
8642 syn_id2colors(hl_id, fgp, bgp)
|
|
8643 int hl_id;
|
|
8644 guicolor_T *fgp;
|
|
8645 guicolor_T *bgp;
|
|
8646 {
|
|
8647 struct hl_group *sgp;
|
|
8648
|
|
8649 hl_id = syn_get_final_id(hl_id);
|
|
8650 sgp = &HL_TABLE()[hl_id - 1]; /* index is ID minus one */
|
|
8651
|
|
8652 *fgp = sgp->sg_gui_fg;
|
|
8653 *bgp = sgp->sg_gui_bg;
|
|
8654 return sgp->sg_gui;
|
|
8655 }
|
|
8656 #endif
|
|
8657
|
|
8658 /*
|
|
8659 * Translate a group ID to the final group ID (following links).
|
|
8660 */
|
|
8661 int
|
|
8662 syn_get_final_id(hl_id)
|
|
8663 int hl_id;
|
|
8664 {
|
|
8665 int count;
|
|
8666 struct hl_group *sgp;
|
|
8667
|
|
8668 if (hl_id > highlight_ga.ga_len || hl_id < 1)
|
|
8669 return 0; /* Can be called from eval!! */
|
|
8670
|
|
8671 /*
|
|
8672 * Follow links until there is no more.
|
|
8673 * Look out for loops! Break after 100 links.
|
|
8674 */
|
|
8675 for (count = 100; --count >= 0; )
|
|
8676 {
|
|
8677 sgp = &HL_TABLE()[hl_id - 1]; /* index is ID minus one */
|
|
8678 if (sgp->sg_link == 0 || sgp->sg_link > highlight_ga.ga_len)
|
|
8679 break;
|
|
8680 hl_id = sgp->sg_link;
|
|
8681 }
|
|
8682
|
|
8683 return hl_id;
|
|
8684 }
|
|
8685
|
|
8686 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
|
8687 /*
|
|
8688 * Call this function just after the GUI has started.
|
|
8689 * It finds the font and color handles for the highlighting groups.
|
|
8690 */
|
|
8691 void
|
|
8692 highlight_gui_started()
|
|
8693 {
|
|
8694 int idx;
|
|
8695
|
|
8696 /* First get the colors from the "Normal" and "Menu" group, if set */
|
|
8697 set_normal_colors();
|
|
8698
|
|
8699 for (idx = 0; idx < highlight_ga.ga_len; ++idx)
|
|
8700 gui_do_one_color(idx, FALSE, FALSE);
|
|
8701
|
|
8702 highlight_changed();
|
|
8703 }
|
|
8704
|
|
8705 static void
|
|
8706 gui_do_one_color(idx, do_menu, do_tooltip)
|
|
8707 int idx;
|
|
8708 int do_menu; /* TRUE: might set the menu font */
|
|
8709 int do_tooltip; /* TRUE: might set the tooltip font */
|
|
8710 {
|
|
8711 int didit = FALSE;
|
|
8712
|
|
8713 if (HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_font_name != NULL)
|
|
8714 {
|
|
8715 hl_do_font(idx, HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_font_name, FALSE, do_menu,
|
|
8716 do_tooltip);
|
|
8717 didit = TRUE;
|
|
8718 }
|
|
8719 if (HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_fg_name != NULL)
|
|
8720 {
|
|
8721 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_fg =
|
|
8722 color_name2handle(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_fg_name);
|
|
8723 didit = TRUE;
|
|
8724 }
|
|
8725 if (HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_bg_name != NULL)
|
|
8726 {
|
|
8727 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_bg =
|
|
8728 color_name2handle(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_bg_name);
|
|
8729 didit = TRUE;
|
|
8730 }
|
205
|
8731 if (HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_sp_name != NULL)
|
|
8732 {
|
|
8733 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_sp =
|
|
8734 color_name2handle(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_gui_sp_name);
|
|
8735 didit = TRUE;
|
|
8736 }
|
7
|
8737 if (didit) /* need to get a new attr number */
|
|
8738 set_hl_attr(idx);
|
|
8739 }
|
|
8740
|
|
8741 #endif
|
|
8742
|
|
8743 /*
|
|
8744 * Translate the 'highlight' option into attributes in highlight_attr[] and
|
|
8745 * set up the user highlights User1..9. If FEAT_STL_OPT is in use, a set of
|
|
8746 * corresponding highlights to use on top of HLF_SNC is computed.
|
|
8747 * Called only when the 'highlight' option has been changed and upon first
|
|
8748 * screen redraw after any :highlight command.
|
|
8749 * Return FAIL when an invalid flag is found in 'highlight'. OK otherwise.
|
|
8750 */
|
|
8751 int
|
|
8752 highlight_changed()
|
|
8753 {
|
|
8754 int hlf;
|
|
8755 int i;
|
|
8756 char_u *p;
|
|
8757 int attr;
|
|
8758 char_u *end;
|
|
8759 int id;
|
|
8760 #ifdef USER_HIGHLIGHT
|
|
8761 char_u userhl[10];
|
|
8762 # ifdef FEAT_STL_OPT
|
|
8763 int id_SNC = -1;
|
|
8764 int id_S = -1;
|
|
8765 int hlcnt;
|
|
8766 # endif
|
|
8767 #endif
|
|
8768 static int hl_flags[HLF_COUNT] = HL_FLAGS;
|
|
8769
|
|
8770 need_highlight_changed = FALSE;
|
|
8771
|
|
8772 /*
|
|
8773 * Clear all attributes.
|
|
8774 */
|
|
8775 for (hlf = 0; hlf < (int)HLF_COUNT; ++hlf)
|
|
8776 highlight_attr[hlf] = 0;
|
|
8777
|
|
8778 /*
|
|
8779 * First set all attributes to their default value.
|
|
8780 * Then use the attributes from the 'highlight' option.
|
|
8781 */
|
|
8782 for (i = 0; i < 2; ++i)
|
|
8783 {
|
|
8784 if (i)
|
|
8785 p = p_hl;
|
|
8786 else
|
|
8787 p = get_highlight_default();
|
|
8788 if (p == NULL) /* just in case */
|
|
8789 continue;
|
|
8790
|
|
8791 while (*p)
|
|
8792 {
|
|
8793 for (hlf = 0; hlf < (int)HLF_COUNT; ++hlf)
|
|
8794 if (hl_flags[hlf] == *p)
|
|
8795 break;
|
|
8796 ++p;
|
|
8797 if (hlf == (int)HLF_COUNT || *p == NUL)
|
|
8798 return FAIL;
|
|
8799
|
|
8800 /*
|
|
8801 * Allow several hl_flags to be combined, like "bu" for
|
|
8802 * bold-underlined.
|
|
8803 */
|
|
8804 attr = 0;
|
|
8805 for ( ; *p && *p != ','; ++p) /* parse upto comma */
|
|
8806 {
|
|
8807 if (vim_iswhite(*p)) /* ignore white space */
|
|
8808 continue;
|
|
8809
|
|
8810 if (attr > HL_ALL) /* Combination with ':' is not allowed. */
|
|
8811 return FAIL;
|
|
8812
|
|
8813 switch (*p)
|
|
8814 {
|
|
8815 case 'b': attr |= HL_BOLD;
|
|
8816 break;
|
|
8817 case 'i': attr |= HL_ITALIC;
|
|
8818 break;
|
|
8819 case '-':
|
|
8820 case 'n': /* no highlighting */
|
|
8821 break;
|
|
8822 case 'r': attr |= HL_INVERSE;
|
|
8823 break;
|
|
8824 case 's': attr |= HL_STANDOUT;
|
|
8825 break;
|
|
8826 case 'u': attr |= HL_UNDERLINE;
|
|
8827 break;
|
205
|
8828 case 'c': attr |= HL_UNDERCURL;
|
|
8829 break;
|
7
|
8830 case ':': ++p; /* highlight group name */
|
|
8831 if (attr || *p == NUL) /* no combinations */
|
|
8832 return FAIL;
|
|
8833 end = vim_strchr(p, ',');
|
|
8834 if (end == NULL)
|
|
8835 end = p + STRLEN(p);
|
|
8836 id = syn_check_group(p, (int)(end - p));
|
|
8837 if (id == 0)
|
|
8838 return FAIL;
|
|
8839 attr = syn_id2attr(id);
|
|
8840 p = end - 1;
|
|
8841 #if defined(FEAT_STL_OPT) && defined(USER_HIGHLIGHT)
|
|
8842 if (hlf == (int)HLF_SNC)
|
|
8843 id_SNC = syn_get_final_id(id);
|
|
8844 else if (hlf == (int)HLF_S)
|
|
8845 id_S = syn_get_final_id(id);
|
|
8846 #endif
|
|
8847 break;
|
|
8848 default: return FAIL;
|
|
8849 }
|
|
8850 }
|
|
8851 highlight_attr[hlf] = attr;
|
|
8852
|
|
8853 p = skip_to_option_part(p); /* skip comma and spaces */
|
|
8854 }
|
|
8855 }
|
|
8856
|
|
8857 #ifdef USER_HIGHLIGHT
|
|
8858 /* Setup the user highlights
|
|
8859 *
|
|
8860 * Temporarily utilize 10 more hl entries. Have to be in there
|
|
8861 * simultaneously in case of table overflows in get_attr_entry()
|
|
8862 */
|
|
8863 # ifdef FEAT_STL_OPT
|
|
8864 if (ga_grow(&highlight_ga, 10) == FAIL)
|
|
8865 return FAIL;
|
|
8866 hlcnt = highlight_ga.ga_len;
|
|
8867 if (id_S == 0)
|
|
8868 { /* Make sure id_S is always valid to simplify code below */
|
|
8869 memset(&HL_TABLE()[hlcnt + 9], 0, sizeof(struct hl_group));
|
|
8870 HL_TABLE()[hlcnt + 9].sg_term = highlight_attr[HLF_S];
|
|
8871 id_S = hlcnt + 10;
|
|
8872 }
|
|
8873 # endif
|
|
8874 for (i = 0; i < 9; i++)
|
|
8875 {
|
|
8876 sprintf((char *)userhl, "User%d", i + 1);
|
|
8877 id = syn_name2id(userhl);
|
|
8878 if (id == 0)
|
|
8879 {
|
|
8880 highlight_user[i] = 0;
|
|
8881 # ifdef FEAT_STL_OPT
|
|
8882 highlight_stlnc[i] = 0;
|
|
8883 # endif
|
|
8884 }
|
|
8885 else
|
|
8886 {
|
|
8887 # ifdef FEAT_STL_OPT
|
|
8888 struct hl_group *hlt = HL_TABLE();
|
|
8889 # endif
|
|
8890
|
|
8891 highlight_user[i] = syn_id2attr(id);
|
|
8892 # ifdef FEAT_STL_OPT
|
|
8893 if (id_SNC == 0)
|
|
8894 {
|
|
8895 memset(&hlt[hlcnt + i], 0, sizeof(struct hl_group));
|
|
8896 hlt[hlcnt + i].sg_term = highlight_attr[HLF_SNC];
|
|
8897 hlt[hlcnt + i].sg_cterm = highlight_attr[HLF_SNC];
|
|
8898 # ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
|
8899 hlt[hlcnt + i].sg_gui = highlight_attr[HLF_SNC];
|
|
8900 # endif
|
|
8901 }
|
|
8902 else
|
|
8903 mch_memmove(&hlt[hlcnt + i],
|
|
8904 &hlt[id_SNC - 1],
|
|
8905 sizeof(struct hl_group));
|
|
8906 hlt[hlcnt + i].sg_link = 0;
|
|
8907
|
|
8908 /* Apply difference between UserX and HLF_S to HLF_SNC */
|
|
8909 hlt[hlcnt + i].sg_term ^=
|
|
8910 hlt[id - 1].sg_term ^ hlt[id_S - 1].sg_term;
|
|
8911 if (hlt[id - 1].sg_start != hlt[id_S - 1].sg_start)
|
|
8912 hlt[hlcnt + i].sg_start = hlt[id - 1].sg_start;
|
|
8913 if (hlt[id - 1].sg_stop != hlt[id_S - 1].sg_stop)
|
|
8914 hlt[hlcnt + i].sg_stop = hlt[id - 1].sg_stop;
|
|
8915 hlt[hlcnt + i].sg_cterm ^=
|
|
8916 hlt[id - 1].sg_cterm ^ hlt[id_S - 1].sg_cterm;
|
|
8917 if (hlt[id - 1].sg_cterm_fg != hlt[id_S - 1].sg_cterm_fg)
|
|
8918 hlt[hlcnt + i].sg_cterm_fg = hlt[id - 1].sg_cterm_fg;
|
|
8919 if (hlt[id - 1].sg_cterm_bg != hlt[id_S - 1].sg_cterm_bg)
|
|
8920 hlt[hlcnt + i].sg_cterm_bg = hlt[id - 1].sg_cterm_bg;
|
|
8921 # ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
|
8922 hlt[hlcnt + i].sg_gui ^=
|
|
8923 hlt[id - 1].sg_gui ^ hlt[id_S - 1].sg_gui;
|
|
8924 if (hlt[id - 1].sg_gui_fg != hlt[id_S - 1].sg_gui_fg)
|
|
8925 hlt[hlcnt + i].sg_gui_fg = hlt[id - 1].sg_gui_fg;
|
|
8926 if (hlt[id - 1].sg_gui_bg != hlt[id_S - 1].sg_gui_bg)
|
|
8927 hlt[hlcnt + i].sg_gui_bg = hlt[id - 1].sg_gui_bg;
|
205
|
8928 if (hlt[id - 1].sg_gui_sp != hlt[id_S - 1].sg_gui_sp)
|
|
8929 hlt[hlcnt + i].sg_gui_sp = hlt[id - 1].sg_gui_sp;
|
7
|
8930 if (hlt[id - 1].sg_font != hlt[id_S - 1].sg_font)
|
|
8931 hlt[hlcnt + i].sg_font = hlt[id - 1].sg_font;
|
|
8932 # ifdef FEAT_XFONTSET
|
|
8933 if (hlt[id - 1].sg_fontset != hlt[id_S - 1].sg_fontset)
|
|
8934 hlt[hlcnt + i].sg_fontset = hlt[id - 1].sg_fontset;
|
|
8935 # endif
|
|
8936 # endif
|
|
8937 highlight_ga.ga_len = hlcnt + i + 1;
|
|
8938 set_hl_attr(hlcnt + i); /* At long last we can apply */
|
|
8939 highlight_stlnc[i] = syn_id2attr(hlcnt + i + 1);
|
|
8940 # endif
|
|
8941 }
|
|
8942 }
|
|
8943 # ifdef FEAT_STL_OPT
|
|
8944 highlight_ga.ga_len = hlcnt;
|
|
8945 # endif
|
|
8946
|
|
8947 #endif /* USER_HIGHLIGHT */
|
|
8948
|
|
8949 return OK;
|
|
8950 }
|
|
8951
|
|
8952 #ifdef FEAT_CMDL_COMPL
|
|
8953
|
|
8954 static void highlight_list __ARGS((void));
|
|
8955 static void highlight_list_two __ARGS((int cnt, int attr));
|
|
8956
|
|
8957 /*
|
|
8958 * Handle command line completion for :highlight command.
|
|
8959 */
|
|
8960 void
|
|
8961 set_context_in_highlight_cmd(xp, arg)
|
|
8962 expand_T *xp;
|
|
8963 char_u *arg;
|
|
8964 {
|
|
8965 char_u *p;
|
|
8966
|
|
8967 /* Default: expand group names */
|
|
8968 xp->xp_context = EXPAND_HIGHLIGHT;
|
|
8969 xp->xp_pattern = arg;
|
|
8970 include_link = TRUE;
|
|
8971 include_default = TRUE;
|
|
8972
|
|
8973 /* (part of) subcommand already typed */
|
|
8974 if (*arg != NUL)
|
|
8975 {
|
|
8976 p = skiptowhite(arg);
|
|
8977 if (*p != NUL) /* past "default" or group name */
|
|
8978 {
|
|
8979 include_default = FALSE;
|
|
8980 if (STRNCMP("default", arg, p - arg) == 0)
|
|
8981 {
|
|
8982 arg = skipwhite(p);
|
|
8983 xp->xp_pattern = arg;
|
|
8984 p = skiptowhite(arg);
|
|
8985 }
|
|
8986 if (*p != NUL) /* past group name */
|
|
8987 {
|
|
8988 include_link = FALSE;
|
|
8989 if (arg[1] == 'i' && arg[0] == 'N')
|
|
8990 highlight_list();
|
|
8991 if (STRNCMP("link", arg, p - arg) == 0
|
|
8992 || STRNCMP("clear", arg, p - arg) == 0)
|
|
8993 {
|
|
8994 xp->xp_pattern = skipwhite(p);
|
|
8995 p = skiptowhite(xp->xp_pattern);
|
|
8996 if (*p != NUL) /* past first group name */
|
|
8997 {
|
|
8998 xp->xp_pattern = skipwhite(p);
|
|
8999 p = skiptowhite(xp->xp_pattern);
|
|
9000 }
|
|
9001 }
|
|
9002 if (*p != NUL) /* past group name(s) */
|
|
9003 xp->xp_context = EXPAND_NOTHING;
|
|
9004 }
|
|
9005 }
|
|
9006 }
|
|
9007 }
|
|
9008
|
|
9009 /*
|
|
9010 * List highlighting matches in a nice way.
|
|
9011 */
|
|
9012 static void
|
|
9013 highlight_list()
|
|
9014 {
|
|
9015 int i;
|
|
9016
|
|
9017 for (i = 10; --i >= 0; )
|
|
9018 highlight_list_two(i, hl_attr(HLF_D));
|
|
9019 for (i = 40; --i >= 0; )
|
|
9020 highlight_list_two(99, 0);
|
|
9021 }
|
|
9022
|
|
9023 static void
|
|
9024 highlight_list_two(cnt, attr)
|
|
9025 int cnt;
|
|
9026 int attr;
|
|
9027 {
|
|
9028 msg_puts_attr((char_u *)("N \bI \b! \b" + cnt / 11), attr);
|
|
9029 msg_clr_eos();
|
|
9030 out_flush();
|
|
9031 ui_delay(cnt == 99 ? 40L : (long)cnt * 50L, FALSE);
|
|
9032 }
|
|
9033
|
|
9034 #endif /* FEAT_CMDL_COMPL */
|
|
9035
|
|
9036 #if defined(FEAT_CMDL_COMPL) || (defined(FEAT_SYN_HL) && defined(FEAT_EVAL)) \
|
|
9037 || defined(FEAT_SIGNS) || defined(PROTO)
|
|
9038 /*
|
|
9039 * Function given to ExpandGeneric() to obtain the list of group names.
|
|
9040 * Also used for synIDattr() function.
|
|
9041 */
|
|
9042 /*ARGSUSED*/
|
|
9043 char_u *
|
|
9044 get_highlight_name(xp, idx)
|
|
9045 expand_T *xp;
|
|
9046 int idx;
|
|
9047 {
|
|
9048 if (idx == highlight_ga.ga_len
|
|
9049 #ifdef FEAT_CMDL_COMPL
|
|
9050 && include_link
|
|
9051 #endif
|
|
9052 )
|
|
9053 return (char_u *)"link";
|
|
9054 if (idx == highlight_ga.ga_len + 1
|
|
9055 #ifdef FEAT_CMDL_COMPL
|
|
9056 && include_link
|
|
9057 #endif
|
|
9058 )
|
|
9059 return (char_u *)"clear";
|
|
9060 if (idx == highlight_ga.ga_len + 2
|
|
9061 #ifdef FEAT_CMDL_COMPL
|
|
9062 && include_default
|
|
9063 #endif
|
|
9064 )
|
|
9065 return (char_u *)"default";
|
|
9066 if (idx < 0 || idx >= highlight_ga.ga_len)
|
|
9067 return NULL;
|
|
9068 return HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_name;
|
|
9069 }
|
|
9070 #endif
|
|
9071
|
|
9072 #ifdef FEAT_GUI
|
|
9073 /*
|
|
9074 * Free all the highlight group fonts.
|
|
9075 * Used when quitting for systems which need it.
|
|
9076 */
|
|
9077 void
|
|
9078 free_highlight_fonts()
|
|
9079 {
|
|
9080 int idx;
|
|
9081
|
|
9082 for (idx = 0; idx < highlight_ga.ga_len; ++idx)
|
|
9083 {
|
|
9084 gui_mch_free_font(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_font);
|
|
9085 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_font = NOFONT;
|
|
9086 # ifdef FEAT_XFONTSET
|
|
9087 gui_mch_free_fontset(HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_fontset);
|
|
9088 HL_TABLE()[idx].sg_fontset = NOFONTSET;
|
|
9089 # endif
|
|
9090 }
|
|
9091
|
|
9092 gui_mch_free_font(gui.norm_font);
|
|
9093 # ifdef FEAT_XFONTSET
|
|
9094 gui_mch_free_fontset(gui.fontset);
|
|
9095 # endif
|
|
9096 # ifndef HAVE_GTK2
|
|
9097 gui_mch_free_font(gui.bold_font);
|
|
9098 gui_mch_free_font(gui.ital_font);
|
|
9099 gui_mch_free_font(gui.boldital_font);
|
|
9100 # endif
|
|
9101 }
|
|
9102 #endif
|
|
9103
|
|
9104 /**************************************
|
|
9105 * End of Highlighting stuff *
|
|
9106 **************************************/
|